SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549


FORM 6-K


Report of Foreign Private Issuer

Pursuant to Rule 13a-16 or 15d-16 of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

March 1, 2012



The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc


Gogarburn
PO Box 1000
Edinburgh EH12 1HQ
Scotland
United Kingdom

(Address of principal executive offices)



Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F.

Form 20-F                                              Form 40-F    

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(1):__

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is submitting the Form 6-K in paper as permitted by Regulation S-T Rule 101(b)(7):__

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes                                                                 No  X 

If "Yes" is marked, indicate below the file number assigned to
the registrant in connection with Rule 12g3-2(b): 82-            

This report on Form 6-K shall be deemed incorporated by reference into the company's Registration Statement on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-162219 and 333-162219-01) and to be a part thereof from the date which it was filed, to the extent not superseded by documents or reports subsequently filed or furnished.

 
 

 
 
Contents

 
Page 
   
Forward-looking statements
   
Presentation of information
   
Condensed consolidated income statement
   
Comment – Group Chairman
   
Comment – Group Chief Executive
   
Highlights
11 
   
Analysis of results
18 
   
Divisional performance
27 
UK Retail
30 
UK Corporate
34 
Wealth
38 
Global Transaction Services
41 
Ulster Bank
44 
US Retail & Commercial
48 
Global Banking & Markets
54 
RBS Insurance
58 
Central items
64 
Non-Core
65 
   
Condensed consolidated income statement
73 
   
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
74 
   
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
75 
   
Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet
76 
   
Average balance sheet
80 
   
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
81 
   
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
84 
   
Notes
85 

 
1

 
 
Contents (continued)

 
Page 
   
Risk and balance sheet management
133 
   
Capital
135 
   
Liquidity and funding risk
141 
   
Credit risk
153 
   
Market risk
210 
   
Additional information
217 
   
Selected financial data
217 
   
Signature page
220 
   
Appendix 1  Businesses outlined for disposal
 
   
Appendix 2  Additional risk management disclosures
 
   
Appendix 3  Asset Protection Scheme
 
   
Appendix 4  Divisional reorganisation
 

 
2

 

Forward-looking statements


Certain sections in this document contain ‘forward-looking statements’ as that term is defined in the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, such as statements that include the words ‘expect’, ‘estimate’, ‘project’, ‘anticipate’, ‘believes’, ‘should’, ‘intend’, ‘plan’, ‘could’, ‘probability’, ‘risk’, ‘Value-at-Risk (VaR)’, ‘target’, ‘goal’, ‘objective’, ‘will’, ‘endeavour’, ‘outlook’, ‘optimistic’, ‘prospects’ and similar expressions or variations on such expressions.

In particular, this document includes forward-looking statements relating, but not limited to: the Group’s restructuring plans, divestments, capitalisation, portfolios, net interest margin, capital ratios, liquidity, risk weighted assets (RWAs), return on equity (ROE), profitability, cost:income ratios, leverage and loan:deposit ratios, funding and risk profile;  certain ring-fencing proposals; sustainability targets; the Group’s future financial performance; the level and extent of future impairments and write-downs, including sovereign debt impairments; the protection provided by the Asset Protection Scheme (APS); and the Group’s potential exposures to various types of market risks, such as interest rate risk, foreign exchange rate risk and commodity and equity price risk. These statements are based on current plans, estimates and projections, and are subject to inherent risks, uncertainties and other factors which could cause actual results to differ materially from the future results expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. For example, certain market risk disclosures are dependent on choices about key model characteristics and assumptions and are subject to various limitations. By their nature, certain of the market risk disclosures are only estimates and, as a result, actual future gains and losses could differ materially from those that have been estimated.

Other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by the forward-looking statements contained in this document include, but are not limited to: the global economic and financial market conditions and other geopolitical risks, and their impact on the financial industry in general and on the Group in particular; the ability to access sufficient sources of liquidity and funding; the recommendations made by the Independent Commission on Banking (ICB) and their potential implications; the ability to implement strategic plans on a timely basis, or at all, including the disposal of certain Non-Core assets and assets and businesses required as part of the State Aid restructuring plan; organisational restructuring, including any adverse consequences of a failure to transfer, or delay in transferring, certain business assets and liabilities from RBS N.V. to RBS; the full nationalisation of the Group or other resolution procedures under the Banking Act 2009; deteriorations in borrower and counterparty credit quality; costs or exposures borne by the Group arising out of the origination or sale of mortgages or mortgage-backed securities in the United States; the extent of future write-downs and impairment charges caused by depressed asset valuations; the value and effectiveness of any credit protection purchased by the Group; unanticipated turbulence in interest rates, yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, credit spreads, bond prices, commodity prices, equity prices and basis, volatility and correlation risks; changes in the credit ratings of the Group; ineffective management of capital or changes to capital adequacy or liquidity requirements; litigation and regulatory investigations; changes to the valuation of financial instruments recorded at fair value; competition and consolidation in the banking sector; the ability of the Group to attract or retain senior management or other key employees; regulatory or legal changes (including those requiring any restructuring of the Group’s operations) in the United Kingdom, the United States and other countries in which the Group operates or a change in United Kingdom Government policy; changes to regulatory requirements relating to capital and liquidity; changes to the monetary and interest rate policies of central banks and other governmental and regulatory bodies; changes in UK and foreign laws, regulations, accounting standards and taxes, including changes in regulatory capital regulations and liquidity requirements; impairments of goodwill; pension fund shortfalls; general operational risks; HM Treasury exercising influence over the operations of the Group; insurance claims; reputational risk; the ability to access the contingent capital arrangements with HM Treasury; the participation of the Group in the APS and the effect of the APS on the Group’s financial and capital position; the conversion of the B Shares in accordance with their terms; limitations on, or additional requirements imposed on, the Group’s activities as a result of HM Treasury’s investment in the Group; and the success of the Group in managing the risks involved in the foregoing.

The forward-looking statements contained in this document speak only as of the date of this announcement, and the Group does not undertake to update any forward-looking statement to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.

The information, statements and opinions contained in this document do not constitute a public offer under any applicable legislation or an offer to sell or solicitation of any offer to buy any securities or financial instruments or any advice or recommendation with respect to such securities or other financial instruments.

 
3

 
 
Presentation of information


RFS Holdings minority interest

RFS Holdings is the entity that acquired ABN AMRO and is 98% owned by RBS and is fully consolidated in its financial statements. The interests of the State of the Netherlands (the successor to Fortis), and Santander in RFS Holdings are included in non-controlling interests. Following legal separation on 1 April 2010, the interests of other Consortium Members in RFS Holdings relate only to shared assets.

Non-GAAP financial information
The directors manage the Group’s performance by class of business, before certain reconciling items, as is presented in the segmental analysis on pages 95 to 99 (the “managed basis”). Discussion of the Group’s performance focuses on the managed basis as the Group believes that such measures allow a more meaningful analysis of the Group’s financial condition and the results of its operations. These measures are non-GAAP financial measures. A body of generally accepted accounting principles such as IFRS is commonly referred to as ‘GAAP’. A non-GAAP financial measure is defined as one that measures historical or future financial performance, financial position or cash flows but which excludes or includes amounts that would not be so adjusted in the most comparable GAAP measure. Reconciliations of these non-GAAP measures are presented throughout this document or in the segmental analysis on pages 95 to 99. These non-GAAP financial measures are not a substitute for GAAP measures, for which management has responsibility. Furthermore, RBS has divided its operations into “Core” and “Non-Core” for internal reporting purposes. Certain measures disclosed in this document for Core operations and used by RBS management are non-GAAP financial measures as they represent a combination of all reportable segments with the exception of Non-Core. In addition, RBS has further divided parts of the Core business into “Retail & Commercial” consisting of the UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, Global Transaction Services, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions. This is a non-GAAP financial measure.  Lastly, the Basel III net stable funding ratio (see pages 149 and 150) represents a non-GAAP financial measure given it is a metric that is not yet required to be disclosed by a government, governmental authority or self-regulatory organisation.

Net interest margin
The basis of calculating the net interest margin (NIM) was refined in Q1 2011 and reflects the actual number of days in each quarter. Group and divisional NIMs for 2010 have been re-computed on the new basis.

Disposal groups
In accordance with IFRS 5 ‘Non-current assets held for sale and discontinued operations’, the Group has transferred the assets and liabilities relating to the planned disposal of its RBS England and Wales, and NatWest Scotland branch-based business, along with certain SME and corporate activities across the UK (‘UK branch-based businesses’), to assets and liabilities of disposal groups.
 
 
4

 
 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the period ended 31 December 2011


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
21,410 
22,776 
 
5,234 
5,371 
5,612 
Interest payable
(8,731)
(8,567)
 
(2,160)
(2,294)
(2,032)
             
Net interest income
12,679 
14,209 
 
3,074 
3,077 
3,580 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
6,384 
8,193 
 
1,590 
1,452 
2,052 
Fees and commissions payable
(1,460)
(2,211)
 
(573)
(304)
(449)
Income from trading activities
2,701 
4,517 
 
(238)
957 
364 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
(1)
Other operating income (excluding insurance
  premium income)
4,122 
1,479 
 
205 
2,384 
1,003 
Insurance net premium income
4,256 
5,128 
 
981 
1,036 
1,272 
             
Non-interest income
16,258 
17,659 
 
1,964 
5,526 
4,242 
             
Total income
28,937 
31,868 
 
5,038 
8,603 
7,822 
             
Staff costs
(8,678)
(9,671)
 
(1,993)
(2,076)
(2,194)
Premises and equipment
(2,451)
(2,402)
 
(674)
(604)
(709)
Other administrative expenses
(4,931)
(3,995)
 
(1,296)
(962)
(1,048)
Depreciation and amortisation
(1,875)
(2,150)
 
(513)
(485)
(546)
Write-down of goodwill and other intangible assets
(91)
(10)
 
(91)
(10)
             
Operating expenses
(18,026)
(18,228)
 
(4,567)
(4,127)
(4,507)
             
Profit before insurance net claims and
  impairment losses
10,911 
13,640 
 
471 
4,476 
3,315 
Insurance net claims
(2,968)
(4,783)
 
(529)
(734)
(1,182)
Impairment losses
(8,709)
(9,256)
 
(1,918)
(1,738)
(2,141)
             
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(766)
(399)
 
(1,976)
2,004 
(8)
Tax (charge)/credit
(1,250)
(634)
 
186 
(791)
             
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(2,016)
(1,033)
 
(1,790)
1,213 
(5)
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations,
  net of tax
47 
(633)
 
10 
55 
             
(Loss)/profit for the period
(1,969)
(1,666)
 
(1,780)
1,219 
50 
Non-controlling interests
(28)
665 
 
(18)
(38)
Preference share and other dividends
(124)
 
             
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and
  B shareholders
(1,997)
(1,125)
 
(1,798)
1,226 
12 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary and
  B share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary and
  B share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary
   and B share from discontinued operations
 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary
  and B shares from discontinued operations
 

 
5

 

Comment


Philip Hampton, Group Chairman, letter to shareholders:
When I became your Chairman in 2009, our urgent task was to stabilise RBS and then to begin the job of rebuilding the company.

We have made good progress in three years. The balance sheet has been reduced by over £700 billion from its peak. Our reliance on short-term wholesale funding, which stood at £297 billion at the end of 2008 has been cut to £102 billion. We repaid more than £20 billion of government-guaranteed debt in 2011. At 10.6%, our Core Tier 1 ratio is one of the strongest among our peers.

Our actions have made RBS safer and more stable.

Achievements like these require hard work. The Board is committed to restoring RBS to good health. We also made comprehensive changes to the executive management team after 2008. I am confident that they, ably led by Stephen Hester, are the right people to rebuild RBS. All of us understand our duties and responsibilities and are determined to fulfil them diligently.

It is the Board’s view that running the business on commercial grounds is the best way to make the bank safer and more valuable for everyone who depends upon it.  I do not believe there is a workable alternative if our aim is to provide the opportunity for the UK government to sell its shares in the public markets in a reasonable timescale.

A sign that we have succeeded will be the desire of private investors to acquire the UK government’s stake. While these investors hold only 18% of our shares today, their view of our performance, leadership and strategy is crucial. All being well, they will own the majority of the equity capital of the company in future years.

In the meantime, the job of rebuilding the Group is far from complete. The need to address the legacy of losses in a number of businesses means that the Group is not yet profitable, although in 2011 our core businesses earned a profit of £6 billion and a return on tangible equity of 10.5%.

During 2011, we faced weak and deteriorating economic and market conditions. We dealt with those. For example, we accelerated our Non-Core run-down, reduced risk concentrations and strengthened our liquidity and funding position. The Independent Commission on Banking published its findings and the UK government responded with its plans. We have begun to deal with its far-reaching implications. In January 2012, we announced how we will reshape our international wholesale business.

So, we can adapt and we have adapted our plans to changing conditions. That is simply doing business.

Other external forces affect banks in the UK and especially RBS. We know we are different. I have said often that we are grateful to, and are well aware of the interest in the Group by UK taxpayers. We intend to repay them by restoring RBS, allowing the bank to do its vital job of serving our customers and being part of a vibrant and successful economy.

 
6

 
 
Comment (continued)


At present, we are an unusual company, operating commercially, listed on the stock market but majority-owned by the UK government. It is a challenge for all those involved to manage the complexities and occasional tensions in this structure. The ability to run the company on a commercial basis can be hindered by elements of the periodic debate on how to respond to such tensions, in the media and elsewhere. The Board believes it is important to remain commercially focussed, recognising where we can the political context in which we operate.

I understand people’s anger and anxiety about inequalities in pay at a time when the economy is weak and many people are finding things tough. RBS alone cannot fix these wider issues if we are to achieve what is asked of us commercially. But we have led the way in changing how we pay our people. We asked our shareholders how they expect us to set incentives. In response, we have aligned the longer-term rewards our people receive with our shareholders’ interests. When we reward good performance, the amount paid in cash is minimal, with most of it paid in shares and bonds. If the subsequent results so warrant, we can claw back awards. I am confident that our practices will stand favourable comparison with others’.

Fulfilling our wider responsibilities
As we rebuild RBS, we are fulfilling our responsibilities to the communities in which our customers and people live and work. Last year, we:

·
provided more than 40p in every £1 lent to UK small and medium-sized businesses;
   
·
opened nearly 120,000 new start-up accounts across the UK;
   
·
provided an average of 4,000 business loans each week;
   
·
helped over 5,000 UK businesses back to health through our Specialised Relationship Management teams; and
   
·
recruited more than 8,000 16-24 year olds.

These demonstrate the role we can and will play in serving and helping society and the economy. We are building on them. Our Board-level Sustainability Committee is talking to our stakeholders about the elements of our business that matter to them and in 2012 we will publish demanding environmental targets that will drive a reduction in our carbon footprint.

The Board
We were pleased to welcome three new independent non-executive directors to the Board: Alison Davis, Tony Di Iorio and Baroness Noakes. They bring a wealth of experience, along with a strong global perspective. They have already made a significant contribution to the work of the Board since they joined.

Colin Buchan retired as a director in August 2011 and John McFarlane will step down in March 2012. We have greatly appreciated the experience, commitment and knowledge they brought to the Board.

Thanks
Finally, I wish to thank our employees. They are rebuilding RBS each day by serving our customers. They did that very well indeed in 2011, even as many faced major uncertainties. I am grateful to them.

 
7

 

Comment (continued)


Stephen Hester, Group Chief Executive, letter to shareholders:
RBS has completed the first three years of its recovery plan. Over that period the Bank’s results across our key goals - Customers, Risk and Value - have exceeded the Plan targets we put together in 2009. This is pleasing and puts the Bank in a vastly better position than before to serve our different constituencies. We are dealing with the new economic and regulatory challenges within the strategic plan and have retained our focus on building an RBS for all to be proud of. Great credit is due to our people for the accomplishments to date and to those who have supported us with their capital or their custom.

Priorities
We are clear on RBS’s priorities:
·
to serve customers well;
   
·
to restore the Bank to a sustainable and conservative risk profile; and
   
·
to rebuild value for all shareholders.

These priorities are interconnected and mutually supporting.

2009-11 Report Card
During the last three years RBS has:

-
sustained its customer franchises across our Core business in the face of restructuring and reputational pressures. Market shares are stable overall. Service standards are generally up.  Lending support across the UK business substantially exceeds our natural customer market share.
   
-
rebuilt its financial resilience. Core Tier 1 ratio increased to 10.6%, total assets reduced by £712 billion from peak levels, short-term wholesale borrowing reduced by £195 billion, converting a £207 billion deficit versus liquid assets to a £53 billion surplus. Balance sheet leverage reduced from 21.2x to 16.9x and the loan:deposit ratio improved to 108% (94% in Core). In each case the 2011 position is well ahead of that originally forecast.
   
-
produced £34 billion in pre-impairment profits from Core businesses. These were used to self-fund our legacy losses and loan impairments, which to date have totalled £43 billion. Operating costs have been reduced by an average of £1 billion annually. Each of these totals is better than originally forecast despite a tougher economic environment.

2011 Results
2011 saw good progress across all measures of risk reduction and increased financial soundness; important given the much tougher market conditions. Customer service and support was sustained well.

However, RBS has reported a pre-tax loss of £766 million overall and, in common with others, has seen a share price fall, albeit still at levels much higher than the 10p starting point in January 2009. These outcomes reflect the stage of our recovery and the external environment. They mask real and important accomplishments, however.

 
8

 
 
Comment (continued)


2011 Results (continued)
Core bank operating profits were £6.1 billion.  Within this total, operating profits in 2011 across RBS’s Retail and Commercial business (excluding Ulster Bank) were up 9% to £4.9 billion. RBS Insurance turned loss into profit, a £749 million improvement on 2010.  GBM suffered a 54% fall in profit to £1.6 billion, reflecting tough market conditions, but still a substantial result and one generally in line with other investment banking businesses. Non-Core losses declined 24% to £4.2 billion as the risk run-off continued ahead of schedule. Exceptional charges for past business associated with PPI and Greek write-downs were also taken. £3.8 billion was handed over to HMT/HMRC/Bank of England in fees for APS/Credit Guarantee Scheme, taxes (both on our behalf and on that of our employees) and capital support schemes.

We all understand that a company that is making losses at the bottom line tests the patience of those who depend on it. However, the restructuring task we have undertaken at RBS is unique in its scale and complexity, and needs to be phased in line with our ability to fund and execute it. In dealing with these legacy losses we expect to put the company on a sustainable footing for generations to come. 2011 proved what we already knew: that there are no shortcuts to this endpoint.

Strategy
The new RBS is built upon customer-driven businesses with substantial competitive strengths in their respective markets; together our ‘Core’ business. Each unit is being reshaped to provide improved and enduring performance and to meet new external challenges. The businesses are managed to add value in their own right but to provide a stronger, more balanced and valuable whole through vital cross-business linkages.

The weaknesses uncovered by the financial crisis - of leverage, risk concentration and business stretch – are being fixed.  The primary vehicle for this is the run-off and sale of assets in our Non-Core division though there are many other parallel tasks.  RBS’s total assets have already been reduced by £712 billion from their peak in 2008 - more than any other entity worldwide has achieved.

Adjustments to Plan
The principles of RBS strategy are working well.  The tougher external environment will slow progress and reduce profitability but requires largely tactical change from the original plan for the majority of our business.

However, all banks, and especially in the UK, must adjust to much higher capital and liquidity requirements, and substantially changed wholesale funding markets.  There are particular pressures on the funding, profitability and capital intensity of cross-border, wholesale and investment banking business lines.

RBS has therefore adjusted its business plan to target a still more conservative capital and funding structure overall in order to meet current and prospective market and regulatory challenges.  This also includes further reduction in balance sheet, capital usage and expense base in the investment banking area, including exit of the cash equities business, reduction of the Group’s fixed income markets balance sheet and combination of its international corporate banking businesses. We expect these moves to make the client proposition in our wholesale businesses more focused, and so stronger and more sustainable. It will improve the stability of their funding and their prospects for an improved return on equity.
 
 
9

 

Comment (continued)


2011 Results (continued)
These enduring principles - around Customer, Risk and Shareholder - continue to drive our strategy.  The actions they give rise to should enable RBS to prosper over the long term as a leading international bank, anchored firmly in the UK and serving customers, shareholders and society well.

People
RBS people are doing a great job in serving customers whilst driving the change we need. Their engagement and efforts are essential to our task. I thank them sincerely. While the climate is tough for people in many walks of life, that does not take away from the exceptional demands we make on our staff and the continuing need we have for their talents, engagement and motivation.

Concluding remarks
In this letter a year ago I re-affirmed the path ahead for RBS and how we planned to travel down it. I am pleased to say we remain on that track.

However, I also warned of the risks from economic and regulatory/policy change. These have indeed impacted strongly and remain uppermost in our minds when looking at 2012. We will continue to prioritise customer service and risk reduction. We will strive to complement this with determined measures to improve business performance to pay for the remaining ‘clean-up’ and then to produce results for shareholders. We are building the capacity of our business to earn its cost of capital and produce solid returns as external conditions allow.

RBS is an enduring financial institution playing a key part in our markets and communities. We support others. We depend on the support of customers and our communities in turn. We are working our way out of a tough legacy whilst sustaining “business as usual” for the vast majority of what we do.

I thank our staff and all our stakeholders for their continued support.

 
10

 

Highlights


2011 results summary
RBS made further progress in 2011 on its strategic plan to rebuild financial resilience, cutting its funded balance sheet to less than £1,000 billion for the first time since the restructuring plan’s inception in 2009. The Group’s priority in 2011 has been to strengthen its balance sheet and reduce risk as it works through the restructuring plan. Key achievements include:

·
decreasing the funded balance sheet by £49 billion to £977 billion.
   
·
exceeding Non-Core run-off targets, with Non-Core funded assets reduced to £94 billion, less than 10% of Group funded assets.
   
·
reducing RWAs by £63 billion.
   
·
growing Retail & Commercial customer deposits by £9 billion.
   
·
improving the Core loan:deposit ratio to 94% from 96% in 2010 and the Group loan:deposit ratio to 108% (2010 - 118%).
   
·
maintaining a robust capital base, with a Core Tier 1 ratio of 10.6%.

Customer franchises have been sustained across the Core Group, with resilient market shares and improving service metrics. While operating results in the Group’s principal retail and commercial businesses have remained strong, measures to reduce risk in Global Banking & Markets (GBM) as financial market conditions deteriorated in the second half of the year and to accelerate the disposal of Non-Core exposures held back overall operating profits.

These results mean that over the last three years RBS has lowered short-term wholesale funding by 66% to £102 billion and improved its loan:deposit ratio to 108%. Core pre-impairment operating profits over this period have totalled £34 billion, including £11.5 billion from GBM. This has helped to fund £43 billion of loan losses and the costs of working through other legacy issues and derisking the Group’s operations, including sovereign debt impairments, APS charges, disposal costs and restructuring charges.

Operating profit
Group loss before tax in 2011 was £766 million up from £399 million in 2010. Adjusting for movements in the fair value of own debt of £1,846 million, a charge of £906 million for the Asset Protection Scheme, Payment Protection Insurance (PPI) costs of £850 million, sovereign debt impairments of £1,099 million, amortisation of purchased intangible assets of £222 million, integration and restructuring costs of £1,064 million, a gain on redemption of own debt of £255 million, strategic disposals of £104 million, bank levy charges of £300 million, interest rate hedge adjustments on impaired available-for-sale Greek government bonds of £169 million, and other non-operating items totalling £45 million, Group operating profit was £1,892 million in 2011, compared with £1,913 million in 2010. Adjusting for the impact of the disposal of Global Merchant Services (GMS) in Q4 2010, operating profit was up 11%. A total of £2,456 million has now been expensed in relation to the APS.

·
UK Retail operating profit rose 45% to £1,991 million, with income flat but expenses 6% lower, and impairments down 32%.
   
·
UK Corporate operating profit totalled £1,414 million, down 3%, with income and expenses broadly flat and impairments up £24 million.
   
·
Wealth operating profit was 6% higher at £321 million, driven by 11% growth in income.
   
·
Global Transaction Services (GTS) operating profit was £743 million, down 16% after adjusting for GMS, largely reflecting a single corporate loan impairment.

 
11

 
 
Highlights


2011 results summary (continued)

Operating profit (continued)
·
Ulster Bank operating losses increased to £1,024 million as Irish credit conditions remained challenging.
   
·
US Retail & Commercial recovery continued with operating profit up 57%, as income improved and impairment losses fell substantially.
   
·
GBM operating profits fell 54% to £1,561 million, with revenue down 25% as the division faced a difficult external environment and managed down its risk exposures.
   
·
RBS Insurance delivered a strong turnaround with an operating profit of £454 million compared with a loss of £295 million in 2010.  We continue to target an IPO of this business in the second half of 2012, subject to market conditions.

Non-Core’s operating loss fell to £4,203 million in 2011, an improvement of £1,302 million from 2010, with impairments falling by £1,557 million, despite ongoing challenges in the Ulster Bank and real estate portfolios. Operating expenses were £961 million lower.  Non-Core RWAs fell by £60 billion in 2011 to £93 billion. The division focused on reducing capital intensive trading assets, with activity including the restructuring of monoline exposures, which, at a cost of c.£600 million in 2011, achieved a reduction of £32 billion in RWAs.

The process of funding legacy losses through the generation of operating profit continues. In 2011 the Group absorbed further significant legacy costs, including integration and restructuring costs of £1,064 million; PPI costs of £850 million; sovereign debt impairments of £1,099 million; and a charge of £906 million for the Asset Protection Scheme. A total of £2,456 million has now been expensed in relation to the APS.  Other significant non-operating items included the bank levy of £300 million and a credit of £1,846 million for movements in the fair value of own debt, resulting in pre-tax losses of £766 million, up from £249 million in 2010. Following a particularly high tax charge of £1,250 million (£634 million in 2010), primarily as a result of continuing Ulster Bank losses, the Group recorded an attributable loss of £1,997 million compared with £1,125 million in 2010.

Returns
Retail & Commercial (R&C) ROE improved to 11.3% from 10.2% in 2010. GBM ROE was 7.7%, notwithstanding the challenging market conditions, leaving overall Core ROE at 10.5%. TNAV per share at end 2011 was 50.1p.

Efficiency
Core expenses were stable, with reduced costs in UK Retail and GBM offset by investment in the Wealth and GTS franchises. Non-Core expenses fell by 43%, leaving Group 2011 expenses 7% lower than in 2010 at £15,478 million. The Group’s cost reduction programme delivered cost savings with an underlying run rate of over £3 billion to the end of 2011, ahead of the original target of £2.5 billion annualised savings by 2013 and with lower programme spend than originally projected. This has enabled the Group to reinvest savings into enhancing its systems infrastructure to support improvements in customer service, enhance product offerings and respond to regulatory changes.

 
12

 
 
Highlights


2011 results summary (continued)

Efficiency (continued)
Staff costs declined 10% to £8,678 million. The compensation ratio in GBM, excluding discontinued businesses, was 39%. Variable compensation accrued in the first half of the year were reduced in the second half of the year, leaving the 2011 variable compensation awards 58% lower than 2010, compared with the 54% fall in operating profit.

The cost:income ratio for the Group was 62% and for R&C was 55%, compared with 56% in 2010. RBS believes that further efficiency gains will be needed to ensure that its businesses are capable of delivering sustainable returns in excess of the cost of equity to its shareholders.

Risk
Group impairments totalled £8,709 million, down 6% from 2010. Non-Core continued to improve, despite persistent challenges in Ulster Bank and commercial real estate portfolios.

UK Retail and US R&C impairment trends remained favourable, with 2011 impairment losses down 32% and 37% respectively compared with the prior year. UK Corporate impairments were broadly in line with 2010 at 0.7% of loans and advances but Core Ulster Bank’s impairment charge rose 19%, reflecting deteriorating bad debt trends and lower asset prices in the mortgage portfolio. Total Ulster Bank impairments in Core and Non-Core were £3,733 million in 2011 compared with £3,895 million in 2010, down 4%.

Adjusting for sovereign debt impairment losses of £1,099 million, interest rate hedge adjustments on impaired available-for-sale Greek government bonds of £169 million and other impairment losses of £2 million, the 2011 impairment charge represented 1.5% of Group customer loans and advances, with the Core ratio at 0.8%. Provision coverage of risk elements in lending improved to 49% compared with 47% at the end of 2010.

The Group actively managed down its market risk exposures in anticipation of the deterioration in financial market conditions in the second half of 2011. Average trading value at risk (VaR) was £105.5 million, down 37% from 2010. Average credit spread VaR in particular was significantly lower, reflecting continuing progress in managing down Non-Core exposures and reducing concentration risk. Increased volatility arising from the difficulties of eurozone sovereigns resulted in average VaR increasing slightly in Q4 2011.

Balance sheet
The Group funded balance sheet fell by £49 billion during 2011 to £977 billion. Non-Core again exceeded targets, reducing funded assets by £44 billion during 2011 to £94 billion at the year-end.  Further reductions will include the disposal of the Group’s aviation finance business for £4.7 billion, signed in January 2012. During 2011, Non-Core focused on reducing capital intensive trading assets, reducing RWAs by £60 billion and also mitigated significant future regulatory uplifts.

GBM lowered funded assets by £35 billion, to £362 billion compared with £397 billion at 31 December 2010, making good progress towards the new target of circa £300 billion set as RBS restructures its wholesale businesses. R&C loan growth remained muted.

 
13

 
 
Highlights


2011 results summary (continued)

Liquidity and funding
The Group further strengthened its liquidity and funding metrics as financial market conditions became more challenging in the second half of 2011. Including loans and advances to customers of £19,405 million and customer deposits of £22,610 within disposal groups the Group loan:deposit ratio improved to 108%, 10 percentage points lower than at the end of 2010. Over the last three years Core R&C customer deposits have grown by £49 billion, partially offset by a reduction in more volatile GBM deposits and Non-Core rundown.

Net term issuance in 2011 totalled £21 billion, exceeding the Group’s targets for the year. £20 billion of maturing government-guaranteed debt was repaid in 2011. In view of continuing uncertain market conditions the liquidity portfolio was maintained above target levels at £155 billion, well in excess of short-term wholesale funding, which, excluding derivatives collateral, fell to £102 billion at year end compared with £130 billion at 31 December 2010.

Capital
The Core Tier 1 ratio was 10.6%, compared with 10.7% at the end of 2010. Excluding the effect of the APS of £69 billion, RWAs decreased by £63 billion, despite a £21 billion impact in Q4 2011 from the implementation of CRD III. The reduction reflected activity in Non-Core to reduce capital-intensive trading assets, including the restructuring of monoline exposures. As assets covered by the APS have run-off or been disposed of, the Core Tier 1 ratio benefit arising from the APS has diminished to 0.9%, compared with 1.2% at end 2010.

Tangible net asset value per share was 50.1p at 31 December 2011, compared with 51.1p at 31 December 2010.

Strategy
RBS has made good progress over the last three years towards its key objectives of serving customers well, reducing risk and rebuilding value for all shareholders.

In the course of 2011 the Group’s priority has been to strengthen its balance sheet and reduce risk as it works through the restructuring plan, and this is reflected in good progress made on the key risk measures set out in 2009. Targets for capital, short-term wholesale funding, liquidity reserves and leverage have all been met ahead of schedule. The 2011 Group loan:deposit ratio was 110%. Including loans and advances to customers of £19,405 million and customer deposits of £22,610 million within disposal groups, the Group loan:deposit ratio improved further in 2011 to stand at 108%, compared with 154% shortly before the strategic plan was launched.

RBS has seen significant improvement in earnings and returns from the worst point reached in 2008. In 2011, however, the deterioration in external economic and financial conditions led the Group to prioritise derisking over driving returns. Core ROE was 10.5%, with R&C return on equity at 11.3%. GBM ROE was 7.7%, notwithstanding the challenging market conditions. The Group’s objective remains for each of its banking businesses to be based on enduring customer franchises; to be capable of generating sustainable returns in excess of its cost of equity; to be able to fund itself from its own deposit base; to contribute to the overall Group through its connectivity with other businesses; and to achieve the levels of efficiency necessary to compete effectively in its market. In light of the changed market and regulatory environment, the RBS Group Board has agreed new medium-term strategic targets, which are set out below.

 
14

 
 
Highlights (continued)


2011 results summary (continued)

Customer franchises
RBS’s first priority is to serve its customers well.  Since the adoption of our strategic plan in 2009 we have been focused on identifying what our customers value and on targeting our product propositions and service improvements accordingly.

2011 highlights for our businesses included:
·
reporting progress against our Customer Charters and introducing new commitments;
   
·
using new technologies to make it easier for customers to bank with us;
   
·
reacting swiftly and decisively to external events affecting our customers; and
   
·
introducing new training programmes for customer-facing employees.

During 2011, UK Retail and Ulster Bank both achieved encouraging progress against their Customer Charter commitments.  UK Retail, for example, achieved the goal of serving 80% of its customers in less than 5 minutes in its busiest branches and answering 90% of all incoming calls in less than a minute. 89% of Ulster Bank’s customer queries were answered in a single call in the period July - September 2011, compared with 81% in the period January - June 2011.  In both divisions, however, there is clearly more to do, with handling of customer complaints a particular focus.

US Retail & Commercial began a phased roll-out of its Customer Commitments in Q4 2011: focusing on getting to know each customer as an individual, earning customer trust, putting customers in control of their own finances and valuing their time and business.

Technological innovation has an important role to play in improving customer service, and 2011 saw further improvements to RBS’s leading mobile banking services.  UK Retail, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial customers can access their accounts and manage their money via their mobiles and GBM customers can access trading analysis and expert commentary through their iPad. The iPhone app for RBS and NatWest customers was updated and has now been downloaded by one million customers.

In August, RBS Insurance responded quickly and decisively to the UK riots, helping customers and other small business owners cope with the aftermath of the rioting, providing general insurance advice and information on the claims process. UK Corporate also reacted swiftly, providing £10 million of interest-free, fee-free loans to business customers affected by the rioting.

In June, UK Corporate launched a relationship manager accreditation programme to improve the knowledge and professionalism of front-line staff, while US Retail & Commercial invested in an enhanced sales training programme for managers and sales colleagues.  By the end of 2011, the majority of UK Corporate’s relationship managers had gained full accreditation under the initial phase of the programme and in the US the training has begun to deliver externally recognised increases in customer satisfaction.

 
15

 
 
Highlights (continued)


2011 results summary (continued)

Customer franchises (continued)
2011 demonstrated clear examples of our commitment to serving our customers well but we recognise there is much we still need to achieve, and providing our customers consistently high quality service remains a key priority in our strategic plan.

UK lending
RBS extended £93.5 billion of new lending to UK businesses in 2011: £36.3 billion of new loans and facilities to mid and large corporates, £16.3 billion of mid corporate overdraft renewals, £31.5 billion of new loans and facilities to SMEs and £9.4 billion of SME overdraft renewals.

New loans and facilities to businesses increased by 22% in 2011 compared with 2010, with new loans and facilities to SME customers up by 4%, exceeding its Merlin “stretch” lending targets. RBS new lending accounted for 48% of all SME lending reported by the Merlin banks, well above its customer market share.

This strong lending performance represented a significant success for RBS’s efforts to foster loan demand from creditworthy companies, in the face of weakening confidence and subdued appetite for investment in 2011. If creditworthy demand grows, the Group would aim to lend even more in 2012. Economic uncertainty caused companies - particularly smaller businesses - to delay or scale back investments and to focus on deleveraging and cash flow preservation. Total SME credit applications in 2011 were 17% lower than for 2010, and 31% lower than 2007.  RBS remains committed to doing everything it can to stimulate demand.

Many of RBS’s SME customers have been paying down debt and building up their cash balances, with SME customers increasingly opting to build up longer term savings in light of perceived decreased investment opportunities. Term deposits of over 12 months rose 53% in 2011 from the Group’s smallest business customers, those with turnover of up to £2 million, and 33% for SME customers overall.  SME overdraft utilisation also continued to fall, from 47% for December 2010 to 45% for December 2011.

Lending to mid and large corporates was driven by re-financing activity, as economic newsflows remained weak and uncertainty surrounding the eurozone drove confidence in economic recovery and market stability lower. Drawn lending balances in the mid and large corporate sector decreased by 5% compared with 2010.

Gross new mortgage lending in 2011 was £16.2 billion, with balances outstanding up 5% compared with 2010.  A fifth of new mortgages provided by the Group were to first time buyers, and gross new lending to this market segment increased quarter on quarter throughout 2011.

 
16

 

Highlights (continued)


2011 results summary (continued)

Outlook
Economic and regulatory challenges have continued into 2012. Growth prospects in the UK, the Group’s most important market, remain modest, while the eurozone sovereign crisis remains a risk.

Against this backdrop, Retail and Commercial performance is expected to remain broadly stable, benefitting modestly  from improvement in impairments.

GBM Markets will transition to its revised, more targeted strategy. The year is off to a good start, but revenue performance will remain market-dependent.

The continuing run-off of Non-Core is expected to crystallise further disposal losses, though overall Non-Core losses are expected to fall again.

The Group NIM outlook is stable with the second half of 2011. However, accounting swings relating to fair value of own debt will continue to feature.

The Group expects to continue to prioritise the strengthening of its balance sheet and the further removal of risk.

 
17

 

Analysis of results

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
Net interest income
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Net interest income
12,679 
14,209 
 
3,074 
3,077 
           
Average interest-earning assets
661,118 
689,531 
 
663,519 
663,059 
           
Net interest margin
1.92% 
2.06% 
 
1.84% 
1.84% 
  - Group
         
  - Core
         
    - Retail & Commercial (1)
3.21% 
3.14% 
 
3.17% 
3.19% 
    - Global Banking & Markets
0.73% 
1.05% 
 
0.76% 
0.71% 
  - Non-Core
0.64% 
1.16% 
 
0.31% 
0.43% 

Note:
(1)
Retail & Commercial (R&C) comprises the UK Retail, UK Corporate, Wealth, Global Transaction Services, Ulster Bank and US Retail & Commercial divisions.

Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
Group net interest income was 11% lower largely driven by the run-off of balances and exit of higher margin, higher risk segments in Non-Core.
   
·
Group NIM was 14 basis points lower, reflecting the cost of carrying a higher liquidity portfolio and by the impact of non-performing assets in the Non-Core division.
   
·
R&C NIM was up 7 basis points, with strengthening asset margins in the first half of the year offsetting the impact of a competitive deposit market.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Group net interest income remained stable in Q4 2011, as reduced interest expense from repayment of high cost government-guaranteed debt offset modest margin pressure in R&C.
   
·
R&C NIM was 2 basis points lower, largely driven by competitive pricing on UK deposits and a continued decline in long-term swap rate returns on current accounts.
   
·
Overall Group interest-earning assets were broadly stable.  R&C interest-earning assets were flat, while elsewhere in the Group higher central bank cash balances offset asset run-off in GBM and Non-Core.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
R&C NIM was down 4 basis points, with continued tightening of liability margins and a decline in long-term swap rate returns on current accounts more than offsetting asset repricing actions.
   
·
Average interest-earning assets were up slightly at £665 billion, with growth in UK mortgage balances and in liquidity holdings offsetting Non-Core run-off.

 
18

 

Analysis of results (continued)


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Non-interest income
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Net fees and commissions
4,924 
5,982 
 
1,017 
1,148 
1,603 
Income from trading activities
           
  - Asset Protection Scheme (APS)
(906)
(1,550)
 
(209)
(60)
(725)
  - movements in the fair value of own debt
225 
(75)
 
(170)
470 
110 
  - other
3,382 
6,142 
 
141 
547 
979 
Gain/(loss) on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
(1)
Other operating income
           
  - strategic disposals
(24)
171 
 
49 
502 
  - movements in the fair value of own debt*
1,621 
249 
 
(200)
1,887 
472 
  - other
2,525 
1,059 
 
403 
448 
29 
             
Non-interest income (excluding
  insurance net premium income)
12,002 
12,531 
 
983 
4,490 
2,970 
Insurance net premium income
4,256 
5,128 
 
981 
1,036 
1,272 
             
Total non-interest income
16,258 
17,659 
 
1,964 
5,526 
4,242 
             
* Fair value of own debt impact:
           
Income from trading activities
225 
(75)
 
(170)
470 
110 
Other operating income
1,621 
249 
 
(200)
1,887 
472 
             
Fair value of own debt (FVOD)
1,846 
174 
 
(370)
2,357 
582 

Key points

2011 compared with 2010

·
Non-interest income decreased by 8% to £16,258 million in 2011. Excluding movements in the fair value of own debt £1,846 million, a charge on the APS of £906 million, gain on redemption of own debt of £255 million, a loss on strategic disposals of £24 million and other losses of £1 million, non-interest income decreased by £3,374 million to £15,088 million. This was principally driven by lower trading income in GBM and Non-Core and a fall in insurance net premium income.
   
·
Volatile market conditions led to a reduction in GBM trading income, driven by the deterioration in global credit markets as sovereign difficulties in the eurozone grew.
   
·
Non-Core trading losses increased by £690 million, reflecting costs incurred as part of the division’s focus on reducing capital trading assets, with activity including the restructuring of monoline exposures, which mitigated both significant immediate and future regulatory uplifts in risk-weighted assets.
   
·
Insurance net premium income fell by 17% largely driven by RBS Insurance’s exit from certain business segments, along with reduced volumes reflecting the de-risking of the motor book.  Insurance net premium income in Non-Core also decreased as legacy policies ran-off.
   
·
2010 results included £482 million of income recorded for GMS prior to its disposal in November 2010.
   
·
A gain of £502 million on strategic disposals for Q4 2010 largely reflected the £837 million gain on the sale of Global Merchant Services, partially offset by losses on Non-Core project finance assets.

 
19

 

Analysis of results (continued)


2011 compared with 2010 (continued)

·
A full year gain on FVOD of £1,846 million as a result of Group credit spreads widening partially offset the 2011 charges. This compares with a smaller gain of £174 million in 2010.
   
·
The APS fair value charge was £906 million in 2011. The cumulative charge for the APS was £2,456 million as at 31 December 2011.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011

·
Non-interest income fell 6% to £1,964 million. Excluding movements in the fair value of own debt of £370 million, a charge on the APS of £209 million, a gain on strategic disposals of £2 million and other adjustments of £2 million, non-interest income was £1,964 million.
   
·
GBM trading income included a £368 million change in own credit on derivative liabilities, partially offset by an improved credit hedging (CEM) position of £235 million. Excluding these items, GBM trading income was £542 million versus £551 million in Q3 2011.
   
·
Insurance premium income fell, largely reflecting the continued de-risking of the motor portfolio.
   
·
The Group’s credit spreads narrowed in the fourth quarter resulting in a FVOD charge of £370 million. This compares with a widening of spreads in Q3 2011 and a significant gain of £2,357 million.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Non-interest income fell 54% to £1,964 million.
   
·
More challenging market conditions reduced trading and fee income in GBM.
   
·
In Q4 2011 the Group recorded a loss of £370 million on FVOD, as Group credit spreads tightened.  Wider credit spreads in Q4 2010 resulted in a gain of £582 million.
   
·
The Q4 2011 APS fair value charge was £209 million compared with a charge of £725 million in Q4 2010, reflecting improved credit spreads in the quarter, as well as a further reduction in assets covered to £131.8 billion at 31 December 2011.

 
20

 

Analysis of results (continued)


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Operating expenses
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Staff expenses
8,678 
9,671 
 
1,993 
2,076 
2,194 
Premises and equipment
2,451 
2,402 
 
674 
604 
709 
Other administrative expenses
           
  -Payment Protection Insurance costs
850 
 
  -Integration and restructuring costs
1,059 
1,032 
 
478 
233 
299 
  -Bank levy
300 
   
300 
   
  -Other
2,722 
2,963 
 
518 
729 
749 
             
Administrative expenses
16,060 
16,068 
 
3,963 
3,642 
3,951 
Depreciation and amortisation
           
  -amortisation of purchased intangible
   assets
222 
369 
 
53 
69 
96 
  -other
1,653 
1,781 
 
460 
416 
450 
Write down of goodwill and other intangible assets
           
  -Goodwill relating to UK branch-based businesses
80 
 
80 
  -other
11 
10 
 
11 
10 
             
Operating expenses
18,026 
18,228 
 
4,567 
4,127 
4,507 
             
             
General insurance
2,968 
4,698 
 
529 
734 
1,151 
Bancassurance
85 
 
31 
             
Insurance net claims
2,968 
4,783 
 
529 
734 
1,182 
             
             
Staff costs as a % of total income
30% 
30% 
 
40% 
24% 
28% 

Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
Group expenses were £18,026 million, 1% lower in 2011. Excluding Payment Protection Insurance costs of £850 million, integration and restructuring costs of £1,059 million, bank levy charges of £300 million, goodwill relating to the sale of UK branch-based business of £80 million and other adjustments of £259 million, Group expenses fell by 7% to £15,478 million. This decrease was driven by cost savings achieved as a result of the cost reduction programme and Non-Core run-off, largely reflecting the disposal of RBS Sempra and specific country exits.
   
·
Staff expenses fell 10%, driven by lower GBM variable compensation as a result of its decrease in revenues, and in Non-Core, given the impact of a 32% reduction in headcount and continued business disposals and country exits.
   
·
General insurance claims were £1,730 million lower, mainly due to the non-repeat of bodily injury reserve strengthening in 2010, de-risking of the motor book, more benign weather in 2011 and claims in Non-Core decreasing as legacy policies ran-off.
   
·
The Group’s cost reduction programme delivered cost savings with an underlying run rate of over £3 billion by the end of 2011.
   
·
Integration and restructuring costs remained broadly flat at £1,059 million, reflecting significant GBM restructuring in 2011.

 
21

 

Analysis of results (continued)


Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Group expenses increased by 10% to £4,567 million. Excluding integration and restructuring costs of £478 million, bank levy charges of £300 million, amortisation of purchased intangible assets of £53 million, goodwill relating to the sale of UK branch-based business of £80 million and other losses of £12 million, Group expenses fell by 5% to £3,644 million. This was significantly driven by a reduction in GBM variable compensation accrued in the first half of 2011. Core R&C expenses declined by 3% in part reflecting lower deposit insurance levies in Wealth and US R&C and continued benefits from the cost reduction programme.
   
·
Non-Core expenses fell 3% largely driven by ongoing rundown of the division.
   
·
Q4 2011 integration and restructuring costs increased to £478 million, largely reflecting the GBM headcount reduction announced in 2011, as well as property exit costs.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Group expenses were £60 million, or 1% higher than in the prior year. Excluding integration and restructuring costs of £478 million, bank levy charges of £300 million, amortisation of purchased intangible assets of £53 million, goodwill relating to the sale of UK branch-based business of £80 million and other losses of £12 million, Group expenses were £437 million, or 11% lower than in the prior year. Non-Core expenses were down 35% reflecting the impact of business disposals and country exits and significantly lower current year variable compensation in GBM.
   
·
General insurance claims fell by 54% as net claims in RBS Insurance fell by £309 million, reflecting an improved risk mix, more benign weather in Q4 2011 and the exit of certain business segments.  Legacy business run-off in Non-Core also reduced claims.
   
·
Integration and restructuring costs increased from £299 million in Q4 2010 to £478 million in Q4 2011 largely reflecting significant restructuring within GBM along with continued business and country exits.

 
22

 

Analysis of results (continued)


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Impairment losses
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loan impairment losses
7,241 
9,144 
 
1,654 
1,452 
2,155 
Securities impairment losses
           
  -Sovereign debt impairment (1)
1,099 
 
224 
142 
  -Interest rate hedge adjustments on
   available-for-sale Greek government
   bonds
169 
 
60 
  -other
200 
112 
 
40 
84 
(14)
             
Group impairment losses
8,709 
9,256 
 
1,918 
1,738 
2,141 
             
Loan impairment losses
           
  - latent
(545)
(121)
 
(190)
(60)
(116)
  - collectively assessed
2,591 
3,070 
 
591 
689 
729 
  - individually assessed
5,195 
6,208 
 
1,253 
823 
1,555 
             
Customer loans
7,241 
9,157 
 
1,654 
1,452 
2,168 
Bank loans
(13)
 
(13)
             
Loan impairment losses
7,241 
9,144 
 
1,654 
1,452 
2,155 
             
Core
3,403 
3,737 
 
924 
817 
912 
Non-Core
3,838 
5,407 
 
730 
635 
1,243 
             
Group
7,241 
9,144 
 
1,654 
1,452 
2,155 
             
Customer loan impairment charge as
  a % of gross loans and advances (2)
           
Group
1.5% 
1.7% 
 
1.3% 
1.1% 
1.6% 
Core
0.8% 
0.9% 
 
0.9% 
0.8% 
0.9% 
Non-Core
4.8% 
4.9% 
 
3.7% 
2.8% 
4.4% 

Notes:
(1)
The Group holds Greek government bonds with a notional amount of £1.45 billion. In the second quarter of 2011, the Group recorded an impairment loss of £733 million in respect of these bonds as a result of Greece’s continuing fiscal difficulties. This charge (c.50% of notional) wrote the bonds down to their market price as at 30 June 2011. In the third quarter of 2011, an additional impairment loss of £142 million was recorded to write the bonds down to their market price as at 30 September 2011 (c.37% of notional). In the fourth quarter of 2011, an additional impairment loss of £224 million was recorded to write the bonds down to their market price as at 31 December 2011 (c.21% of notional).
(2)
Customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of gross customer loans and advances excluding reverse repurchase agreements and including disposal groups.

 
23

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)


Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
Group loan impairment losses decreased by 21% compared with 2010, driven largely by a £1,569 million reduction in Non-Core loan impairments, despite continuing challenges in Ulster Bank and corporate real estate portfolios.
   
·
R&C loan impairment losses fell by £199 million, driven by improving credit metrics in UK Retail and US Retail & Commercial partially offset by increases in Ulster Bank, largely reflecting a deterioration in credit metrics on the mortgage portfolio, and a single name provision in GTS.
   
·
Total Core and Non-Core Ulster Bank loan impairment losses decreased by 3%, as the £223 million increase in Core Ulster Bank losses was more than offset by a decrease in losses recognised in Non-Core.
   
·
The Group customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of loans and advances fell to 1.5% compared with 1.7% for 2010.  For Core, the comparable percentages are 0.8% and 0.9%.
   
·
An impairment of £1,099 million was taken on the Group’s AFS bond portfolio in 2011 as a result of the decline in the value of Greek sovereign bonds. As of 31 December 2011, the bonds were marked at 21% of par value.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Group loan impairment losses increased by 14% in Q4 2011, largely reflecting a small number of corporate provisions in GBM and a small increase in Non-Core impairments related to the UK Corporate portfolio.
   
·
Total Core and Non-Core Ulster Bank loan impairments fell by £38 million compared with Q3 2011, £570 million versus £608 million, driven by a 14% decrease in Non-Core Ulster Bank impairments. Core Ulster Bank impairments were broadly flat as lower losses on the corporate portfolio were offset by an increase in mortgage losses.
   
·
An additional impairment of £224 million was taken in Q4 2011 as a result of the continuing decline in the value of Greek sovereign bonds.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Group loan impairment losses fell 23% largely driven by a reduction in Non-Core impairment losses reflecting a reduction in Ulster Bank provisions in the quarter.
   
·
Total Ulster Bank loan impairment losses (Core and Non-Core) were £570 million in Q4 2011, compared with £1,159 million in Q4 2010, driven by the decrease in Non-Core impairments.
   
·
Loan impairment losses in R&C fell by £51 million, driven by improvements in UK Retail, US Retail & Commercial and Ulster Bank, partially offset by a single name provision in GTS and higher specific provisions in UK Corporate.
   
·
Provision coverage of risk elements in lending was 49% at the end of Q4 2011, compared with 47% a year earlier.

 
24

 

Analysis of results (continued)


Bank levy
The Finance Act 2011 introduced an annual bank levy in the UK.  The levy is collected through the existing quarterly Corporation Tax collection mechanism starting with payment dates on or after 19 July 2011.

The levy is based on the total chargeable equity and liabilities as reported in the balance sheet at the end of a chargeable period. The first chargeable period for the Group was the year ended 31 December 2011. In determining the chargeable equity and liabilities the following amounts are excluded: adjusted Tier 1 capital; certain “protected deposits” (for example those protected under the Financial Services Compensation Scheme); liabilities that arise from certain insurance business within banking groups; liabilities in respect of currency notes in circulation; Financial Services Compensation Scheme liabilities; liabilities representing segregated client money; and deferred tax liabilities, current tax liabilities, liabilities in respect of the levy, revaluation of property liabilities, liabilities representing the revaluation of business premises and defined benefit retirement liabilities. It is also permitted in specified circumstances to reduce certain liabilities: by netting them against certain assets; offsetting assets on the relevant balance sheets that would qualify as high quality liquid assets (in accordance with the FSA definition); and repo liabilities secured against sovereign and supranational debt.

The levy will be set at a rate of 0.088 per cent from 2012. Three different rates applied during 2011, these average to 0.075 per cent. Certain liabilities are subject to only a half rate, namely any deposits not otherwise excluded, (except for those from financial institutions and financial traders) and liabilities with a maturity greater than one year at the balance sheet date. The levy is not charged on the first £20 billion of chargeable liabilities. The cost of the levy to the Group for 2011 is £300 million (included in Other administrative expenses - see page 21). As the Group continues to target a reduction in wholesale funding, the cost should decline over time absent further rate increases.

 
25

 
 
Analysis of results (continued)


Capital resources and ratios
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
Core Tier 1 capital
£46bn 
£48bn 
£50bn 
Tier 1 capital
£57bn 
£58bn 
£60bn 
Total capital
£61bn 
£62bn 
£65bn 
Risk-weighted assets
     
  - gross
£508bn 
£512bn 
£571bn 
  - benefit of the Asset Protection Scheme
(£69bn)
(£89bn)
(£106bn)
Risk-weighted assets
£439bn 
£423bn 
£465bn 
Core Tier 1 ratio (1)
10.6%
11.3% 
10.7% 
Tier 1 ratio
13.0%
13.8% 
12.9% 
Total capital ratio
13.8%
14.7% 
14.0% 

Note:
(1)
The benefit of APS in Core Tier 1 ratio is 0.9% at 31 December 2011 (30 September 2011 - 1.3%; 31 December 2010 - 1.2%).

Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
The Group’s Core Tier 1 ratio remained strong at 10.6%. Core Tier 1 ratio fell 10 basis points compared with 2010, reflecting the PPI charge, the impairment taken on the Group’s AFS bond portfolio in relation to Greek sovereign bonds,  the bank levy and the implementation of CRD III.
   
·
Gross risk-weighted assets fell £63 billion, or 11% in 2011.  Net of the APS scheme the decline was £26 billion. The fall in risk-weighted assets was largely driven by Non-Core run-off and business exits, combined with specific actions taken in Non-Core to reduce capital intensive assets. These were partially offset by CRD III related uplifts which added £21 billion.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
The Core Tier 1 ratio declined 70 basis points versus Q3 2011, reflecting a £21 billion uplift in risk-weighted assets from the implementation of CRD III, along with the quarter’s attributable loss.
   
·
Gross risk-weighted assets were broadly flat on the previous quarter, with the CRD III related uplift offset by Non-Core risk-weighted assets reduction from run-off and restructuring activity.
   
·
The Q4 2011 capital relief from APS declined to 0.9%, versus 1.3% in Q3 2011, due to the significant decline in covered assets in Non-Core of £20 billion.

 
26

 

Analysis of results (continued)


Balance sheet
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
Funded balance sheet (1)
£977bn 
£1,035bn 
£1,026bn 
Total assets
£1,507bn 
£1,608bn 
£1,454bn 
Loans and advances to customers (2)
£454bn 
£486bn 
£503bn 
Customer deposits (3)
£414bn 
£434bn 
£429bn 
Loan:deposit ratio - Group (4)
110% 
112% 
118% 

Notes:
(1)
Funded balance sheet represents total assets less derivatives.
(2)
Excluding reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing.
(3)
Excluding repurchase agreements and stock lending.
(4)
Net of provisions. Including disposal groups, the loan:deposit ratio at 31 December 2011 was 108%.

Key points
·
Funded assets declined £58 billion in the quarter to close the year at £977 billion. GBM’s funded assets fell £35 billion in 2011, to £362 billion, with further reductions to circa £300 billion of funded assets targeted as RBS restructures its wholesale businesses. Non-Core funded assets fell by £11 billion in the quarter, £44 billion in the year, closing 2011 with funded assets of £94 billion, ahead of its revised target of £96 billion.
   
·
Loans and advances to customers were down 7% from Q3 2011. Loans and advances to customers, including disposal groups of £19 billion, were down 3% from Q3 2011, and down 7% from Q4 2010, largely reflecting run-off in Non-Core. Loans and advances in R&C were broadly flat in the year.
   
·
Customer deposits were down 5% from Q3 2011. Including disposal groups of £23 billion, customer deposits increased by £6 billion from Q4 2010. R&C deposits increased by £10 billion, 3%, from 2010, partially offset by a decrease in Non-Core as business disposals and country exits continued. Customer deposits also increased by £3 billion compared with Q3 2011, as UK Retail attracted £3 billion of new deposits and UK Corporate attracted £2 billion of new deposits, partially offset by reductions in GBM and Ulster Bank.
   
·
The Group loan:deposit ratio improved to 108% at 31 December 2011, a 900 basis point improvement from 31 December 2010. The Core loan:deposit ratio also improved to 94% compared with 96% a year earlier.

Further discussion of the Group’s liquidity and funding position is included on pages 141 to 150.

 
27

 
 

Divisional performance


The operating profit/(loss) of each division is shown below.

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Operating profit/(loss) by division
           
UK Retail
1,991 
1,372 
 
461 
499 
558 
UK Corporate
1,414 
1,463 
 
275 
301 
333 
Wealth
321 
304 
 
96 
71 
87 
Global Transaction Services
743 
1,088 
 
197 
195 
267 
Ulster Bank
(1,024)
(761)
 
(239)
(219)
(271)
US Retail & Commercial
479 
306 
 
157 
115 
64 
             
Retail & Commercial
3,924 
3,772 
 
947 
962 
1,038 
Global Banking & Markets
1,561 
3,364 
 
(95)
112 
527 
RBS Insurance
454 
(295)
 
125 
123 
(9)
Central items
156 
577 
 
85 
67 
115 
             
Core
6,095 
7,418 
 
1,062 
1,264 
1,671 
Non-Core
(4,203)
(5,505)
 
(1,308)
(997)
(1,616)
             
Managed basis
1,892 
1,913 
 
(246)
267 
55 
Reconciling items
           
Fair value of own debt
1,846 
174 
 
(370)
2,357 
582 
Asset Protection Scheme
(906)
(1,550)
 
(209)
(60)
(725)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
 
Sovereign debt impairment
(1,099)
 
(224)
(142)
Amortisation of purchased intangible assets
(222)
(369)
 
(53)
(69)
(96)
Integration and restructuring costs
(1,064)
(1,032)
 
(478)
(233)
(299)
Gain/(loss) on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
(1)
Strategic disposals
(104)
171 
 
(82)
(49)
502 
Bank levy
(300)
 
(300)
Other
(214)
(259)
 
(13)
(68)
(27)
             
Statutory basis
(766)
(399)
 
(1,976)
2,004 
(8)


 
27

 
Divisional performance (continued)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Impairment losses/(recoveries)
  by division
           
UK Retail
788 
1,160 
 
191 
195 
222 
UK Corporate
785 
761 
 
234 
228 
219 
Wealth
25 
18 
 
13 
Global Transaction Services
166 
 
47 
45 
Ulster Bank
1,384 
1,161 
 
327 
327 
376 
US Retail & Commercial
325 
517 
 
65 
84 
105 
             
Retail & Commercial
3,473 
3,626 
 
877 
883 
931 
Global Banking & Markets
49 
151 
 
68 
(32)
(5)
Central items
(2)
 
(4)
             
Core
3,520 
3,780 
 
941 
854 
930 
Non-Core
3,919 
5,476 
 
751 
682 
1,211 
             
Group impairment losses
7,439 
9,256 
 
1,692 
1,536 
2,141 



 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
 
             
Net interest margin by division
           
UK Retail
3.92 
3.91 
 
3.75 
3.90 
4.05 
UK Corporate
2.58 
2.51 
 
2.55 
2.48 
2.55 
Wealth
3.59 
3.37 
 
3.86 
3.46 
3.29 
Global Transaction Services
5.52 
6.73 
 
5.29 
5.33 
6.14 
Ulster Bank
1.77 
1.84 
 
1.81 
1.85 
1.77 
US Retail & Commercial
3.06 
2.85 
 
3.03 
3.09 
3.00 
             
Retail & Commercial
3.21 
3.14 
 
3.17 
3.19 
3.21 
Global Banking & Markets
0.73 
1.05 
 
0.76 
0.71 
0.93 
Non-Core
0.64 
1.16 
 
0.31 
0.43 
1.09 
             
Group net interest margin
1.92 
2.06 
 
1.84 
1.84 
 


 
28

 
Divisional performance (continued)

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Risk-weighted assets by division
           
UK Retail
48.4 
48.7 
(1%)
 
48.8 
(1%)
UK Corporate
76.1 
75.7 
1% 
 
81.4 
(7%)
Wealth
12.9 
13.0 
(1%)
 
12.5 
3% 
Global Transaction Services
17.3 
18.6 
(7%)
 
18.3 
(5%)
Ulster Bank
36.3 
34.4 
6% 
 
31.6 
15% 
US Retail & Commercial
58.8 
56.5 
4% 
 
57.0 
3% 
             
Retail & Commercial
249.8 
246.9 
1% 
 
249.6 
Global Banking & Markets
151.1 
134.3 
13% 
 
146.9 
3% 
Other
10.8 
9.8 
10% 
 
18.0 
(40%)
             
Core
411.7 
391.0 
5% 
 
414.5 
(1%)
Non-Core
93.3 
117.9 
(21%)
 
153.7 
(39%)
             
Group before benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
505.0 
508.9 
(1%)
 
568.2 
(11%)
Benefit of Asset Protection Scheme
(69.1)
(88.6)
(22%)
 
(105.6)
(35%)
             
Group before RFS Holdings
  minority interest
435.9 
420.3 
4% 
 
462.6 
(6%)
RFS Holdings minority interest
3.1 
3.0 
3% 
 
2.9 
7% 
             
Group
439.0 
423.3 
4% 
 
465.5 
(6%)

For the purposes of the divisional return on equity ratios, notional equity has been calculated as a percentage of the monthly average of divisional risk-weighted assets, adjusted for capital deductions. Currently, 9% has been applied to the Retail & Commercial divisions and 10% to Global Banking & Markets. However, these will be subject to modification as the final Basel III rules and ICB recommendations are considered.

Employee numbers by division (full time equivalents in continuing operations rounded to the nearest hundred)
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
       
UK Retail
27,700 
27,900 
28,200 
UK Corporate
13,500 
13,600 
13,100 
Wealth
5,700 
5,600 
5,200 
Global Transaction Services
2,600 
2,700 
2,600 
Ulster Bank
4,200 
4,400 
4,200 
US Retail & Commercial
15,200 
15,300 
15,700 
       
Retail & Commercial
68,900 
69,500 
69,000 
Global Banking & Markets
17,000 
18,900 
18,700 
RBS Insurance
14,900 
15,200 
14,500 
Group Centre
6,200 
6,100 
4,700 
       
Core
107,000 
109,700 
106,900 
Non-Core
4,700 
5,300 
6,900 
       
 
111,700 
115,000 
113,800 
Business Services
34,000 
34,200 
34,400 
Integration and restructuring
1,100 
1,100 
300 
       
Group
146,800 
150,300 
148,500 


 
29

 
UK Retail

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
4,272 
4,078 
 
1,036 
1,074 
1,088 
             
Net fees and commissions
1,066 
1,100 
 
242 
259 
316 
Other non-interest income
140 
322 
 
35 
33 
86 
             
Non-interest income
1,206 
1,422 
 
277 
292 
402 
             
Total income
5,478 
5,500 
 
1,313 
1,366 
1,490 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(839)
(889)
 
(200)
(206)
(208)
  - other
(437)
(480)
 
(116)
(102)
(71)
Indirect expenses
(1,423)
(1,514)
 
(345)
(364)
(400)
             
 
(2,699)
(2,883)
 
(661)
(672)
(679)
             
Insurance net claims
(85)
 
(31)
Impairment losses
(788)
(1,160)
 
(191)
(195)
(222)
             
Operating profit
1,991 
1,372 
 
461 
499 
558 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal advances
1,089 
993 
 
276 
260 
275 
Personal deposits
961 
1,102 
 
214 
236 
271 
Mortgages
2,277 
1,984 
 
577 
576 
557 
Cards
950 
962 
 
238 
231 
251 
Other, including bancassurance
201 
459 
 
63 
136 
             
Total income
5,478 
5,500 
 
1,313 
1,366 
1,490 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
182 
177 
 
32 
34 
30 
Personal
437 
682 
 
116 
120 
131 
Cards
169 
301 
 
43 
41 
61 
             
Total impairment losses
788 
1,160 
 
191 
195 
222 
             
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
0.2% 
0.2% 
 
0.1% 
0.1% 
0.1% 
Personal
4.3% 
5.8% 
 
4.6% 
4.7% 
4.5% 
Cards
3.0% 
4.9% 
 
3.0% 
2.9% 
4.0% 
             
Total
0.7% 
1.1% 
 
0.7% 
0.7% 
0.8% 


 
30

 
UK Retail (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
26.4% 
18.0% 
 
25.1% 
26.7% 
25.2% 
Net interest margin
3.92% 
3.91% 
 
3.75% 
3.90% 
4.05% 
Cost:income ratio
49% 
52% 
 
50% 
49% 
46% 
Adjusted cost:income ratio (2)
49% 
53% 
 
50% 
49% 
47% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (3)
           
  - mortgages
95.0 
94.2 
1% 
 
90.6 
5% 
  - personal
10.1 
10.3 
(2%)
 
11.7 
(14%)
  - cards
5.7 
5.6 
2% 
 
6.1 
(7%)
             
 
110.8 
110.1 
1% 
 
108.4 
2% 
Customer deposits (excluding
  bancassurance) (3)
101.9 
98.6 
3% 
 
96.1 
6% 
Assets under management (excluding
  deposits)
5.5 
5.6 
(2%)
 
5.7 
(4%)
Risk elements in lending (3)
4.6 
4.7 
(2%)
 
4.6 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
106% 
109% 
(300bp)
 
110% 
(400bp)
Risk-weighted assets
48.4 
48.7 
(1%) 
 
48.8 
(1%)

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
Adjusted cost:income ratio is based on total income after netting insurance claims and operating expenses.
(3)
Includes disposal groups: loans and advances to customers £7.3 billion; risk elements in lending £0.5 billion; customer deposits £8.8 billion.

Key points
In 2010, UK Retail set out an aspiration to become the UK’s most helpful bank and launched the Customer Charter.  In 2011, we made good progress on our Customer Charter commitments and the roll-out of innovation that actually helps customers. In December 2011, UK Retail refined its staff incentive scheme to further strengthen the role of customer service and to help build long lasting customer relationships.

Progress against the Customer Charter commitments is independently assessed and has shown encouraging results. By the end of 2011, we achieved the goal of serving 80% of our customers in less than 5 minutes in our busiest branches. Branch opening hours have also been extended and standardised, which means that our branches are now open for an additional 5,000 hours per week at times our customers have told us suit them.

Innovation has supported the delivery of Helpful Banking by focusing on solutions that make it easier for customers to bank with RBS and NatWest. An important example has been giving customers access to 24 hour emergency cash from NatWest and RBS ATMs when their cards are lost or stolen. We also updated our market-leading iPhone application and by the end of the year 1 million customers had downloaded the application. With successful apps also launched for iPad, Android and Blackberry, RBS is now the leading mobile bank in the UK.


 
31

 
UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

2011 compared with 2010
·
UK Retail delivered strong full year results, as operating profit increased by £619 million to £1,991 million, despite continued uncertainty in the economic climate and the low interest rate environment. Profit before impairments was up £247 million or 10%, while impairments fell by £372 million, with further improvements in the unsecured book and continued careful mortgage underwriting. Return on equity improved to 26.4%.
 
·
The division continued to focus on growing secured lending while at the same time building customer deposits, thereby reducing the Group’s reliance on wholesale funding. Loans and advances to customers grew 2%, with a change in mix from unsecured to secured as the Group actively sought to improve its risk profile. Mortgage balances grew by 5%, while unsecured lending contracted by 11%.
 
o    Mortgage growth reflected continued strong new business levels. Gross mortgage lending market share of 10% continues above our stock position of 8%.
 
o    Customer deposits grew 6%, outperforming the market total deposit growth of 3%.  Savings balances grew by £6 billion, or 9%, with 1.5 million accounts opened, demonstrating the strength of our customer franchise and our strategy to further develop primary banking relationships.
 
·
Net interest income increased by 5% to £4,272 million, driven by strong balance sheet growth. Net interest margin remained broadly flat with recovering asset margins largely offset by more competitive savings rates and lower long term swap rate returns adversely impacting liability margins.
   
·
Non-interest income declined 15% to £1,206 million, primarily driven by lower investment and protection income as a result of the dissolution of the bancassurance joint venture.  In addition, a number of changes have been made to support delivery of Helpful Banking, such as ‘Act Now’ text alerts, which have decreased fee income.
   
·
Overall expenses decreased by 6%, with the adjusted cost:income ratio improving from 53% to 49%.  Cost reductions were driven by a clear management focus on process re-engineering and operational efficiency together with benefits from the dissolution of the bancassurance joint venture, partly offset by higher inflation rates in utility and mail costs.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased 32% to £788 million reflecting the impact of a strengthened risk appetite, and a more stable economic environment.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets were broadly stable, with volume growth in lower risk secured mortgages partly offset by a decrease in the unsecured portfolio.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
UK Retail achieved strong deposit growth of £3.3 billion or 3% in the quarter, with competitive fixed rate bond and ISA offerings helping to deliver strong growth in savings balances. With interest rates falling and declining consumer activity, this strong deposit-gathering performance was balanced by narrowing liability margins and lower fee income, resulting in a 4% drop in income and operating profit of £461 million, £38 million lower than in the previous quarter.

 
32

 
UK Retail (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011 (continued)
·
Mortgage balances increased £0.8 billion and RBS’s share of gross new lending remained strong at 10% in the quarter, above its share of stock at 8%. Unsecured lending declined 1% as the Group continued to focus on lower risk secured lending. In conjunction with the strong deposit growth recorded during the quarter, this resulted in an improvement in the loan to deposit ratio to 106% from 109% in Q3 2011.
   
·
Net interest income fell 4%, £38 million, driven by the continued tightening of liability margins, with competitive pricing on savings balances and a continued decline in long-term swap rate returns on current accounts. Overall the net interest margin declined 15 basis points to 3.75%.
   
·
Non-interest income declined by 5%, £15 million, as subdued consumer spending activity continued to depress transaction volumes.
   
·
Overall expenses decreased by 2%, £11 million, with direct staff costs down 3%, £6 million, due to headcount reductions and lower staff compensation.  Indirect costs decreased by 5%, £19 million, driven by further cost saving initiatives linked to compensation costs and technology savings.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased by 2% or £4 million during the period.
 
 
Mortgage impairment losses were £32 million on a total book of £95 billion, £2 million lower than Q3 2011. Arrears rates were stable and remained below the Council of Mortgage Lenders industry average. Provision coverage levels remain stable.
 
 
The unsecured portfolio impairment charge of £159 million, on a book of almost £16 billion, was broadly flat. Default levels remained stable. Industry benchmarks for cards arrears remain stable, with RBS continuing to perform better than the market.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit decreased by £97 million, with income down 10%, costs down 3% and impairments 14% lower than in Q4 2010.
   
·
Net interest income was 5% lower, with strong mortgage and deposit balance growth more than offset by a reduction in net interest margin. Liability margins fell as a result of continued competitive pressure on new business savings margins and lower long term swap rate returns adversely impacting current account income.
   
·
Customer deposits were up 6%, with savings balances 9% higher, significantly outperforming the market. This strong deposit growth contributed to a reduction of the loan to deposit ratio from 110% to 106%.
   
·
Non-interest income declined by 31%, £125 million, largely driven by the dissolution of the bancassurance joint venture combined with lower spending and investment activity reflecting the general economic environment.
   
·
Overall expenses were 3% lower, despite increased charges relating to the Financial Services Compensation Scheme, reflecting continued implementation of process efficiencies and lower average staff compensation and benefits from the dissolution of the bancassurance joint venture.
   
·
Impairment losses decreased by 14%, £31 million, primarily reflecting improvements in default rates on the unsecured book.


 
33

 
UK Corporate

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
2,585 
2,572 
 
634 
621 
653 
             
Net fees and commissions
948 
952 
 
229 
244 
251 
Other non-interest income
327 
371 
 
62 
83 
79 
             
Non-interest income
1,275 
1,323 
 
291 
327 
330 
             
Total income
3,860 
3,895 
 
925 
948 
983 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(780)
(778)
 
(195)
(184)
(198)
  - other
(335)
(359)
 
(86)
(88)
(93)
Indirect expenses
(546)
(534)
 
(135)
(147)
(140)
             
 
(1,661)
(1,671)
 
(416)
(419)
(431)
             
Impairment losses
(785)
(761)
 
(234)
(228)
(219)
             
Operating profit
1,414 
1,463 
 
275 
301 
333 
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate and commercial lending
2,676 
2,598 
 
634 
647 
657 
Asset and invoice finance
660 
617 
 
169 
176 
166 
Corporate deposits
683 
728 
 
170 
172 
184 
Other
(159)
(48)
 
(48)
(47)
(24)
             
Total income
3,860 
3,895 
 
925 
948 
983 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Banks and financial institutions
20 
20 
 
(2)
12 
Hotels and restaurants
59 
52 
 
16 
22 
18 
Housebuilding and construction
103 
131 
 
27 
29 
47 
Manufacturing
34 
 
13 
(9)
Other
163 
127 
 
37 
36 
(12)
Private sector education, health, social work,
  recreational and community services
113 
30 
 
81 
20 
21 
Property
170 
245 
 
19 
82 
84 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
85 
91 
 
29 
24 
31 
Asset and invoice finance
38 
64 
 
14 
27 
             
Total impairment losses
785 
761 
 
234 
228 
219 


 
34

 
UK Corporate (continued)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) by sector
           
Banks and financial institutions
0.4% 
0.3% 
 
(0.1%)
0.4% 
0.8% 
Hotels and restaurants
1.0% 
0.8% 
 
1.0% 
1.4% 
1.1% 
Housebuilding and construction
2.6% 
2.9% 
 
2.8% 
2.9% 
4.2% 
Manufacturing
0.7% 
 
1.1% 
0.8% 
(0.7%)
Other
0.5% 
0.4% 
 
0.5% 
0.4% 
(0.2%)
Private sector education, health, social work,
  recreational and community services
1.3% 
0.3% 
 
3.7% 
0.9% 
0.9% 
Property
0.6% 
0.8% 
 
0.3% 
1.1% 
1.1% 
Wholesale and retail trade, repairs
1.0% 
0.9% 
 
1.4% 
1.1% 
1.3% 
Asset and invoice finance
0.4% 
0.6% 
 
0.5% 
1.1% 
             
Total
0.7% 
0.7% 
 
0.9% 
0.8% 
0.8% 

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
12.4% 
12.1% 
 
10.2% 
11.1% 
11.8% 
Net interest margin
2.58% 
2.51% 
 
2.55% 
2.48% 
2.55% 
Cost:income ratio
43% 
43% 
 
45% 
44% 
44% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
111.8 
112.7 
(1%)
 
114.6 
(2%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (2)
           
  - banks and financial institutions
5.7 
5.7 
 
6.1 
(7%)
  - hotels and restaurants
6.1 
6.3 
(3%)
 
6.8 
(10%)
  - housebuilding and construction
3.9 
4.0 
(3%)
 
4.5 
(13%)
  - manufacturing
4.6 
4.7 
(2%)
 
5.3 
(13%)
  - other
32.6 
32.6 
 
31.0 
5% 
  - private sector education, health, social
    work, recreational and community services
8.7 
8.7 
 
9.0 
(3%)
  - property
28.2 
29.0 
(3%)
 
29.5 
(4%)
  - wholesale and retail trade, repairs
8.5 
8.9 
(4%)
 
9.6 
(11%)
  - asset and invoice finance
10.4 
10.1 
3% 
 
9.9 
5% 
             
 
108.7 
110.0 
(1%)
 
111.7 
(3%)
             
Customer deposits (2)
100.9 
98.9 
2% 
 
100.0 
1% 
Risk elements in lending (2)
5.0 
4.9 
2% 
 
4.0 
25% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
106% 
109% 
(300bp)
 
110% 
(400bp)
Risk-weighted assets
76.1 
75.7 
1% 
 
81.4 
(7%)

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax, divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
Includes disposal groups: loans and advances to customers £12.2 billion; risk elements in lending £1.0 billion; customer deposits £21.8 billion.


 
35

 
UK Corporate (continued)

Key points
In 2011, UK Corporate focused on supporting its customers through challenging economic times.

As a result of over 5,000 hours of customer research, UK Corporate launched the ‘Ahead for Business’ promise to its small and medium-sized enterprise (SME) customers.

To deliver on this, the division launched a number of initiatives to improve the service it offers to customers. For example, the ‘Working with You’ initiative, has seen over 4,600 visits to customer businesses since its launch in Q2 2011.  Additionally, following the launch of the relationship manager accreditation programme, also in Q2 2011, almost all relationship managers have gained full accreditation in the initial phase.

UK Corporate continued to support new and existing businesses during 2011:

·
launching its best ever fixed rate loan product for SMEs;
   
·
reacting quickly after the August riots to give affected businesses access to special interest rate and fee free lending products;
   
·
answering over 4,000 calls on the Start-up Hotline, offering free advice and a complementary business plan review service; and
   
·
supporting more debt capital and loan market deals for larger corporates than any other bank

The division also took measures to reduce the risk retained in the business allowing for quicker and more consistent decisions by simplifying the credit underwriting process and improving automated decision making.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit decreased 3% to £1,414 million, as lower income and higher impairments were only partially offset by a decrease in expenses.
   
·
Net interest income remained broadly flat.  Net interest margin improved 7 basis points with  benefits from re-pricing the lending portfolio and the revision to income deferral assumptions in Q1 2011 partially offset by increased funding costs together with continued pressure on deposit margins.  A 1% increase in deposit balances supported an improvement in the loan to deposit ratio to 106%.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased by 4% as a result of lower GBM cross-sales and fee income, partially offset by increased Invoice Finance and Lombard income.
   
·
Excluding the £29 million OFT penalty in 2010, total costs increased by 1%, largely reflecting increased investment in the business and higher costs of managing the non-performing book.
   
·
Impairments of £785 million were 3% higher due to increased specific impairments and collectively assessed provisions, partially offset by lower latent loss provisions.

 
36

 
UK Corporate (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Operating profit of £275 million was 9% lower, with increased net interest income more than offset by higher impairments and lower non-interest income.
   
·
Net interest income rose by 2% and net interest margin by 7 basis points, with improved lending margins more than offsetting continued pressure on deposit margins.  Strong growth in customer deposits, up £2 billion or 2%, contributed to an improvement in the loan to deposit ratio from 109% to 106%.
   
·
Non-interest income fell by 11%, due to a number of valuation adjustments, including derivative close out costs associated with impaired assets.
   
·
Total costs decreased 1% due to lower indirect costs, partially offset by higher discretionary staff costs.
   
·
Impairment losses increased £6 million due to a small number of specific provisions, partially offset by an improvement in collectively assessed balances and latent provision releases.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit decreased 17%, driven by lower income and increased impairments.
   
·
Net interest income decreased 3%, impacted by higher funding and liquidity costs.  Excluding these costs of £39 million, income increased 1% with net interest margin up 11 basis points, reflecting the benefit from re-pricing the lending portfolio.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased 12%, largely driven by a number of valuation adjustments, including derivative close out costs associated with impaired assets.
   
·
Total costs decreased 3%, despite the higher operational costs of managing the non-performing book in Q4 2011, largely reflecting a decrease in staff incentive costs.
 
.
·
Impairment losses increased £15 million reflecting higher specific provisions.
 

 
 
37

 
Wealth

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
718 
609 
 
191 
178 
160 
             
Net fees and commissions
375 
376 
 
89 
95 
94 
Other non-interest income
84 
71 
 
23 
23 
17 
             
Non-interest income
459 
447 
 
112 
118 
111 
             
Total income
1,177 
1,056 
 
303 
296 
271 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(413)
(382)
 
(96)
(106)
(96)
  - other
(195)
(142)
 
(43)
(57)
(29)
Indirect expenses
(223)
(210)
 
(55)
(58)
(53)
             
 
(831)
(734)
 
(194)
(221)
(178)
             
Impairment losses
(25)
(18)
 
(13)
(4)
(6)
             
Operating profit
321 
304 
 
96 
71 
87 
             
Analysis of income
           
Private banking
975 
857 
 
255 
244 
220 
Investments
202 
199 
 
48 
52 
51 
             
Total income
1,177 
1,056 
 
303 
296 
271 

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
18.7% 
18.9% 
 
22.1% 
16.3% 
21.0% 
Net interest margin
3.59% 
3.37% 
 
3.86% 
3.46% 
3.29% 
Cost:income ratio
71% 
70% 
 
64% 
75% 
66% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
8.3 
8.3 
 
7.8 
6% 
  - personal
6.9 
7.2 
(4%)
 
6.7 
3% 
  - other
1.7 
1.5 
13% 
 
1.6 
6% 
             
 
16.9 
17.0 
(1%)
 
16.1 
5% 
Customer deposits (2)
38.2 
37.4 
2% 
 
37.1 
3% 
Assets under management (excluding
  deposits) (2)
30.9 
29.9 
3% 
 
33.9 
(9%)
Risk elements in lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos) (2)
44% 
45% 
(100bp)
 
43% 
100bp 
Risk-weighted assets
12.9 
13.0 
(1%)
 
12.5 
3% 

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
31 December 2010 comparatives were revised in Q3 2011 to reflect the current reporting methodology.


 
38

 
Wealth (continued)

Key points
2011 has been a significant year for the Coutts businesses from a strategic perspective. In Q1 2011, a new divisional strategy was defined with the execution of early changes already making an impact.

Key strategic changes in 2011 included:
·
A refreshed Coutts brand bringing Coutts UK and RBS Coutts under one single contemporary brand.
   
·
A refocus on territories where the businesses have the opportunity for greatest scale or growth such as UK, Asia, Middle East, and Eastern Europe.
   
·
Further development of client propositions as well as the portfolio of products and services for key international markets.
   
·
Strategic investment in technology leading to the development of a single global technology platform for the Wealth division. The platform was successfully deployed in Adam & Company in 2011 with Coutts UK to follow in 2012.
   
·
Strengthening the connectivity between Wealth and other Group divisions including referrals in international jurisdictions and improved connectivity with UK Corporate.
   
·
Continued activity to ensure the division responds to new or expected regulatory changes with proactive solution design and preparation.
   
·
Injection of new management into key roles from both internal and external sources including key segment heads, marketing, products & services, and international executive leadership.

Following the establishment of a single global brand in Q4 2011, focus turned to the reorganisation of key global functions such as marketing and product & services, as well as some local management structures. These reorganisations have realigned the division to maximise execution of the divisional strategy.

The execution plan for the strategy will continue into 2012 and position Wealth strongly against its peers.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit increased by 6% on 2010 to £321 million, driven by a 11% growth in income partially offset by increases in expenses and impairments.
   
·
Income increased by £121 million with a 24 basis points improvement in lending margins, strong treasury income and increases in lending and deposit volumes. Non-interest income rose 3%, with investment income growing 2% despite turbulent market conditions.
   
·
Expenses increased by £97 million, largely driven by adverse foreign exchange movements and headcount growth to service the increased revenue base.  Additional strategic investment in technology enhancement, rebranding and programmes to support regulatory change also contributed to the increase.
   
·
Client assets and liabilities managed by the division decreased by 1%. Customer deposits grew 3% in a competitive environment and lending volumes grew 5%. Assets under management declined 9%, with fund outflows contributing 3% of the decrease and market conditions making up the balance.


 
39

 
Wealth (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Operating profit increased 35% to £96 million in the quarter with a small increase in income and lower expenses partially offset by a rise in impairments.
   
·
Income increased 2% in Q4 2011 with a 7% increase in net interest income partially offset by a 5% decline in non-interest income. The growth in net interest income reflects continued growth in lending margins and strong treasury income. Non-interest income declined with turbulent market conditions resulting in a decrease in investment and brokerage income.
   
·
Expenses decreased 12% largely driven by a decrease in Financial Services Compensation Scheme levies and lower incentive costs, assisted by a favourable movement in exchange rates.
   
·
Client assets and liabilities managed by the division increased by 2%. Lending volumes were stable and deposit volumes increased 2%, primarily in the UK, as result of a successful fixed term deposit campaign. Assets under management grew 3% with stable net new business and positive market movements.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit increased 10% with a 12% growth in income partially offset by higher expenses and impairments.
   
·
Income increased due to a 19% rise in net interest income with a 57 basis points improvement in net interest margin reflecting strong treasury income, higher lending margins and growth in deposit volumes. Non-interest income increased 1%.
   
·
Expenses rose 9% reflecting adverse movements in exchange rates and continued investment in private banker recruitment, strategic initiatives and regulatory project spend.




 
40

 

Global Transaction Services

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,076 
974 
 
277 
276 
263 
Non-interest income
1,175 
1,587 
 
296 
300 
375 
             
Total income
2,251 
2,561 
 
573 
576 
638 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(375)
(411)
 
(95)
(89)
(105)
  - other
(113)
(159)
 
(26)
(26)
(51)
Indirect expenses
(854)
(894)
 
(208)
(221)
(212)
             
 
(1,342)
(1,464)
 
(329)
(336)
(368)
             
Impairment losses
(166)
(9)
 
(47)
(45)
(3)
             
Operating profit
743 
1,088 
 
197 
195 
267 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Domestic cash management
866 
818 
 
221 
216 
207 
International cash management
868 
801 
 
222 
220 
223 
Trade finance
318 
309 
 
77 
90 
81 
Merchant acquiring
16 
451 
 
80 
Commercial cards
183 
182 
 
48 
46 
47 
             
Total income
2,251 
2,561 
 
573 
576 
638 

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
30.4% 
42.8% 
 
33.0% 
31.0% 
42.7% 
Net interest margin
5.52% 
6.73% 
 
5.29% 
5.33% 
6.14% 
Cost:income ratio
60% 
57% 
 
57% 
58% 
58% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
25.9 
29.9 
(13%)
 
25.2 
3% 
Loans and advances
15.8 
19.5 
(19%)
 
14.4 
10% 
Customer deposits
71.7 
71.4 
 
69.9 
3% 
Risk elements in lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.1 
100% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
22% 
28% 
(600bp)
 
21% 
100bp 
Risk-weighted assets
17.3 
18.6 
(7%)
 
18.3 
(5%)

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

 
41

 
Global Transaction Services (continued)

Key points
In Q4 2011, Global Transaction Services (GTS) maintained operating profit levels with continued focus on cost management and an improved funding contribution.

GTS recognises the important role international trade plays in a strong global economy and throughout 2011 the division supported UK companies, both in the UK and overseas, to do more business internationally.  This support included delivering a series of UK Government-backed ‘Doing Business in Asia’ events.

During the year, GTS invested in improving existing products and services and also in developing new ones.  To help corporate treasurers manage their global positions, the division launched a global Liquidity Solutions Portal, giving its customers a view of their operational and investment balances and rates all in one place, improving transparency, and enabling them to execute and redeem investments effectively.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit was down 32%, partly reflecting the sale of Global Merchant Services (GMS) which completed on 30 November 2010. Adjusting for the disposal, operating profit decreased 16%, driven by an impairment provision on a single name in 2011.
   
·
Excluding GMS income of £451 million, income was 7% higher driven by the success of deposit-gathering initiatives, as deposits increased £2 billion in a competitive environment.
   
·
Excluding GMS expenses of £244 million, expenses increased by 10%, reflecting business improvement initiatives and investment in technology and support infrastructure.
   
·
Impairment losses increased to £166 million compared with £9 million in 2010 reflecting a single name impairment.
   
·
For the eleven months in 2010 before completion of the disposal, GMS generated income of £451 million, total expenses of £244 million and an operating profit of £207 million.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Operating profit was in line with Q3 2011 reflecting resilient income and slightly higher impairment charges, offset by lower expenses.
   
·
Income fell by 1% as a result of seasonally lower trade finance activity.
   
·
Total expenses fell by 2% largely driven by a reduction in technology and infrastructure support costs, partially offset by lower discretionary staff costs in Q3 2011.
   
·
Q4 2011 impairment losses of £47 million, up 4%, largely related to additional provisioning on an existing single name impairment.
   
·
Customer deposits held up well in a competitive environment despite the adverse effect of a weakened Euro exchange rate.
   
·
Third party assets decreased 13% as a result of reduced trade finance activity and the positive impact of balance sheet efficiency initiatives.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets fell 7%, primarily benefitting from lower loans and advances.


 
42

 
Global Transaction Services (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit was down 26%, driven by a provision on a single name in 2011. Adjusting for the sale of GMS, which completed on 30 November 2010 with an operating profit of £207 million, operating profit decreased 17%.
   
·
Excluding GMS income of £451 million, income increased by 3%, driven by strong deposit gathering initiatives. Excluding GMS expenses of £244 million, expenses increased by 3%, reflecting business improvement initiatives and investment in technology and support infrastructure.
   
·
In the two months in Q4 2010 before completion of the disposal, GMS recorded income of £80 million, total expenses of £50 million and an operating profit of £30 million.


 
43

 
Ulster Bank

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
696 
761 
 
171 
185 
187 
             
Net fees and commissions
142 
156 
 
28 
41 
40 
Other non-interest income
69 
58 
 
21 
19 
16 
             
Non-interest income
211 
214 
 
49 
60 
56 
             
Total income
907 
975 
 
220 
245 
243 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(221)
(237)
 
(53)
(55)
(57)
  - other
(67)
(74)
 
(15)
(17)
(17)
Indirect expenses
(259)
(264)
 
(64)
(65)
(64)
             
 
(547)
(575)
 
(132)
(137)
(138)
             
Impairment losses
(1,384)
(1,161)
 
(327)
(327)
(376)
             
Operating loss
(1,024)
(761)
 
(239)
(219)
(271)
             
             
Analysis of income by business
           
Corporate
435 
521 
 
98 
107 
122 
Retail
428 
465 
 
101 
116 
124 
Other
44 
(11)
 
21 
22 
(3)
             
Total income
907 
975 
 
220 
245 
243 
             
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Mortgages
570 
294 
 
133 
126 
159 
Corporate
           
  - property
324 
375 
 
83 
78 
69 
  - other corporate
434 
444 
 
100 
111 
135 
Other lending
56 
48 
 
11 
12 
13 
             
Total impairment losses
1,384 
1,161 
 
327 
327 
376 
             
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) by sector
           
Mortgages
2.8% 
1.4% 
 
2.7% 
2.4% 
3.0% 
Corporate
           
  - property
6.8% 
6.9% 
 
6.9% 
6.1% 
5.1% 
  - other corporate
5.6% 
4.9% 
 
5.2% 
5.4% 
6.0% 
Other lending
3.5% 
3.7% 
 
2.8% 
3.2% 
4.0% 
             
Total
4.1% 
3.1% 
 
3.8% 
3.7% 
4.1% 


 
44

 
Ulster Bank (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
(26.1%)
(21.0%)
 
(23.3%)
(21.2%)
(29.8%)
Net interest margin
1.77% 
1.84% 
 
1.81% 
1.85% 
1.77% 
Cost:income ratio
60% 
59% 
 
60% 
56% 
57% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - mortgages
20.0 
20.7 
(3%)
 
21.2 
(6%)
  - corporate
           
     - property
4.8 
5.1 
(6%)
 
5.4 
(11%)
     - other corporate
7.7 
8.2 
(6%)
 
9.0 
(14%)
  - other lending
1.6 
1.5 
7% 
 
1.3 
23% 
             
 
34.1 
35.5 
(4%)
 
36.9 
(8%)
Customer deposits
21.8 
23.4 
(7%)
 
23.1 
(6%)
Risk elements in lending
           
  - mortgages
2.2 
2.1 
5% 
 
1.5 
47% 
  - corporate
           
     - property
1.3 
1.5 
(13%)
 
0.7 
86% 
     - other corporate
1.8 
1.8 
 
1.2 
50% 
  - other lending
0.2 
0.2 
 
0.2 
             
Total risk elements in lending
5.5 
5.6 
(2%)
 
3.6 
53% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
143% 
141% 
200bp 
 
152% 
(900bp)
Risk-weighted assets
36.3 
34.4 
6% 
 
31.6 
15% 
             
Spot exchange rate - €/£
1.196 
1.162 
   
1.160 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating loss after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
 
Key points
2011 was another difficult year for the business due to the continued challenging economic environment. This was reflected in the financial performance, with ongoing pressure on income and a further increase in impairment losses.

Ulster Bank continues to make progress on its customer commitments and deposit gathering strategy, while cost management and targeting growth in areas that leverage competitive advantage, remain priorities.  In 2011, customer numbers increased by 2%, representing a strong performance in current and savings accounts, driven by the enhanced customer service highlighted by our 'Help for what matters' programme.

Following a review of the cost base and operating model, 950 proposed job losses were announced in January 2012, the majority of which are expected by the end of 2012. This decision is a necessary part of the changes required to build a stronger sustainable business for the future.

 
45

 
Ulster Bank (continued)

Key points (continued)

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit before impairment losses decreased by £40 million in 2011 with lower income partially mitigated by cost savings. Impairment losses of £1,384 million increased by 19% from 2010 resulting in an operating loss of £1,024 million, 35% higher than 2010.
   
·
Income fell by 7% driven by a contracting performing loan book coupled with higher funding costs. Loans and advances to customers decreased by 8% during 2011.
   
·
Expenses fell by 5% reflecting tight management of the cost base across the business.
   
·
Impairment losses increased by 19% largely reflecting the deterioration in credit metrics on the mortgage portfolio driven by a combination of higher debt flow and further fall in asset prices.
   
·
Despite intense competition, retail and small business deposit balances have grown strongly throughout 2011, driven by the benefits of a focused deposit gathering strategy.  However, total customer deposit balances fell by 6% largely driven by the outflow of wholesale customer balances due to rating downgrades.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets increased by 15% in 2011 reflecting the deterioration in credit risk metrics.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Operating loss for the quarter increased by £20 million to £239 million largely as higher funding costs in both wholesale and deposit markets continue to outweigh the impact of loan re-pricing initiatives and tight expense management.
   
·
Net interest income decreased by £14 million driven by a reduction in income earning assets coupled with an increase in funding costs. Customer loan balances reduced by 4%, reflecting amortisation of the loan book, which continued to exceed new business volume growth. Net interest margin declined by 4 basis points in the quarter to 1.81%, with the decrease in income partly offset by lower asset balances.
   
·
Non-interest income fell by £11 million largely due to a one-off foreign exchange gain in Q3 2011.
   
·
Expenses remained broadly flat in the quarter, but continued focus on cost management is driving towards a declining trend.
   
·
Impairment losses were flat, with lower losses on the corporate portfolio offset by an increase in mortgage losses.
   
·
Customer deposit balances decreased by 7% reflecting an outflow of wholesale balances due to rating downgrades.


 
46

 
Ulster Bank (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating loss was £32 million lower primarily driven by a decrease in impairment charges on both the mortgage and corporate portfolios.
   
·
Net interest income fell by 9%, reflecting the impact of a reducing loan book coupled with higher funding costs. Net interest margin increased by 4 basis points primarily driven by progress made on initiatives to improve customer loan margins during 2011.
   
·
Non-interest income decreased by 13%, partially reflecting the loss of income from the merchant services business disposed of in Q4 2010.
   
·
Expenses were broadly flat with an 8% fall in direct expenses.


 
47

 
US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
1,896 
1,917 
 
493 
483 
467 
             
Net fees and commissions
709 
729 
 
164 
190 
169 
Other non-interest income
295 
300 
 
94 
67 
62 
             
Non-interest income
1,004 
1,029 
 
258 
257 
231 
             
Total income
2,900 
2,946 
 
751 
740 
698 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(819)
(784)
 
(211)
(206)
(204)
  - other
(544)
(569)
 
(133)
(152)
(124)
Indirect expenses
(733)
(770)
 
(185)
(183)
(201)
             
 
(2,096)
(2,123)
 
(529)
(541)
(529)
Impairment losses
(325)
(517)
 
(65)
(84)
(105)
             
Operating profit
479 
306 
 
157 
115 
64 
             
             
Average exchange rate - US$/£
1.604 
1.546 
 
1.573 
1.611 
1.581 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
464 
509 
 
128 
119 
128 
Personal lending and cards
420 
476 
 
94 
111 
113 
Retail deposits
918 
903 
 
235 
236 
206 
Commercial lending
580 
580 
 
147 
149 
141 
Commercial deposits
292 
320 
 
76 
75 
75 
Other
226 
158 
 
71 
50 
35 
             
Total income
2,900 
2,946 
 
751 
740 
698 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
35 
58 
 
Home equity
99 
126 
 
19 
29 
26 
Corporate and commercial
54 
202 
 
54 
Other consumer
57 
97 
 
17 
11 
Securities
80 
34 
 
12 
30 
16 
             
Total impairment losses
325 
517 
 
65 
84 
105 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.6% 
1.0% 
 
0.6% 
0.5% 
0.2% 
Home equity
0.7% 
0.8% 
 
0.5% 
0.8% 
0.7% 
Corporate and commercial
0.2% 
1.0% 
 
0.1% 
0.1% 
1.1% 
Other consumer
0.8% 
1.4% 
 
0.9% 
0.7% 
0.3% 
             
Total
0.5% 
1.0% 
 
0.4% 
0.4% 
0.7% 



 
48

 
US Retail & Commercial (£ Sterling) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
6.3% 
3.6% 
 
8.0% 
6.0% 
3.3% 
Net interest margin
3.06% 
2.85% 
 
3.03% 
3.09% 
3.00% 
Cost:income ratio
72% 
72% 
 
70% 
73% 
76% 


 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
74.5 
72.9 
2% 
 
71.2 
5% 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
6.1 
5.9 
3% 
 
6.1 
  - home equity
14.9 
14.9 
 
15.2 
(2%)
  - corporate and commercial
22.8 
22.1 
3% 
 
20.4 
12% 
  - other consumer
7.6 
6.6 
15% 
 
6.9 
10% 
             
 
51.4 
49.5 
4% 
 
48.6 
6% 
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
59.5 
58.5 
2% 
 
58.7 
1% 
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
0.6 
0.6 
 
0.4 
50% 
  - commercial
0.4 
0.4 
 
0.5 
(20%)
             
Total risk elements in lending
1.0 
1.0 
 
0.9 
11% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
85% 
83% 
200bp 
 
81% 
400bp 
Risk-weighted assets
58.8 
56.5 
4% 
 
57.0 
3% 
             
Spot exchange rate - US$/£
1.548 
1.562 
   
1.552 
 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
·
Sterling weakened relative to the US dollar during the fourth quarter, with the average exchange rate decreasing by 2% compared with Q3 2011.
   
·
Performance is described in full in the US dollar-based financial statements set out on pages 50 and 51.


 
49

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
$m 
$m 
 
$m 
$m 
$m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
3,042 
2,962 
 
777 
778 
739 
             
Net fees and commissions
1,138 
1,126 
 
258 
306 
267 
Other non-interest income
473 
465 
 
148 
109 
100 
             
Non-interest income
1,611 
1,591 
 
406 
415 
367 
             
Total income
4,653 
4,553 
 
1,183 
1,193 
1,106 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(1,313)
(1,212)
 
(331)
(332)
(322)
  - other
(874)
(880)
 
(211)
(245)
(197)
Indirect expenses
(1,176)
(1,189)
 
(291)
(295)
(317)
             
 
(3,363)
(3,281)
 
(833)
(872)
(836)
             
Impairment losses
(521)
(799)
 
(101)
(136)
(168)
             
Operating profit
769 
473 
 
249 
185 
102 
             
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Mortgages and home equity
744 
786 
 
202 
192 
201 
Personal lending and cards
673 
735 
 
147 
179 
179 
Retail deposits
1,474 
1,397 
 
370 
381 
329 
Commercial lending
931 
896 
 
232 
240 
223 
Commercial deposits
469 
495 
 
120 
121 
119 
Other
362 
244 
 
112 
80 
55 
             
Total income
4,653 
4,553 
 
1,183 
1,193 
1,106 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Residential mortgages
56 
90 
 
14 
12 
Home equity
160 
194 
 
29 
48 
40 
Corporate and commercial
87 
312 
 
13 
11 
87 
Other consumer
92 
150 
 
26 
17 
11 
Securities
126 
53 
 
19 
48 
25 
             
Total impairment losses
521 
799 
 
101 
136 
168 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) by sector
           
Residential mortgages
0.6% 
1.0% 
 
0.6% 
0.5% 
0.2% 
Home equity
0.7% 
0.8% 
 
0.5% 
0.8% 
0.7% 
Corporate and commercial
0.2% 
1.0% 
 
0.1% 
0.1% 
1.1% 
Other consumer
0.8% 
1.4% 
 
0.9% 
0.7% 
0.4% 
             
Total
0.5% 
1.0% 
 
0.4% 
0.5% 
0.8% 


 
50

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
6.3% 
3.6% 
 
8.0% 
6.0% 
3.3% 
Net interest margin
3.06% 
2.85% 
 
3.03% 
3.09% 
3.00% 
Cost:income ratio
72% 
72% 
 
70% 
73% 
76% 

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
$bn 
$bn 
Change 
 
$bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets
115.3 
113.8 
1% 
 
110.5 
4% 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
           
  - residential mortgages
9.4 
9.1 
3% 
 
9.4 
  - home equity
23.1 
23.3 
(1%)
 
23.6 
(2%)
  - corporate and commercial
35.3 
34.5 
2% 
 
31.7 
11% 
  - other consumer
11.8 
10.4 
13% 
 
10.6 
11% 
             
 
79.6 
77.3 
3% 
 
75.3 
6% 
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
92.1 
91.3 
1% 
 
91.2 
1% 
Risk elements in lending
           
  - retail
1.0 
0.9 
11% 
 
0.7 
43% 
  - commercial
0.6 
0.6 
 
0.7 
(14%)
             
Total risk elements in lending
1.6 
1.5 
7% 
 
1.4 
14% 
Loan:deposit ratio (excluding repos)
85% 
83% 
200bp 
 
81% 
400bp 
Risk-weighted assets
91.1 
88.2 
3% 
 
88.4 
3% 

Note:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 9% of monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).

Key points
US R&C continued to focus on its back-to-basics strategy, with good progress made in developing the division’s customer franchise during 2011. The bank continued to re-energise the franchise through new branding, product development and competitive pricing.

To strengthen retail alignment and improve efficiencies, US R&C formed a consolidated Consumer Banking division by combining management of the retail banking franchise with the consumer lending division during H2 2011. This continued focus on alignment is expected to further contribute to the improved penetration of loan products to deposit households, which has already increased in ten consecutive quarters. The penetration of on-line banking customers, a key indicator of customer retention, also continued to improve during 2011.

To enhance the customer experience, in Q4 2011, Consumer Banking introduced four core Customer Commitments, built around feedback received from customers in Massachusetts. In Q1 2012, the Commitments will be rolled out to Citizens Financial Group’s (CFG’s) entire branch footprint.

 
51

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)
Significant organisational changes and investment in Commercial Banking, including unification under the RBS Citizens brand, has been important in positioning the business for growth. The enhanced sales training programme for managers and sales colleagues in this business has begun to deliver results with both higher credit balances and increased client satisfaction.  External researchers TNS awarded Citizens the second highest score in relationship manager satisfaction among its competitors for 2011.

Risk management was also an important focus for 2011 and in Q4 2011, CFG’s Board of directors approved a new formal risk appetite statement aimed at ensuring sustained predictable earnings and further strengthening the control environment.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit increased to £479 million ($769 million) from £306 million ($473 million), an increase of £173 million ($296 million), or 56%.  Excluding a credit of £73 million ($113 million) related to changes to the defined benefit plan in Q2 2010, operating profit increased £246 million ($409 million), or 106%, substantially driven by lower impairments and improved income.
   
·
The macroeconomic operating environment remained challenging, with low rates, high unemployment, a soft housing market, sluggish consumer activity and the continuing impact of legislative changes including the Durbin Amendment in the Dodd-Frank Act which became effective on 1 October 2011.
   
·
The Durbin Amendment lowers the allowable interchange on debit transactions to $0.23-$0.24 per transaction. The current annualised impact of the Durbin Amendment is estimated at £94 million ($150 million).
   
·
Net interest income was down £21 million, or 1% (up $80 million in US dollar terms).  Net interest margin improved by 21 basis points to 3.06% reflecting changes in deposit mix, continued discipline around deposit pricing and the positive impact from the balance sheet restructuring programme carried out during Q3 2010 combined with strong commercial loan growth, partially offset by run-off of consumer loans.
   
·
Non-interest income was down £25 million (up $20 million in US dollar terms), or 1%. The increase in US dollars primarily driven by higher account and transaction fees, partially offset by the impact of legislative changes on debit card and deposit fees.
   
·
Excluding the defined benefit plan credit of £73 million ($113 million) in Q2 2010, total expenses were down £100 million ($31 million), or 5%, due to a number of factors including lower Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) deposit insurance levies, and lower litigation and marketing costs, partially offset by higher regulatory costs.
   
·
Impairment losses declined by £192 million ($278 million), or 37%, largely reflecting an improved credit environment slightly offset by higher impairments related to securities.  Loan impairments as a percent of loans and advances improved to 0.5% from 1.0%.
   
·
Customer deposits were up 1% with particularly strong growth achieved in checking balances.  Consumer checking balances grew by 6%, while small business checking balances grew by 5% over the year.


 
52

 
US Retail & Commercial (US Dollar) (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
US Retail & Commercial posted an operating profit of £157 million ($249 million) compared with £115 million ($185 million) in the prior quarter, an increase of £42 million ($64 million), or 37%, driven by a decrease in expenses and impairments.
   
·
Net interest income was £493 million ($777 million) compared with £483 million ($778 million) in the prior quarter. Loans and advances were up £2 billion ($2 billion), or 4%, from the previous quarter partially due to strong growth in commercial loan volumes partly offset by some continued planned run-off of long term fixed rate consumer products.
   
·
Non-interest income was in line with the previous quarter, reflecting lower debit card fees impacted by legislative changes within the Durbin Amendment.
   
·
Total expenses were down £12 million ($39 million), or 2%, reflecting lower mortgage servicing rights impairment and FDIC deposit insurance levies.
   
·
Impairment losses were down £19 million ($35 million), or 22%, reflecting lower impairments related to securities. Loan impairments as a percent of loans and advances improved slightly to 0.4% from 0.5%.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit increased to £157 million ($249 million) from £64 million ($102 million), an increase of £93 million ($147 million), or 145%, substantially driven by lower impairments and improved income.
   
·
Net interest income was up £26 million ($38 million), or 6%.  Net interest margin improved by 3 basis points to 3.03% reflecting changes in deposit mix and continued discipline around deposit pricing combined with strong commercial loan growth partially offset by run-off of consumer loans.
   
·
Non-interest income was up £27 million ($39 million), or 12%, reflecting securities gains. Higher account and transaction fees as a result of new pricing initiatives, were offset by lower debit card fees.
   
·
Total expenses were broadly in line with Q4 2010 reflecting a positive movement on the valuation of mortgage servicing rights in Q4 2010, not repeated in Q4 2011, and higher costs related to regulatory challenges, offset by lower litigation costs.
   
·
Impairment losses declined by £40 million ($67 million), or 38%, reflecting an improved credit environment.  Loan impairments as a percentage of loans and advances improved to 0.4% from 0.8%.



 
53

 
Global Banking & Markets

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income from banking activities
707 
1,252 
 
171 
171 
225 
Funding cost of rental assets
(42)
(37)
 
(12)
(10)
(11)
             
Net interest income
665 
1,215 
 
159 
161 
214 
             
Net fees and commissions receivable
1,049 
1,283 
 
188 
222 
381 
Income from trading activities
4,735 
5,218 
 
395 
1,892 
957 
Other operating income
(508)
196 
 
170 
(1,176)
35 
             
Non-interest income
5,276 
6,697 
 
753 
938 
1,373 
             
Total income
5,941 
7,912 
 
912 
1,099 
1,587 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(2,454)
(2,693)
 
(459)
(527)
(554)
  - other
(928)
(842)
 
(240)
(243)
(292)
Indirect expenses
(949)
(862)
 
(240)
(249)
(219)
             
 
(4,331)
(4,397)
 
(939)
(1,019)
(1,065)
             
Impairment (losses)/recoveries
(49)
(151)
 
(68)
32 
             
Operating profit/(loss)
1,561 
3,364 
 
(95)
112 
527 
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Rates - money markets
(212)
65 
 
(78)
(19)
(65)
Rates - flow
1,668 
1,985 
 
465 
113 
413 
Currencies
868 
870 
 
183 
227 
178 
Credit and asset backed markets
1,424 
2,215 
 
93 
433 
             
Fixed income & currencies
3,748 
5,135 
 
579 
414 
959 
Portfolio management and origination
1,343 
1,777 
 
277 
305 
396 
Equities
781 
933 
 
158 
114 
183 
             
Total excluding fair value derivative liabilities
5,872 
7,845 
 
1,014 
833 
1,538 
Fair value derivative liabilities
69 
67 
 
(102)
266 
49 
             
Total income
5,941 
7,912 
 
912 
1,099 
1,587 
             
Analysis of impairments by sector
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
(139)
51 
 
(62)
(2)
Property and construction
(42)
(74)
 
(25)
(11)
(10)
Banks and financial institutions
54 
(177)
 
(11)
44 
(54)
Other
78 
49 
 
30 
(1)
71 
             
Total impairment (losses)/recoveries
(49)
(151)
 
(68)
32 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements)
0.1% 
0.2% 
 
0.4% 
(0.2%)



 
54

 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on equity (1)
7.7% 
16.6% 
 
(1.8%)
2.3% 
10.2% 
Net interest margin
0.73% 
1.05% 
 
0.76% 
0.71% 
0.93% 
Cost:income ratio
73% 
56% 
 
103% 
93% 
67% 
Compensation ratio (2)
41% 
34% 
 
50% 
48% 
35% 
Compensation ratio - continuing business
39% 
32% 
       


 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Loans and advances to customers
74.7 
73.1 
2% 
 
75.1 
(1%)
Loans and advances to banks
29.9 
34.1 
(12%)
 
44.5 
(33%)
Reverse repos
100.5 
100.6 
 
94.8 
6% 
Securities
111.0 
124.5 
(11%)
 
119.2 
(7%)
Cash and eligible bills
28.1 
33.3 
(16%)
 
38.8 
(28%)
Other
17.5 
33.0 
(47%)
 
24.3 
(28%)
             
Total third party assets (excluding derivatives
  mark-to-market)
361.7 
398.6 
(9%)
 
396.7 
(9%)
Net derivative assets (after netting)
37.0 
45.6 
(19%)
 
37.4 
(1%)
Customer deposits (excluding repos)
37.4 
39.5 
(5%)
 
38.9 
(4%)
Risk elements in lending
1.8 
1.6 
13% 
 
1.7 
6% 
Risk-weighted assets
151.1 
134.3 
13% 
 
146.9 
3% 

Notes:
(1)
Divisional return on equity is based on divisional operating profit after tax divided by average notional equity (based on 10% of the monthly average of divisional RWAs, adjusted for capital deductions).
(2)
Compensation ratio is based on staff costs as a percentage of total income.

Key points
During Q4 2011, the market environment continued to weaken.  Market volatility remained elevated and liquidity depressed as markets reacted to developments in the European sovereign debt crisis.  Deal flow was weak reflecting investor pessimism about the outlook for the world economy.  Throughout the year, GBM continued to deliver core products and innovative solutions to clients, while also focusing on management of its cost base and on tight control of its risk positions.

On 12 January 2012 the Group announced changes to its wholesale banking operations in light of a changed market and regulatory environment.  The changes will see the reorganisation of RBS’s wholesale businesses into ‘Markets’ and ‘International Banking’ and the exit and downsizing of selected activities.  The changes will ensure the wholesale businesses continue to deliver against the Group’s strategy.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit fell by 54%, from £3,364 million for 2010 to £1,561 million for 2011, driven by a 25% decrease in revenue. The year was characterised by volatile and deteriorating credit markets, especially during the second half of the year when the European sovereign debt crisis drove a sharp widening in credit spreads.
 

 
 
55

 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key points (continued)

2011 compared with 2010 (continued)
·
Due to this deterioration in the markets both the Rates and Credit businesses suffered significantly, and income from trading activities fell from £5,218 million in 2010, to £4,735 million in 2011. The heightened volatility increased risk aversion amongst clients and limited opportunities for revenue generation in the secondary markets.
   
·
Portfolio Management and Origination revenue also fell sharply as clients curtailed new activity and continued to repay existing debt.
   
·
Equities revenue fell 16% as wider market conditions reduced investor confidence, resulting in lower client issuance and reduced activity in the secondary markets.
   
·
Total costs fell by 2% despite increased investment costs in 2011, which included a programme to meet new regulatory requirements. The compensation ratio in GBM excluding discontinued businesses was 39%, driven by fixed salary costs and prior year deferred awards. Variable compensation accrued in the first half of the year were reduced in the second half of the year, leaving the 2011 variable compensation awards 58% lower than 2010, compared with a 54% fall in operating profit, as detailed on page 89.
   
·
Third party assets fell from £396.7 billion in 2010 to £361.7 billion in 2011 as a result of lower levels of activity and careful management of balance sheet exposures.
   
·
A 3% increase in risk-weighted assets reflected the impact of significant regulatory changes, with a £21 billion uplift as a result of CRD III, largely offset by the impact of the division’s focus on risk management.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
An operating loss of £95 million was driven by a swing in the fair value of GBM’s own derivative liabilities (FVDL) of £368 million, due to improving credit spreads (similar to fair value of own debt movements), partially offset by a movement of £235 million in counterparty exposure management (CEM) (positive movement of £20 million in Q4 2011 versus a negative movement of £215 million in Q3 2011).  
   
·
Excluding the movements in FVDL and CEM, revenue decreased by 5%, to £994 million compared with £1,048 million in Q3 2011, as the market environment remained challenging for a number of businesses:
   
 
Rates Money Markets continued to record negative revenue as the cost of the division’s funding activities more than offset the revenue generated by the client facing business.
     
 
Rates Flow showed some recovery from a weak Q3 2011 largely driven by a turnaround in counterparty exposure management activities. Trading conditions for the underlying business remained difficult.
     
 
Currencies declined on weaker options performance. The spot FX business continued to perform consistently well.
     
 
Credit and Asset Backed Markets continued to incur losses in the flow credit business, albeit at a lower level than prior quarter. Earnings from asset backed products were also down, reflecting increased risk aversion in both GBM and the wider market.
     
 
Equities revenue increased from a very weak Q3 2011, although client activity remained subdued.
     
 
The fall in Portfolio Management and Origination reflected exceptional gains from credit hedging activity in Q3 2011. Origination and loan income remained broadly flat; client activity, especially in EMEA, was weak.
 
 

 
 
56

 
Global Banking & Markets (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011 (continued)
·
Total costs fell £80 million driven by reductions in headcount and a reduction in variable compensation accrued during the first half of the year, while a range of other cost saving initiatives were partially offset by higher legal costs.  The compensation ratio rose compared with the prior quarter due to lower levels of revenue earned.
   
·
Impairments of £68 million resulted from a small number of corporate provisions.
   
·
Third party assets were driven £37 billion lower during Q4 2011, and activity was managed carefully amidst the volatile credit environment.  Further reductions in the funded balance sheet to circa £300 billion are targeted to take place over the up to three year implementation period of the wholesale business restructuring.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets increased by 13% to £151 billion as CRD III regulations were implemented on the last day of Q4 2011, resulting in an increase of £21 billion. Excluding the impact of this regulatory change, risk-weighted assets remained tightly controlled.
   
·
The negative return on equity in the quarter was driven by the significant fall in revenue. The impact of the increase in risk-weighted assets was minimal as average risk-weighted assets remained low across the quarter.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
The operating loss of £95 million in Q4 2011 compares with an operating profit of £527 million in Q4 2010. The deterioration in performance was due to the sharp decline in revenue, reflecting the difficult credit environment and low levels of investor confidence.
   
·
Rates Flow benefited from a favourable counter party credit development. Excluding the impact of this, the business weakened amidst heightened market volatility, especially relating to sovereign bond valuations.
   
·
 
Earnings from Credit and Asset Backed Markets fell sharply. Losses on flow credit trading contrasted with a gain in Q4 2010 and gains on asset backed products were constrained in Q4 2011 as both the market and the business became increasingly risk averse.
   
·
The fall in Portfolio Management and Origination reflected limited client activity, especially in EMEA, and the net repayment of existing debt during the year.
   
·
The decline in total costs reflected significantly lower current year variable compensation, the realisation of benefits from a number of cost saving initiatives and the non-repeat of a significant legal expense incurred during Q4 2010.


 
57

 
RBS Insurance

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Earned premiums
4,221 
4,459 
 
1,043 
1,057 
1,100 
Reinsurers' share
(252)
(148)
 
(71)
(67)
(40)
             
Net premium income
3,969 
4,311 
 
972 
990 
1,060 
Fees and commissions
(400)
(410)
 
(161)
(83)
(133)
Instalment income
138 
159 
 
33 
35 
38 
Investment income
265 
277 
 
60 
72 
77 
Other income
100 
179 
 
19 
19 
70 
             
Total income
4,072 
4,516 
 
923 
1,033 
1,112 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff expenses
(288)
(287)
 
(75)
(67)
(72)
  - other expenses
(333)
(325)
 
(79)
(88)
(77)
             
Indirect expenses
(225)
(267)
 
(55)
(60)
(74)
             
 
(846)
(879)
 
(209)
(215)
(223)
             
Net claims
(2,772)
(3,932)
 
(589)
(695)
(898)
 
           
Operating profit/(loss)
454 
(295)
 
125 
123 
(9)
             
Analysis of income by product
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
1,874 
1,962 
 
460 
475 
504 
  - partnerships
228 
373 
 
36 
49 
100 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
490 
488 
 
126 
121 
123 
  - partnerships
378 
408 
 
83 
97 
104 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding
  broker
           
  - own brands
185 
197 
 
47 
44 
51 
  - partnerships
132 
168 
 
(15)
48 
Commercial
365 
341 
 
95 
98 
90 
International
346 
333 
 
88 
90 
83 
Other (1)
74 
246 
 
11 
52 
             
Total income
4,072 
4,516 
 
923 
1,033 
1,112 

For the notes to this table refer to page 60.

 
58

 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
In-force policies (000s)
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
3,787 
4,162 
 
3,787 
3,832 
4,162 
  - partnerships
320 
645 
 
320 
388 
645 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
1,811 
1,797 
 
1,811 
1,832 
1,797 
  - partnerships
2,497 
2,530 
 
2,497 
2,504 
2,530 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding
  broker
           
  - own brands
1,844 
1,966 
 
1,844 
1,886 
1,966 
  - partnerships
7,307 
7,497 
 
7,307 
7,714 
7,497 
Commercial
422 
352 
 
422 
410 
352 
International
1,387 
1,082 
 
1,387 
1,357 
1,082 
Other (1)
644 
 
44 
644 
             
Total in-force policies (2)
19,376 
20,675 
 
19,376 
19,967 
20,675 
             
Gross written premium (£m)
           
Personal lines motor excluding broker
           
  - own brands
1,584 
1,647 
 
348 
438 
370 
  - partnerships
137 
257 
 
28 
36 
59 
Personal lines home excluding broker
           
  - own brands
474 
478 
 
112 
133 
116 
  - partnerships
549 
556 
 
132 
144 
137 
Personal lines rescue and other excluding
  broker
           
  - own brands
174 
178 
 
40 
48 
41 
  - partnerships
174 
159 
 
44 
48 
39 
Commercial
435 
397 
 
102 
101 
96 
International
570 
425 
 
142 
125 
123 
Other (1)
201 
 
             
Total gross written premium
4,098 
4,298 
 
950 
1,077 
988 

For the notes to this table refer to page 60.

 
59

 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key metrics (continued)
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Return on regulatory capital (3)
11.3% 
(7.9%)
 
12.5% 
12.3% 
(0.9%)
Return on tangible equity (4)
10.3% 
(6.8%)
 
11.0% 
11.0% 
(0.8%)
Loss ratio (5)
70% 
91% 
 
61% 
70% 
85% 
Commission ratio (6)
10% 
10% 
 
17% 
8% 
13% 
Expense ratio (7)
20% 
20% 
 
22% 
20% 
23% 
Combined operating ratio (8)
100% 
121% 
 
100% 
98% 
121% 
             
Balance sheet
           
Total insurance reserves - (£m) (9)
     
7,284 
7,545 
7,643 

Notes:
(1)
‘Other’ predominantly consists of the personal lines broker business.
(2)
Total in-force policies include travel and creditor policies sold through RBS Group. These comprise travel policies included in bank accounts e.g. Royalties Gold Account, and creditor policies sold with bank products including mortgage, loan and card payment protection.
(3)
Return on regulatory capital required is based on annualised operating profit/(loss) after tax divided by average notional regulatory equity.
(4)
Return on tangible equity is based on annualised operating profit/(loss) after tax divided by average tangible equity.
(5)
Loss ratio is based on net claims divided by net premium income.
(6)
Commission ratio is based on fees and commissions divided by gross written premium.
(7)
Expense ratio is based on expenses divided by gross written premium.
(8)
Combined operating ratio is the sum of the loss, commission and expense ratios.
(9)
Consists of general and life insurance liabilities, unearned premium reserve and liability adequacy reserve.


Key points
RBS Insurance continues to make good progress ahead of its divestment from the Group. Q4 2011 operating profit of £125 million was the fifth successive quarter of year-on-year improvement. Operating profit of £454 million for 2011 shows a return to full year profitability and represents close to a £750 million turnaround from 2010. These results demonstrate the success of the first phase of management’s transformation plan - to return to profit in 2011. The full year combined operating ratio improved to 100% (2010 - 121%) with a full year return on equity of 10.3% compared with a negative return of 6.8% in 2010.

The second phase of the RBS Insurance transformation plan, to build competitive advantage, is underway and tangible benefits are already being delivered. All new Churchill, Direct Line and Privilege motor claims, as well as all new Churchill home claims, are now being processed through a new claims management system.  Within motor, the rollout of a new rating engine and new pricing tools ensured more accurate and tailored pricing with the aim of generating greater value from RBS Insurance's multi-brand, multi-distribution strategy.


 
60

 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key points (continued)
As part of the plan to build competitive advantage, the rationalisation of occupied sites continues, with 15 site exits by the end of 2011. The consolidation of the four UK general insurance underwriting entities within the RBS Insurance Group was successfully completed in December 2011. All UK general insurance business is now written through one underwriter with the aim of improving operational and capital efficiency.

Marking a significant new partnership, RBS Insurance signed a five-year contract with Sainsbury’s Finance in 2011 to provide underwriting, sales, service and claims management for its car insurance customers. Following the successful launch and development of the car insurance partnership, a further contract was signed early in 2012 to provide home insurance for Sainsbury’s customers.  Building on RBS Insurance’s established successful relationship with Nationwide Building Society, a deal was concluded to extend its provision of home insurance until the end of 2015.  RBS Insurance is also concluding terms with RBS Group’s UK Retail bank on the details of a five-year agreement for the continued provision of general insurance products post separation.  The term would commence from the point of initial divestment.

While overall gross written premium fell by 5% in 2011, it increased by 10% in Commercial, which includes NIG, the commercial broker business, and Direct Line for Business, the direct SME insurer.  A new brand identity was unveiled for NIG and work continued to improve its product offering and service to brokers. Direct Line for Business continued to develop well.

RBS Insurance’s international division showed strong growth in gross written premiums primarily in Italy, assisted by the first full year of its sales agreements with FGA Capital, a joint venture between Fiat and Credit Agricole.  The German business also showed good growth following improvements in the second half of 2011 to its direct and partnership business, including strengthening its relationship with Renault.

Ahead of the planned divestment in the second half of 2012, RBS Insurance has begun separating its activities and operations from RBS Group. Its corporate functions have been strengthened, arm’s length agreements are under discussion with the Group where appropriate, a new corporate brand, Direct Line Group was announced on 15 February 2012 and a new risk and control framework has been implemented, in readiness for standalone status.

Overall, RBS Insurance has powerful brands, improved earnings, a robust balance sheet and is executing the second phase of its transformation plan to rebuild competitive advantage.

 
61

 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key points (continued)

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating profit rose by £749 million in 2011, principally due to the non repeat of the bodily injury reserve strengthening in 2010, de-risking of the motor book, exit of certain business segments and more benign weather in 2011.
   
·
Gross written premium fell £200 million, 5%, as the business continued to drive improved profitability through reduced volumes in unattractive segments.  This was partially offset by growth in Commercial and International.
   
·
Total income fell £444 million, 10%, following the exit of personal lines broker, a decline in premiums reflecting reduced motor volumes and higher reinsurance costs to reduce the risk profile of the book.
   
·
Net claims fell £1,160 million, 30%, due to the non recurrence of bodily injury reserve strengthening in 2010, actions taken to de-risk the book, the exit of certain business segments and more benign weather in 2011.
   
·
Total direct expenses rose by £9 million principally driven by project activity to support the transformation plan.
   
·
Investment income fell £12 million, 4%, reflecting decreased yields on the portfolio in 2011, partially offset by higher realised gains.
   
·
At the end of 2011, RBS Insurance's investment portfolios comprised primarily cash, gilts and investment grade bonds.  Within the UK portfolio, £8.9 billion, and the International portfolio, £827 million, there was no exposure to sovereign debt issued by Portugal, Ireland, Italy, Greece or Spain.
   
·
Total in-force policies fell 6% in the year due to planned de-risking of the motor book and the exiting of certain other segments and partnerships, including personal lines broker.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Operating profit of £125 million rose by £2 million, 2%, compared with Q3 2011 as lower income was offset by a decrease in net claims, partially reflecting more benign weather.
   
·
Gross written premium of £950 million fell £127 million, 12%, as a result of seasonality and a reduction of in-force policies following continued improvements to the risk profile of the motor book. This was partially offset by growth in International, largely due to the partnership with FGA Capital.
   
·
Total income of £923 million fell £110 million, 11%, due to lower volumes and higher commissions payable, including £57 million to UK Retail.
   
·
Net claims fell £106 million to £589 million partially reflecting a £57 million release of claims reserves relating to creditor insurance. This release was matched by the payment to UK Retail within fees and commissions. Excluding the release and commission payment, the loss ratio would have been 6 percentage points higher and commission ratio 6 percentage points lower.
   
·
Total direct expenses of £154 million were broadly flat.
 
 

 
 
62

 
RBS Insurance (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011 (continued)
·
Investment income of £60 million was down by £12 million, 17%, due to lower disposal gains.
   
·
Total in-force policies fell by 3% driven by the planned de-risking of the motor book and the exit of certain business segments and partnerships, partially offset by growth in International and Commercial.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Operating profit rose by £134 million due to a significant turnaround in the technical result, driven by a 34% decrease in net claims.
   
·
Gross written premium fell £38 million, 4%, as a result of reduced in-force policies aimed at improving the risk profile of the book, partially offset by growth in International.
   
·
Total income fell £189 million, 17%, reflecting lower motor volumes and higher fees and commissions payable.
   
·
Net claims were down by £309 million, 34%, through a combination of improved risk mix, more benign weather in 2011, and the exit of certain business segments.
   
·
Total direct expenses increased by £5 million, 3%, due to the transfer of certain Group services to RBS Insurance in preparation for separation.
   
·
Investment income was down £17 million, or 22%, due to lower disposal gains and decreased yields.
   
·
Total in-force policies reduced by 6% principally due to the planned de-risking of the motor book and the exiting of certain other segments and partnerships, including personal lines broker, partially offset by growth in International.





 
63

 
Central items

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Central items not allocated
156 
577 
 
85 
67 
115 

Funding and operating costs have been allocated to operating divisions based on direct service usage, the requirement for market funding and other appropriate drivers where services span more than one division.

Residual unallocated items relate to volatile corporate items that do not naturally reside within a division.

Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £156 million in 2011, a decline of £421 million compared with 2010.
   
·
2010 benefitted from c£300 million of accounting gains on hybrid securities, c£150 million of which was amortised during 2011.
   
·
A VAT recovery of £176 million in 2010 compared with £85 million recovered in 2011.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £85 million in the quarter, an increase of £18 million compared with Q3 2011.

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Central items not allocated represented a credit of £85 million, £30 million lower than Q4 2010.



 
64

 
Non-Core

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Income statement
           
Net interest income
881 
1,959 
 
129 
163 
419 
Funding costs of rental assets
(215)
(276)
 
(56)
(53)
(61)
Net interest income
666 
1,683 
 
73 
110 
358 
             
Net fees and commissions
(38)
471 
 
(47)
(85)
166 
Loss from trading activities
(721)
(31)
 
(407)
(246)
(152)
Insurance net premium income
291 
695 
 
10 
45 
185 
Other operating income
           
  - rental income
953 
1,035 
 
218 
235 
275 
  - other (1)
55 
(889)
 
(151)
(13)
(511)
             
Non-interest income
540 
1,281 
 
(377)
(64)
(37)
             
Total income/(loss)
1,206 
2,964 
 
(304)
46 
321 
             
Direct expenses
           
  - staff
(375)
(731)
 
(82)
(93)
(105)
  - operating lease depreciation
(347)
(452)
 
(91)
(82)
(108)
  - other
(256)
(573)
 
(57)
(62)
(141)
Indirect expenses
(317)
(500)
 
(84)
(86)
(127)
             
 
(1,295)
(2,256)
 
(314)
(323)
(481)
             
Insurance net claims
(195)
(737)
 
61 
(38)
(245)
Impairment losses
(3,919)
(5,476)
 
(751)
(682)
(1,211)
             
Operating loss
(4,203)
(5,505)
 
(1,308)
(997)
(1,616)

Note:
(1)
Includes losses on disposals (year ended 31 December 2011 - £127 million; year ended 31 December 2010 - £504 million; quarter ended 31 December 2011 - £36 million; quarter ended 30 September 2011 - £37 million; quarter ended 31 December 2010 - £247 million).



 
65

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Analysis of income/(loss)by business
           
Banking & portfolios
1,474 
1,673 
 
(168)
214 
157 
International businesses
419 
778 
 
92 
101 
84 
Markets
(687)
513 
 
(228)
(269)
80 
             
Total income/(loss)
1,206 
2,964 
 
(304)
46 
321 
             
Loss from trading activities
           
Monoline exposures
(670)
(5)
 
(243)
(230)
(57)
Credit derivative product companies
(85)
(139)
 
(19)
(5)
(38)
Asset-backed products (1)
29 
235 
 
(22)
(51)
33 
Other credit exotics
(175)
77 
 
(8)
(7)
21 
Equities
(11)
(17)
 
(11)
11 
Banking book hedges
(1)
(82)
 
(36)
73 
(70)
Other (2)
192 
(100)
 
(80)
(15)
(52)
             
 
(721)
(31)
 
(407)
(246)
(152)
             
Impairment losses
           
Banking & portfolios
3,833 
5,328 
 
714 
656 
1,258 
International businesses
82 
200 
 
30 
17 
59 
Markets
(52)
 
(106)
             
Total impairment losses
3,919 
5,476 
 
751 
682 
1,211 
             
Loan impairment charge as % of gross
  customer loans and advances
  (excluding reverse repurchase
  agreements) (3)
           
Banking & portfolios
4.9% 
5.0% 
 
3.6% 
2.8% 
4.6% 
International businesses
3.7% 
4.4% 
 
5.3% 
2.7% 
5.2% 
Markets
(3.0%) 
0.2% 
 
(8.8%)
(0.4%)
(38.4%)
             
Total
4.8% 
4.9% 
 
3.7% 
2.8% 
4.4% 

Notes:
(1)
Asset-backed products include super senior asset-backed structures and other asset-backed products.
(2)
Includes profits in RBS Sempra Commodities JV (year ended 31 December 2011 - £4 million; year ended 31 December 2010 - £372 million; quarter ended 31 December 2011 - £1 million; quarter ended 30 September 2011 - £1 million; quarter ended 31 December 2010 - £19 million).
(3)
Includes disposal groups.




 
66

 
Non-Core (continued)

Key metrics
 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
             
Performance ratios
           
Net interest margin
0.64% 
1.16% 
 
0.31% 
0.43% 
1.09% 
Cost:income ratio
107% 
76% 
 
nm 
nm 
150% 
Adjusted cost:income ratio
128% 
101% 
 
nm 
nm 
nm 

 
31 December
2011 
30 September 
2011 
   
31 December 
2010 
 
 
£bn 
£bn 
Change 
 
£bn 
Change 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets (excluding
  derivatives) (1)
93.7 
105.1 
(11%)
 
137.9 
(32%)
Total third party assets (including
  derivatives) (1)
104.7 
117.7 
(11%)
 
153.9 
(32%)
Loans and advances to customers (gross) (2)
79.4 
88.9 
(11%)
 
108.4 
(27%)
Customer deposits (2)
3.5 
4.3 
(19%)
 
6.7 
(48%)
Risk elements in lending (2)
24.0 
24.6 
(2%)
 
23.4 
3% 
Risk-weighted assets (1)
93.3 
117.9 
(21%)
 
153.7 
(39%)

nm = not meaningful

Notes:
(1)
Includes RBS Sempra Commodities JV (31 December 2011 third party assets, excluding derivatives (TPAs) £0.1 billion, RWAs £1.6 billion; 30 September 2011 TPAs £0.3 billion, RWAs £1.7 billion; 31 December 2010 TPAs £6.7 billion, RWAs £4.3 billion).
(2)
Excludes disposal groups.


 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross customer loans and advances
     
Banking & portfolios
77.3 
86.6 
104.9 
International businesses
2.0 
2.2 
3.5 
Markets
0.1 
0.1 
       
 
79.4 
88.9 
108.4 
       
Risk-weighted assets
     
Banking & portfolios
64.8 
66.6 
83.5 
International businesses
4.1 
4.5 
5.6 
Markets
24.4 
46.8 
64.6 
       
 
93.3 
117.9 
153.7 
       
Third party assets (excluding derivatives)
     
Banking & portfolios
81.3 
91.0 
113.9 
International businesses
2.9 
3.3 
4.4 
Markets
9.5 
10.8 
19.6 
       
 
93.7 
105.1 
137.9 

 
67

 
Non-Core (continued)

Third party assets (excluding derivatives)

Year ended 31 December 2011
 
31 December 
2010 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
42.6 
(5.6)
(2.4)
0.7 
(3.4)
(0.4)
31.5 
Corporate
59.8 
(8.5)
(11.3)
2.5 
(0.1)
(0.2)
42.2 
SME
3.7 
(1.6)
0.1 
(0.1)
2.1 
Retail
9.0 
(1.1)
(1.4)
(0.3)
(0.1)
6.1 
Other
2.5 
(0.6)
1.9 
Markets
13.6 
(2.9)
(1.8)
1.0 
(0.1)
9.8 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
131.2 
(20.3)
(16.9)
4.3 
(3.9)
(0.8)
93.6 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
6.7 
(1.3)
(5.0)
(0.3)
0.1 
               
Total (1)
137.9 
(21.6)
(21.9)
4.3 
(3.9)
(1.1)
93.7 

Quarter ended 31 December 2011
 
30 September 
2011 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
31 December 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate
35.3 
(1.8)
(1.1)
0.1 
(0.6)
(0.4)
31.5 
Corporate
46.9 
(1.6)
(3.6)
0.6 
(0.1)
42.2 
SME
2.4 
(0.3)
0.1 
(0.1)
2.1 
Retail
7.4 
(0.2)
(1.1)
6.1 
Other
1.9 
1.9 
Markets
10.9 
(0.2)
(1.0)
0.1 
9.8 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
104.8 
(4.1)
(6.8)
0.8 
(0.8)
(0.3)
93.6 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
0.3 
(0.2)
0.1 
               
Total (1)
105.1 
(4.1)
(7.0)
0.8 
(0.8)
(0.3)
93.7 

Quarter ended 30 September 2011
 
30 June 
2011 
Run-off 
Disposals/ 
restructuring 
Drawings/ 
roll overs 
Impairments 
FX 
30 September 
2011 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
Commercial real estate (2)
36.6 
0.3 
(0.6)
0.2 
(0.5)
(0.7)
35.3 
Corporate (2)
50.4 
(2.4)
(1.3)
0.5 
(0.3)
46.9 
SME
2.7 
(0.3)
2.4 
Retail
8.0 
(0.3)
(0.3)
(0.1)
0.1 
7.4 
Other
2.3 
(0.4)
1.9 
Markets
11.5 
(0.9)
(0.4)
0.6 
0.1 
10.9 
               
Total (excluding derivatives)
111.5 
(4.0)
(2.6)
1.3 
(0.6)
(0.8)
104.8 
Markets - RBS Sempra
  Commodities JV
1.1 
(0.5)
(0.3)
0.3 
               
Total (1)
112.6 
(4.5)
(2.9)
1.3 
(0.6)
(0.8)
105.1 


Notes:
(1)
Disposals of £0.2 billion have been signed as at 31 December 2011 but are pending completion (30 September 2011 - £1 billion; 31 December 2010 - £12 billion).
(2)
Business restructuring in Q3 2011 resulted in third party assets of £1 billion transferring from Corporate to Commercial Real Estate resulting in run-off totalling £0.3 billion in Q3 2011.



 
68

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Impairment losses by donating division
  and sector
           
             
UK Retail
           
Mortgages
 
Personal
(27)
 
(28)
             
Total UK Retail
(22)
13 
 
(28)
             
UK Corporate
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
76 
26 
 
26 
Property and construction
224 
437 
 
83 
92 
103 
Transport
52 
 
(20)
Banking and financial institutions
69 
 
51 
Lombard
75 
129 
 
20 
12 
50 
Other
96 
166 
 
21 
18 
50 
             
Total UK Corporate
528 
830 
 
157 
125 
239 
             
Ulster Bank
           
Mortgages
42 
 
Commercial real estate
           
  - investment
609 
630 
 
151 
74 
206 
  - development
1,552 
1,759 
 
77 
162 
596 
Other corporate
173 
251 
 
15 
45 
(19)
Other EMEA
15 
52 
 
             
Total Ulster Bank
2,349 
2,734 
 
245 
283 
789 
             
US Retail & Commercial
           
Auto and consumer
58 
82 
 
14 
37 
Cards
(9)
23 
 
SBO/home equity
201 
277 
 
33 
57 
51 
Residential mortgages
16 
 
(1)
Commercial real estate
40 
185 
 
14 
(4)
31 
Commercial and other
(3)
17 
 
(1)
             
Total US Retail & Commercial
303 
588 
 
64 
70 
123 
             
Global Banking & Markets
           
Manufacturing and infrastructure
57 
(290)
 
42 
23 
15 
Property and construction
752 
1,296 
 
241 
189 
176 
Transport
(3)
33 
 
10 
(6)
24 
Telecoms, media and technology
68 
 
18 
27 
(23)
Banking and financial institutions
(98)
196 
 
(31)
(29)
19 
Other
(20)
14 
 
25 
(1)
(163)
             
Total Global Banking & Markets
756 
1,258 
 
305 
203 
48 
             
Other
           
Wealth
51 
 
Global Transaction Services
 
Central items
 
(2)
             
Total Other
53 
 
(1)
             
Total impairment losses
3,919 
5,476 
 
751 
682 
1,211 
 

 
 
69

 
Non-Core (continued)

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements) by donating division and sector
     
       
UK Retail
     
Mortgages
1.4 
1.4 
1.6 
Personal
0.1 
0.3 
0.4 
       
Total UK Retail
1.5 
1.7 
2.0 
       
UK Corporate
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
0.1 
0.1 
0.3 
Property and construction
5.9 
6.5 
11.4 
Transport
4.5 
4.8 
5.4 
Banking and financial institutions
0.6 
0.5 
0.8 
Lombard
1.0 
1.2 
1.7 
Other
7.5 
7.5 
7.4 
       
Total UK Corporate
19.6 
20.6 
27.0 
       
Ulster Bank
     
Commercial real estate
     
  - investment
3.9 
3.9 
4.0 
  - development
8.5 
8.7 
8.4 
Other corporate
1.6 
1.7 
2.2 
Other EMEA
0.4 
0.4 
0.4 
       
Total Ulster Bank
14.4 
14.7 
15.0 
       
US Retail & Commercial
     
Auto and consumer
0.8 
1.9 
2.6 
Cards
0.1 
0.1 
0.1 
SBO/home equity
2.5 
2.6 
3.2 
Residential mortgages
0.6 
0.6 
0.7 
Commercial real estate
1.0 
1.1 
1.5 
Commercial and other
0.4 
0.5 
0.5 
       
Total US Retail & Commercial
5.4 
6.8 
8.6 
       
Global Banking & Markets
     
Manufacturing and infrastructure
6.6 
7.0 
8.7 
Property and construction
15.3 
17.8 
19.6 
Transport
3.2 
3.9 
5.5 
Telecoms, media and technology
0.7 
0.9 
0.9 
Banking and financial institutions
5.6 
8.3 
12.0 
Other
6.8 
6.7 
9.0 
       
Total Global Banking & Markets
38.2 
44.6 
55.7 
       
Other
     
Wealth
0.2 
0.3 
0.4 
Global Transaction Services
0.2 
0.3 
0.3 
RBS Insurance
0.2 
Central items
(0.2)
(0.3)
(1.0)
       
Total Other
0.2 
0.3 
(0.1)
       
Gross loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse
  repurchase agreements)
79.3 
88.7 
108.2 


 
70

 
Non-Core (continued)

Key points
Non-Core third party assets fell to £94 billion, below the revised year end target of £96 billion and significantly ahead of the original guidance of £118 billion.  Further reductions will include the sale of RBS Aviation Capital for £4.7 billion, which was signed in January 2012.  Since the division was formed in 2009, the reduction totals £164 billion, or 64%. By the end of 2011, the Non-Core funded balance sheet equated to less than 10% of the Group funded balance sheet compared with 21% when the division was created.

The division focused on reducing capital intensive trading assets, with activity including the restructuring of monoline exposures, which, at a cost of c.£600 million in 2011, achieved a reduction of £32 billion in risk-weighted assets.

An operating loss of £4,203 million for 2011 was £1,302 million lower than 2010.  Income declined by £1,758 million reflecting continued divestment, including business and country exits.  The decrease was partially offset by a reduction in expenses of £961 million, largely driven by the fall in headcount. Impairment losses fell by £1,557 million despite ongoing challenges in the real estate and Ulster Bank portfolios.

2011 compared with 2010
·
Operating loss of £4,203 million in 2011 was £1,302 million lower than the loss recorded in 2010. The continued divestment of Non-Core businesses and portfolios has reduced revenue streams as well as the cost base.
   
·
Losses from trading activities increased by £690 million compared with 2010, principally as a result of the disposal of RBS Sempra Commodities in 2010 and costs incurred as part of the division’s focus on reducing capital intensive trading assets and mitigating future regulatory uplifts in risk-weighted assets.
   
·
Impairment losses fell by £1,557 million despite ongoing challenges in the real estate and Ulster Bank portfolios, reflecting improvements in other asset classes.
   
·
Third party assets declined by £44 billion (32%) reflecting disposals of £22 billion and run-off of £22 billion.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets were £60 billion lower than 2010, principally driven by significant disposal activity on trading book assets combined with run-off.
   
·
Headcount declined by 2,189 (32%) to 4,669 in 2011, largely reflecting the divestment activity in relation to Asia, Non-Core Insurance and RBS Sempra Commodities.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
Non-Core continued to reduce the size of its balance sheet, with third party assets declining by £11 billion to £94 billion, driven by disposals of £7 billion and run-off of £4 billion.
   
·
Risk-weighted assets fell by £25 billion in Q4 2011 primarily reflecting the restructuring of monoline exposures and run-off.
   
·
The increased operating loss reported in Q4 2011 reflected trading losses associated with the ongoing reduction of capital intensive trading assets and market movements. Additionally, other income losses increased in Q4 2011 as a result of valuation movements of £131 million recorded on equity and asset positions.



 
71

 
Non-Core (continued)

Key points (continued)

Q4 2011 compared with Q4 2010
·
Q4 2011 operating loss of £1,308 million was 19% lower than the loss recorded in Q4 2010.
   
·
Impairments were £460 million lower in Q4 2011 reflecting a reduction in impairments reported in the Ulster Bank portfolio, following substantial provisioning of land development values earlier in 2011.
   
·
Non-interest income fell principally as a result of trading losses incurred in Q4 2011.
   
·
Ongoing disposal activity reduced the balance sheet and headcount, resulting in lower net interest income, fees and commissions, net premium income, claims, and expenses.



 
72

 
 
Condensed consolidated income statement
for the period ended 31 December 2011


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Interest receivable
21,410 
22,776 
 
5,234 
5,371 
5,612 
Interest payable
(8,731)
(8,567)
 
(2,160)
(2,294)
(2,032)
             
Net interest income
12,679 
14,209 
 
3,074 
3,077 
3,580 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
6,384 
8,193 
 
1,590 
1,452 
2,052 
Fees and commissions payable
(1,460)
(2,211)
 
(573)
(304)
(449)
Income from trading activities
2,701 
4,517 
 
(238)
957 
364 
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
(1)
Other operating income (excluding insurance
  premium income)
4,122 
1,479 
 
205 
2,384 
1,003 
Insurance net premium income
4,256 
5,128 
 
981 
1,036 
1,272 
             
Non-interest income
16,258 
17,659 
 
1,964 
5,526 
4,242 
             
Total income
28,937 
31,868 
 
5,038 
8,603 
7,822 
             
Staff costs
(8,678)
(9,671)
 
(1,993)
(2,076)
(2,194)
Premises and equipment
(2,451)
(2,402)
 
(674)
(604)
(709)
Other administrative expenses
(4,931)
(3,995)
 
(1,296)
(962)
(1,048)
Depreciation and amortisation
(1,875)
(2,150)
 
(513)
(485)
(546)
Write-down of goodwill and other intangible
   assets
(91)
(10)
 
(91)
(10)
             
Operating expenses
(18,026)
(18,228)
 
(4,567)
(4,127)
(4,507)
             
Profit before insurance net claims and
  impairment losses
10,911 
13,640 
 
471 
4,476 
3,315 
Insurance net claims
(2,968)
(4,783)
 
(529)
(734)
(1,182)
Impairment losses
(8,709)
(9,256)
 
(1,918)
(1,738)
(2,141)
             
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(766)
(399)
 
(1,976)
2,004 
(8)
Tax (charge)/credit
(1,250)
(634)
 
186 
(791)
             
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(2,016)
(1,033)
 
(1,790)
1,213 
(5)
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations,
  net of tax
47 
(633)
 
10 
55 
             
(Loss)/profit for the period
(1,969)
(1,666)
 
(1,780)
1,219 
50 
Non-controlling interests
(28)
665 
 
(18)
(38)
Preference share and other dividends
(124)
 
             
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and
  B shareholders
(1,997)
(1,125)
 
(1,798)
1,226 
12 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary and
  B share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary and
  B share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary
   and B share from discontinued operations
 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary
  and B shares from discontinued operations
 
 
 
73

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of comprehensive income
for the period ended 31 December 2011


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
(Loss)/profit for the period
(1,969)
(1,666)
 
(1,780)
1,219 
50 
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
           
Available-for-sale financial assets (1)
2,258 
(389)
 
(107)
996 
(1,132)
Cash flow hedges
1,424 
1,454 
 
124 
939 
(353)
Currency translation
(440)
81 
 
(117)
(22)
34 
Actuarial (losses)/gains on defined benefit
  plans
(581)
158 
 
(581)
158 
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
  before tax
2,661 
1,304 
 
(681)
1,913 
(1,293)
Tax (charge)/credit
(1,472)
(309)
 
(500)
(480)
393 
             
Other comprehensive income/(loss)
  after tax
1,189 
995 
 
(1,181)
1,433 
(900)
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income for
  the period
(780)
(671)
 
(2,961)
2,652 
(850)
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income is
 attributable to:
           
Non-controlling interests
(24)
(197)
 
(12)
(6)
52 
Preference shareholders
105 
 
Paid-in equity holders
19 
 
Ordinary and B shareholders
(756)
(598)
 
(2,949)
2,658 
(902)
             
 
(780)
(671)
 
(2,961)
2,652 
(850)

Note:
(1)
Analysis provided on page 117.

Key points
·
The movement in available-for-sale financial assets reflects net unrealised gains on high quality sovereign bonds.
   
·
Actuarial losses on defined benefit plans reflect changes in assumptions of £1,017 million, primarily due to a reduction in the real discount rate in the UK and US, partially offset by £436 million net experience gains.
   
·
The tax charge for the year and Q4 2011 includes £664 million write-off of deferred tax assets in The Netherlands.
 
 
74

 
 
Condensed consolidated balance sheet
at 31 December 2011


 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Assets
     
Cash and balances at central banks
79,269 
78,445 
57,014 
Net loans and advances to banks
43,870 
52,602 
57,911 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
39,440 
48,127 
42,607 
Loans and advances to banks
83,310 
100,729 
100,518 
Net loans and advances to customers
454,112 
485,573 
502,748 
Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing
61,494 
54,132 
52,512 
Loans and advances to customers
515,606 
539,705 
555,260 
Debt securities
209,080 
229,657 
217,480 
Equity shares
15,183 
14,888 
22,198 
Settlement balances
7,771 
21,526 
11,605 
Derivatives
529,618 
572,344 
427,077 
Intangible assets
14,858 
14,744 
14,448 
Property, plant and equipment
11,868 
17,060 
16,543 
Deferred tax
3,878 
4,988 
6,373 
Prepayments, accrued income and other assets
10,976 
10,598 
12,576 
Assets of disposal groups
25,450 
3,044 
12,484 
       
Total assets
1,506,867 
1,607,728 
1,453,576 
       
Liabilities
     
Bank deposits
69,113 
78,370 
66,051 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
39,691 
36,227 
32,739 
Deposits by banks
108,804 
114,597 
98,790 
Customer deposits
414,143 
433,660 
428,599 
Repurchase agreements and stock lending
88,812 
95,691 
82,094 
Customer accounts
502,955 
529,351 
510,693 
Debt securities in issue
162,621 
194,511 
218,372 
Settlement balances
7,477 
17,983 
10,991 
Short positions
41,039 
48,495 
43,118 
Derivatives
523,983 
561,790 
423,967 
Accruals, deferred income and other liabilities
23,125 
22,938 
23,089 
Retirement benefit liabilities
2,239 
1,855 
2,288 
Deferred tax
1,945 
1,913 
2,142 
Insurance liabilities
6,312 
6,628 
6,794 
Subordinated liabilities
26,319 
26,275 
27,053 
Liabilities of disposal groups
23,995 
2,516 
9,428 
       
Total liabilities
1,430,814 
1,528,852 
1,376,725 
       
Equity
     
Non-controlling interests
1,234 
1,433 
1,719 
Owners’ equity*
     
  Called up share capital
15,318 
15,318 
15,125 
  Reserves
59,501 
62,125 
60,007 
       
Total equity
76,053 
78,876 
76,851 
       
Total liabilities and equity
1,506,867 
1,607,728 
1,453,576 
       
* Owners’ equity attributable to:
     
Ordinary and B shareholders
70,075 
72,699 
70,388 
Other equity owners
4,744 
4,744 
4,744 
       
 
74,819 
77,443 
75,132 

 
75

 

Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet


Total assets of £1,506.9 billion at 31 December 2011 were up £53.3 billion, 4%, compared with 31 December 2010. This principally reflects an increase in cash and balances at central banks and the mark-to-market value of derivatives in Global Banking & Markets, partly offset by decreases in debt securities and equity shares and the continuing disposal and run-off of Non-Core assets.

Cash and balances at central banks were up £22.3 billion, 39%, to £79.3 billion due to improvements in the Group’s structured liquidity position during 2011.

Loans and advances to banks decreased by £17.2 billion, 17%, to £83.3 billion. Reverse repurchase agreements and stock borrowing (‘reverse repos’) were down £3.2 billion, 7%, to £39.4 billion and bank placings declined £14.0 billion, 24%, to £43.9 billion, primarily as a result of the reduction in exposure to eurozone banks and lower cash collateral requirements.

Loans and advances to customers were down £39.7 billion, 7%, to £515.6 billion. Within this, reverse repurchase agreements were up £9.0 billion, 17%, to £61.5 billion. Customer lending decreased by £48.7 billion, 10%, to £454.1 billion or £46.9 billion, 9%, to £473.9 billion before impairment provisions.  This reflected the transfer to disposal groups of £19.5 billion of customer balances relating to the UK branch-based businesses.  There were also planned reductions in Non-Core of £28.1 billion, together with declines in UK Corporate, £2.9 billion and Ulster Bank, £2.0 billion, together with the effect of exchange rate and other movements, £1.9 billion. These were partially offset by growth in Global Banking & Markets, £0.2 billion, Global Transaction Services, £1.5 billion, Wealth, £0.7 billion, UK Retail, £2.3 billion and US Retail & Commercial, £2.8 billion.

Debt securities were down £8.4 billion, 4%, to £209.1 billion driven mainly by a reduction in holdings of government and financial institution bonds in Global Banking & Markets and Group Treasury.

Equity shares decreased £7.0 billion, 32%, to £15.2 billion which largely reflects the closure of positions to reduce the Group’s level of unsecured funding requirements to mitigate the potential impact of unfavourable market conditions.

Settlement balances declined £3.8 billion, 33% to £7.8 billion as a result of decreased customer activity.

Movements in the value of derivative assets up £102.5 billion, 24%, to £529.6 billion, and liabilities, up £100.0 billion, 24%, to £524.0 billion, primarily reflect increases in interest rate contracts as a result of a significant downward shift in interest rates across all major currencies, together with increases in the mark-to-market value of credit derivatives as a result of widening credit spreads and rising credit default swap prices.

Property, plant and equipment declined £4.7 billion, 28%, to £11.9 billion, primarily as a result of the transfer of RBS Aviation Capital’s operating lease assets to disposal groups.

Deferred taxation was down £2.5 billion, 39%, to £3.9 billion, largely as a result of the utilisation of brought forward tax losses in the UK.
 
 
76

 

Commentary on condensed consolidated balance sheet


The increase in assets and liabilities of disposal groups reflects the reclassification of the UK branch-based businesses and RBS Aviation Capital pending their disposal, partly offset by the completion of disposals, primarily RBS Sempra Commodities JV and certain Non-Core project finance assets.

Deposits by banks increased £10.0 billion, 10%, to £108.8 billion, with higher repurchase agreements and stock lending (‘repos’), up £6.9 billion, 21%, to £39.7 billion and higher inter-bank deposits, up £3.1 billion, 5%, to £69.1 billion.

Customer accounts fell £7.7 billion, 2%, to £503.0 billion. Within this, repos increased £6.7 billion, 8%, to £88.8 billion. Excluding repos, customer deposits were down £14.4 billion, 3%, to £414.1 billion, reflecting the transfer to disposal groups of £21.8 billion of customer accounts relating to the UK branch-based businesses. This was partly offset by the net effect of growth in Global Transaction Services, £2.7 billion, UK Corporate, £0.9 billion, UK Retail, £5.8 billion, US Retail & Commercial, £0.6 billion and Wealth, £1.8 billion, together with exchange rate and other movements of £0.3 billion and declines in Global Banking & Markets, £0.8 billion, Ulster Bank, £0.8 billion and Non-Core, £3.1 billion.

Debt securities in issue were down £55.8 billion, 26% to £162.6 billion driven by reductions in the level of certificates of deposit and commercial paper in Global Banking & Markets and Group Treasury.

Settlement balances declined £3.5 billion, 32%, to £7.5 billion and short positions were down £2.1 billion, 5%, to £41.0 billion due to decreased customer activity.

Subordinated liabilities were down £0.7 billion, 3%, to £26.3 billion, primarily reflecting the redemption of £0.2 billion US dollar and £0.4 billion Euro denominated dated loan capital.

The Group’s non-controlling interests decreased by £0.5 billion, 28%, to £1.2 billion, primarily due to the disposal of the majority of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV business, £0.4 billion.

Owners’ equity decreased by £0.3 billion to £74.8 billion. This was driven by the attributable loss for the year, £2.0 billion, together with the recognition of actuarial losses in respect of the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes, net of tax, £0.5 billion and exchange rate and other movements of £0.3 billion.  Offsetting these reductions were gains in available-for-sale reserves, £1.1 billion and cash flow hedging reserves, £1.0 billion and the issue of shares under employee share schemes, £0.4 billion.
 
 
77

 
 
Average balance sheet


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
 
 
           
Average yields, spreads and margins of the
  banking business
         
Gross yield on interest-earning assets of banking business
3.24 
3.30 
 
3.13 
3.21 
Cost of interest-bearing liabilities of banking business
(1.68)
(1.47)
 
(1.70)
(1.74)
           
Interest spread of banking business
1.56 
1.83 
 
1.43 
1.47 
Benefit from interest-free funds
0.36 
0.23 
 
0.41 
0.37 
           
Net interest margin of banking business
1.92 
2.06 
 
1.84 
1.84 
           
           
Average interest rates
         
The Group's base rate
0.50 
0.50 
 
0.50 
0.50 
           
London inter-bank three month offered rates
         
  - Sterling
0.87 
0.70 
 
0.99 
0.87 
  - Eurodollar
0.33 
0.34 
 
0.43 
0.30 
  - Euro
1.36 
0.75 
 
1.50 
1.51 
 
 
78

 

Average balance sheet (continued)


 
Year ended
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
31 December 2010
 
Average 
   
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Assets
           
Loans and advances to banks
73,834 
697 
0.94 
52,862 
591 
1.12 
Loans and advances to
  customers
466,280 
17,969 
3.85 
506,571 
18,889 
3.73 
Debt securities
121,004 
2,744 
2.27 
130,098 
3,296 
2.53 
             
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
661,118 
21,410 
3.24 
689,531 
22,776 
3.30 
             
Trading business
278,975 
   
276,330 
   
Non-interest earning assets
595,062 
   
706,343 
   
             
Total assets
1,535,155 
   
1,672,204 
   
             
Liabilities
           
Deposits by banks
64,595 
982 
1.52 
81,615 
1,333 
1.63 
Customer accounts
331,318 
3,529 
1.07 
337,582 
3,721 
1.10 
Debt securities in issue
151,175 
3,371 
2.23 
183,452 
3,277 
1.79 
Subordinated liabilities
22,551 
740 
3.28 
28,156 
417 
1.48 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(49,025)
109 
(0.22)
(48,315)
(181)
0.37 
             
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
520,614 
8,731 
1.68 
582,490 
8,567 
1.47 
             
Trading business
307,564 
   
293,993 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
           
  - demand deposits
66,404 
   
53,016 
   
  - other liabilities
565,534 
   
665,799 
   
Owners’ equity
75,039 
   
76,906 
   
             
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,535,155 
   
1,672,204 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.

 
79

 

Average balance sheet (continued)


 
Quarter ended
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
30 September 2011
 
Average 
   
Average 
   
 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
balance 
Interest 
Rate 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Assets
           
Loans and advances to banks
91,370 
207 
0.90 
72,453 
154 
0.84 
Loans and advances to
  customers
452,530 
4,336 
3.80 
469,307 
4,505 
3.81 
Debt securities
119,619 
691 
2.29 
121,299 
712 
2.33 
             
Interest-earning assets -
  banking business
663,519 
5,234 
3.13 
663,059 
5,371 
3.21 
             
Trading business
271,183 
   
281,267 
   
Non-interest earning assets
656,468 
   
654,489 
   
             
Total assets
1,591,170 
   
1,598,815 
   
             
Liabilities
           
Deposits by banks
60,397 
226 
1.48 
65,470 
248 
1.50 
Customer accounts
335,577 
926 
1.09 
332,891 
919 
1.10 
Debt securities in issue
128,701 
793 
2.44 
150,427 
897 
2.37 
Subordinated liabilities
22,906 
191 
3.31 
23,000 
175 
3.02 
Internal funding of trading
  business
(44,408)
24 
(0.21)
(48,161)
55 
(0.45)
             
Interest-bearing liabilities -
  banking business
503,173 
2,160 
1.70 
523,627 
2,294 
1.74 
             
Trading business
299,789 
   
314,626 
   
Non-interest-bearing liabilities
           
  - demand deposits
70,538 
   
66,496 
   
  - other liabilities
642,503 
   
617,817 
   
Owners’ equity
75,167 
   
76,249 
   
             
Total liabilities and
  owners’ equity
1,591,170 
   
1,598,815 
   

Note:
(1)
Interest receivable and interest payable on trading assets and liabilities are included in income from trading activities.
 
 
80

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 31 December 2011


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Called-up share capital
           
At beginning of period
15,125 
14,630 
 
15,318 
15,317 
15,030 
Ordinary shares issued
193 
523 
 
121 
Preference shares redeemed
(1)
 
Cancellation of non-voting deferred shares
(27)
 
(27)
             
At end of period
15,318 
15,125 
 
15,318 
15,318 
15,125 
             
Paid-in equity
           
At beginning of period
431 
565 
 
431 
431 
431 
Securities redeemed
(132)
 
Transfer to retained earnings
(2)
 
             
At end of period
431 
431 
 
431 
431 
431 
             
Share premium account
           
At beginning of period
23,922 
23,523 
 
23,923 
23,923 
23,858 
Ordinary shares issued
79 
281 
 
78 
64 
Redemption of preference shares classified
  as debt
118 
 
             
At end of period
24,001 
23,922 
 
24,001 
23,923 
23,922 
             
Merger reserve
           
At beginning of period
13,272 
25,522 
 
13,222 
13,222 
13,272 
Transfer to retained earnings
(50)
(12,250)
 
             
At end of period
13,222 
13,272 
 
13,222 
13,222 
13,272 
             
Available-for-sale reserve
           
At beginning of period
(2,037)
(1,755)
 
(292)
(1,026)
(1,242)
Unrealised gains/(losses)
1,769 
179 
 
(179)
1,005 
(1,148)
Realised losses/(gains) (1)
486 
(519)
 
69 
(12)
16 
Tax
(1,175)
74 
 
(555)
(259)
337 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
  businesses (2)
(16)
 
             
At end of period
(957)
(2,037)
 
(957)
(292)
(2,037)
             
Cash flow hedging reserve
           
At beginning of period
(140)
(252)
 
798 
113 
119 
Amount recognised in equity
2,417 
180 
 
389 
1,203 
(149)
Amount transferred from equity to earnings
(993)
(59)
 
(265)
(264)
(197)
Tax
(405)
(67)
 
(43) 
(254)
87 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
  businesses (3)
58 
 
             
At end of period
879 
(140)
 
879 
798 
(140)

For the notes to this table refer to page 83.
 
 
81

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 31 December 2011 (continued)


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Foreign exchange reserve
           
At beginning of period
5,138 
4,528 
 
4,847 
4,834 
5,085 
Retranslation of net assets
(382)
997 
 
(111)
(31)
Foreign currency (losses)/gains on hedges
  of net assets
(10)
(458)
 
20 
10 
(6)
Tax
23 
63 
 
13 
34 
34 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
  businesses
 
25 
             
At end of period
4,775 
5,138 
 
4,775 
4,847 
5,138 
             
Capital redemption reserve
           
At beginning of period
198 
170 
 
198 
198 
172 
Preference shares redeemed
 
(1)
Cancellation of non-voting deferred shares
27 
 
27 
             
At end of period
198 
198 
 
198 
198 
198 
             
Contingent capital reserve
           
At beginning and end of period
(1,208)
(1,208)
 
(1,208)
(1,208)
(1,208)
             
Retained earnings
           
At beginning of period
21,239 
12,134 
 
20,977 
19,726 
20,904 
(Loss)/profit attributable to ordinary and B
  shareholders and other equity owners
           
  - continuing operations
(2,002)
(973)
 
(1,798)
1,225 
12 
  - discontinued operations
(28)
 
Equity preference dividends paid
(105)
 
Paid-in equity dividends paid, net of tax
(19)
 
Transfer from paid-in equity
           
  - gross
 
  - tax
(1)
 
Equity owners gain on withdrawal of
  non-controlling interest
           
  - gross
40 
 
  - tax
(11)
 
Redemption of equity preference shares
(2,968)
 
Gain on redemption of equity preference
  shares
609 
 
Redemption of preference shares classified
  as debt
(118)
 
Transfer from merger reserve
50 
12,250 
 
Actuarial (losses)/gains recognised in
  retirement benefit schemes
           
  - gross
(581)
158 
 
(581)
158 
  - tax
86 
(71)
 
86 
(71)
Purchase of non-controlling interest
(38)
 
(38)
Shares issued under employee share
  schemes
(58)
(13)
 
151 
(2)
(2)
Share-based payments
           
  - gross
200 
385 
 
98 
35 
282 
  - tax
(10)
 
(4)
(8)
(6)
             
At end of period
18,929 
21,239 
 
18,929 
20,977 
21,239 
 
 
82

 
 
Condensed consolidated statement of changes in equity
for the period ended 31 December 2011 (continued)


 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Own shares held
           
At beginning of period
(808)
(121)
 
(771)
(786)
(821)
Disposal/(purchase) of own shares
20 
(700)
 
13 
11 
Shares issued under employee share
  schemes
19 
13 
 
             
At end of period
(769)
(808)
 
(769)
(771)
(808)
             
Owners’ equity at end of period
74,819 
75,132 
 
74,819 
77,443 
75,132 
             
Non-controlling interests
           
At beginning of period
1,719 
16,895 
 
1,433 
1,498 
1,780 
Currency translation adjustments and other
  movements
(54)
(466)
 
(32)
(1)
15 
Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling
  interests
           
  - continuing operations
(14)
(60)
 
(12)
(17)
  - discontinued operations
42 
(605)
 
10 
55 
Dividends paid
(40)
(4,200)
 
(1)
17 
Movements in available-for-sale securities
           
  - unrealised gains/(losses)
(56)
 
(2)
  - realised losses
37 
 
  - tax
(1)
 
(1)
(1)
  - recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
    discontinued operations (4)
(7)
 
Movements in cash flow hedging reserves
           
  - amounts recognised in equity
(120)
 
(21)
  - tax
39 
 
  - recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
    discontinued operations (5)
1,036 
 
15 
Equity raised
559 
 
58 
Equity withdrawn and disposals
(421)
(11,298)
 
(186)
(59)
(188)
Transfer to retained earnings
(40)
 
             
At end of period
1,234 
1,719 
 
1,234 
1,433 
1,719 
             
Total equity at end of period
76,053 
76,851 
 
76,053 
78,876 
76,851 
             
Total comprehensive (loss)/income
  recognised in the statement of
  changes in equity is attributable to:
           
Non-controlling interests
(24)
(197)
 
(12)
(6)
52 
Preference shareholders
105 
 
Paid-in equity holders
19 
 
Ordinary and B shareholders
(756)
(598)
 
(2,949)
2,658 
(902)
             
 
(780)
(671)
 
(2,961)
2,652 
(850)

Notes:
(1)
Includes an impairment loss of £1,099 million in respect of the Group’s holding of Greek government bonds, together with £169 million of related interest rate hedge adjustments, for the year ended 31 December 2011.
(2)
Net of tax (year ended 31 December 2010 - £5 million credit).
(3)
Net of tax (year ended 31 December 2010 - £19 million credit).
(4)
Net of tax (year ended 31 December 2010 - £2 million credit).
(5)
Net of tax (year ended 31 December 2010 - £340 million credit).
 
 
83

 
 
Condensed consolidated cash flow statement
for the year ended 31 December 2011


 
2011 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
     
Operating activities
   
Operating loss before tax
(766)
(399)
Operating loss before tax on discontinued operations
58 
(541)
Adjustments for non-cash items
7,661 
2,571 
     
Net cash inflow from trading activities
6,953 
1,631 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
(3,444)
17,095 
     
Net cash flows from operating activities before tax
3,509 
18,726 
Income taxes received/(paid)
(184)
565 
     
Net cash flows from operating activities
3,325 
19,291 
     
Net cash flows from investing activities
14 
3,351 
     
Net cash flows from financing activities
(1,741)
(14,380)
     
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(1,473)
82 
     
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
125 
8,344 
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
152,530 
144,186 
     
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
152,655 
152,530 
 
 
84

 
 
Notes


1. Basis of preparation
Having reviewed the Group’s forecasts, projections and other relevant evidence, the directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group will continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the accounts for the year ended 31 December 2011 have been prepared on a going concern basis.

2. Accounting policies
The annual accounts are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and interpretations issued by the IFRS Interpretations Committee of the IASB as adopted by the European Union (EU) (together IFRS).

Recent developments in IFRS
In May 2011, the IASB issued six new or revised standards:

IFRS 10 Consolidated Financial Statements which replaces SIC-12 Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities and the consolidation elements of the existing IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements.  The new standard adopts a single definition of control: a reporting entity controls another entity when the reporting entity has the power to direct the activities of that other entity to generate returns for the reporting entity.

IAS 27 Separate Financial Statements which comprises those parts of the existing IAS 27 that dealt with separate financial statements.

IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements which supersedes IAS 31 Interests in Joint Ventures. IFRS 11 distinguishes between joint operations and joint ventures. Joint operations are accounted for by the investor recognising its assets and liabilities including its share of any assets held and liabilities incurred jointly and its share of revenues and costs. Joint ventures are accounted for in the investor’s consolidated accounts using the equity method.

IAS 28 Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures covers joint ventures as well as associates; both must be accounted for using the equity method. The mechanics of the equity method are unchanged.

IFRS 12 Disclosure of Interests in Other Entities covers disclosures for entities reporting under IFRS 10 and IFRS 11 replacing those in IAS 28 and IAS 27. Entities are required to disclose information that helps financial statement readers evaluate the nature, risks and financial effects associated with an entity’s interests in subsidiaries, in associates and joint arrangements and in unconsolidated structured entities.

IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement which sets out a single IFRS framework for defining and measuring fair value and requiring disclosures about fair value measurements.

These standards are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013. Earlier application is permitted. The Group is reviewing the standards to determine their effect on the Group’s financial reporting.
 
 
85

 
 
Notes (continued)


2. Accounting policies (continued)

Recent developments in IFRS (continued)
In June 2011, the IASB issued amendments to two standards:

Amendments to IAS 1 Presentation of Items of Other Comprehensive Income that require items that will never be recognised in profit or loss to be presented separately in other comprehensive income from those that are subject to subsequent reclassification. The amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2012. Earlier application is permitted.

Amendments IAS 19 Employee Benefits - these require the immediate recognition of all actuarial gains and losses eliminating the ‘corridor approach’; interest cost to be calculated on the net pension liability or asset at the appropriate corporate bond rate; and all past service costs to be recognised immediately when a scheme is curtailed or amended. These amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2013. Earlier application is permitted. The Group is reviewing the amendments to determine their effect on the Group’s financial reporting.

In December 2011, the IASB issued Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Amendments to IAS 32) and Disclosures-Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (Amendments to IFRS 7). The amendment to IAS 32 adds application guidance on the meaning of ‘a legally enforceable right to set off’ and on simultaneous settlement. IFRS 7 is amended to require disclosures facilitating comparisons between those entities reporting under IFRS and those reporting under US GAAP.  The amendments are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2014 and are required to be applied retrospectively.
 
 
86

 
 
Notes (continued)


3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Loans and advances to customers
17,969 
18,889 
 
4,336 
4,505 
4,755 
Loans and advances to banks
697 
591 
 
207 
154 
167 
Debt securities
2,744 
3,296 
 
691 
712 
690 
             
Interest receivable
21,410 
22,776 
 
5,234 
5,371 
5,612 
             
Customer accounts
3,529 
3,721 
 
926 
919 
926 
Deposits by banks
982 
1,333 
 
226 
248 
288 
Debt securities in issue
3,371 
3,277 
 
794 
897 
866 
Subordinated liabilities
740 
417 
 
190 
175 
(18)
Internal funding of trading businesses
109 
(181)
 
24 
55 
(30)
             
Interest payable
8,731 
8,567 
 
2,160 
2,294 
2,032 
             
Net interest income
12,679 
14,209 
 
3,074 
3,077 
3,580 
             
Fees and commissions receivable
6,384 
8,193 
 
1,590 
1,452 
2,052 
Fees and commissions payable
           
  - banking
(962)
(1,892)
 
(339)
(204)
(392)
  - insurance related
(498)
(319)
 
(234)
(100)
(57)
             
Net fees and commissions
4,924 
5,982 
 
1,017 
1,148 
1,603 
             
Foreign exchange
1,327 
1,491 
 
308 
441 
217 
Interest rate
760 
1,862 
 
76 
33 
(165)
Credit
(15)
41 
 
(695)
366 
83 
Other
629 
1,123 
 
73 
117 
229 
             
Income/(loss) from trading activities
2,701 
4,517 
 
(238)
957 
364 
             
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
553 
 
(1)
             
Operating lease and other rental income
1,307 
1,394 
 
308 
327 
369 
Changes in fair value of own debt
1,621 
249 
 
(200)
1,887 
472 
Changes in the fair value of securities and
  other financial assets and liabilities
150 
(180)
 
(148)
(83)
Changes in the fair value of investment
  properties
(139)
(405)
 
(65)
(22)
(293)
Profit on sale of securities
882 
496 
 
179 
274 
(10)
Profit on sale of property, plant and
  equipment
22 
50 
 
(5)
29 
(Loss)/profit on sale of subsidiaries and
  associates
(28)
(107) 
 
(15)
(39)
511 
Life business (losses)/profits
(13)
90 
 
(8)
29 
Dividend income
62 
69 
 
15 
14 
11 
Share of profits less losses of associated
  entities
26 
70 
 
14 
Other income
232 
(247)
 
(24)
89 
(46)
             
Other operating income
4,122 
1,479 
 
205 
2,384 
1,003 
 
 
87

 

Notes (continued)


3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses (continued)

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Non-interest income (excluding
  insurance net premium income)
12,002 
12,531 
 
983 
4,490 
2,970 
Insurance net premium income
4,256 
5,128 
 
981 
1,036 
1,272 
             
Total non-interest income
16,258 
17,659 
 
1,964 
5,526 
4,242 
             
Total income
28,937 
31,868 
 
5,038 
8,603 
7,822 
             
             
Staff costs
8,678 
9,671 
 
1,993 
2,076 
2,194 
Premises and equipment
2,451 
2,402 
 
674 
604 
709 
Other (1)
4,931 
3,995 
 
1,296 
962 
1,048 
             
Administrative expenses
16,060 
16,068 
 
3,963 
3,642 
3,951 
Depreciation and amortisation
1,875 
2,150 
 
513 
485 
546 
Write-down of goodwill and other
  intangible assets
91 
10 
 
91 
10 
             
Operating expenses
18,026 
18,228 
 
4,567 
4,127 
4,507 
             
General insurance
2,968 
4,698 
 
529 
734 
1,151 
Bancassurance
85 
 
31 
             
Insurance net claims
2,968 
4,783 
 
529 
734 
1,182 
             
Loan impairment losses
7,241 
9,144 
 
1,654 
1,452 
2,155 
Securities impairment losses
           
  - sovereign debt impairment and related
    interest rate hedge adjustments
1,268 
 
224 
202 
  - other
200 
112 
 
40 
84 
(14)
             
Impairment losses
8,709 
9,256 
 
1,918 
1,738 
2,141 

Note:
(1)
Includes Payment Protection Insurance costs of £850 million reflected in the quarter ended 30 June 2011.
 
 
88

 

Notes (continued)


3. Analysis of income, expenses and impairment losses (continued)

Staff expenses

Staff expenses comprise
2011 
£m 
2010 
£m 
Change
%
       
Salaries
5,423 
5,473 
(1)
Variable compensation
985 
1,246 
(21)
Temporary and contract costs
846 
700 
21 
Share based compensation
197 
397 
(50)
Bonus tax
27 
99 
(73)
Social security costs
640 
661 
(3)
Post retirement benefits
447 
569 
(21)
Other *
113 
526 
(79)
       
Staff  expenses
8,678 
9,671 
(10)

*  Other includes severance costs and variable compensation for disposal groups.

Variable compensation awards
The following table analyses Group and GBM variable compensation awards for 2011, which are 43% and 58% respectively lower than in 2010.
 
Group
 
GBM
 
2011 
£m 
2010 
£m 
Change
%
 
2011 
£m 
2010 
£m 
Change
%
               
Non-deferred cash awards (1)
72 
89 
(19)
 
10 
18 
(44)
Non-deferred share awards
35 
54 
(35)
 
23 
43 
(47)
               
Total non-deferred variable compensation
107 
143 
(25)
 
33 
61 
(46)
               
Deferred bond awards
582 
1,029 
(43)
 
286 
701 
(59)
Deferred share awards
96 
203 
(53)
 
71 
175 
(59)
               
Total deferred variable compensation
678 
1,232 
(45)
 
357 
876 
(59)
               
Total variable compensation
785 
1,375 
(43)
 
390 
937 
(58)
               
Variable compensation as a % of core
  operating profit (2)
11% 
16% 
   
18% 
22% 
 
Proportion of variable compensation that is
  deferred
86% 
90% 
   
92% 
93% 
 
               
Total employees
146,800 
148,500 
(1)
 
17,000 
18,700 
(9)
Variable compensation per employee
£5,347 
£9,260 
(42)
 
£22,941 
£50,114 
(54)

Reconciliation of variable compensation awards to income statement charge
2011 
£m 
2010 
£m 
     
Variable compensation awarded  for 2011
785 
1,375 
Less: deferral of charge for amounts awarded for current year
(302)
(512)
Add: current year charge for amounts deferred  from prior years
502 
383 
     
Income statement charge for variable compensation
985 
1,246 

 
Actual
 
Expected
Year in which income statement charge is expected to be taken for deferred variable compensation
2010 
£m 
2011 
£m 
 
 
2012 
£m 
2013
and beyond 
£m 
           
Variable compensation deferred from 2009 and earlier
383 
160 
 
78 
Variable compensation deferred from  2010
342 
 
105 
65 
Variable compensation for  2011 deferred
 
225 
77 
           
 
383 
502 
 
408 
142 

Notes:
(1)
Cash payments to all employees are limited to £2,000.
(2)
Core operating profit pre variable compensation expense and before one-off and other items.
 
 
89

 
 
Notes (continued)

4. Loan impairment provisions
Operating (loss)/profit is stated after charging loan impairment losses of £7,241 million (2010 - £9,144 million). The balance sheet loan impairment provisions increased in the year ended 31 December 2011 from £18,182 million to £19,883 million and the movements thereon were:

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
At beginning of period
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
6,921 
8,252 
2,110 
17,283 
Transfers to disposal groups
(773)
(773)
 
(72)
(72)
Intra-group transfers
177 
(177)
 
(568)
568 
Currency translation and other
  adjustments
(76)
(207)
(283)
 
(16)
59 
43 
Disposals
 
(20)
(2,152)
(2,172)
Amounts written-off
(2,137)
(2,390)
(4,527)
 
(2,224)
(3,818)
(6,042)
Recoveries of amounts previously
  written-off
167 
360 
527 
 
213 
198
411 
Charge to income statement
                 
  - continued
3,403 
3,838 
7,241 
 
3,737 
5,407
9,144 
  - discontinued
(8)
(8)
 
42 
42 
Unwind of discount (recognised in interest
  income)
(213)
(271)
(484)
 
(197)
(258)
(455)
                   
At end of period
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
At beginning of period
8,873 
11,850 
20,723 
 
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
7,791 
9,879 
17,670 
Transfers to disposal
  groups
(773)
(773)
 
 
(5)
 
(5)
Intra-group transfers
 
 
(217)
217 
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(75)
(162)
(237)
 
(90)
(285)
(375)
 
147 
(235)
(88)
Disposals
(3)
(3)
 
 
(3)
(3)
(6)
Amounts written-off
(526)
(981)
(1,507)
 
(593)
(497)
(1,090)
 
(745)
(771)
(1,516)
Recoveries of amounts
  previously written-off
48 
99 
147 
 
39 
55 
94 
 
29 
67 
96 
Charge to income
  statement
                         
  - continued
924 
730 
1,654 
 
817 
635 
1,452 
 
912 
1,243 
2,155 
  - discontinued
 
 
Unwind of discount
  (recognised in interest
  income)
(57)
(67)
(124)
 
(52)
(65)
(117)
 
(51)
(76)
(127)
                           
At end of period
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
8,873 
11,850 
20,723 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 

Provisions at 31 December 2011 include £123 million (30 September 2011 - £126 million; 31 December 2010 - £127 million) in respect of loans and advances to banks.

The table above excludes impairments relating to securities (see page 23).
 
 
90

 

Notes (continued)


5. Pensions

 
2011 
2010 
Pension costs
£m 
£m 
     
Defined benefit schemes
349 
462 
Defined contribution schemes
98 
107 
     
 
447 
569 

 
2011 
2010 
Net pension deficit/(surplus)
£m 
£m 
     
At 1 January
2,183 
2,905 
Currency translation and other adjustments
(3)
Income statement
   
  - pension costs
   
    - continuing operations
349 
519 
    - discontinued operations
21 
  - curtailment gains: continuing operations
(78)
Net actuarial losses/(gains)
581 
(158)
Contributions by employer
(1,059)
(832)
Disposal of RFS minority interest
(194)
     
At 31 December
2,051 
2,183 
     
Net assets of schemes in surplus
(188)
(105)
Net liabilities of schemes in deficit
2,239 
2,288 

The Group and the Trustees of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group Pension Fund agreed the funding valuation as at 31 March 2010 during the year. It showed that the value of liabilities exceed the value of assets by £3.5 billion as at 31 March 2010, a ratio of assets to liabilities of 84%. In order to eliminate this deficit, the Group will pay additional contributions each year over the period 2011 to 2018. These contributions started at £375 million per annum in 2011, increasing to £400 million per annum in 2013 and from 2016 onwards will be further increased in line with price inflation. These contributions are in addition to the regular annual contributions of around £300 million for future accrual benefits.
 
 
91

 

Notes (continued)


6. Tax
The actual tax (charge)/credit differs from the expected tax (charge)/credit computed by applying the standard UK corporation tax rate of 26.5% (2010 - 28%) as follows:

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
(Loss)/profit before tax
(766)
(399)
 
(1,976)
2,004 
(8)
             
Tax credit/(charge) based on the standard UK
  corporation tax rate of 26.5% (2010 - 28%)
203 
112 
 
524 
(531)
Sovereign debt impairment where no
  deferred tax asset recognised
(275)
 
(56)
(36)
Other losses in period where no deferred
  tax asset recognised
(530)
(450)
 
(195)
(67)
(96)
Foreign profits taxed at other rates
(417)
(517)
 
(46)
(71)
(131)
UK tax rate change - deferred tax impact
(110)
(82)
 
27 
(50)
Unrecognised timing differences
(20)
11 
 
(10)
18 
Non-deductible goodwill impairment
(24)
(3)
 
(24)
(3)
Items not allowed for tax
           
  - losses on strategic disposals and
     write-downs
(72)
(311)
 
(58)
(4)
(129)
  - UK bank levy
(80)
 
(80)
  - employee share schemes
(113)
(32)
 
(101)
(4)
(32)
  - other disallowable items
(271)
(296)
 
(123)
(46)
(162)
Non-taxable items
           
  - gain on sale of Global Merchant Services
12 
221 
 
221 
  - gain on redemption of own debt
11 
 
(1)
  - other non-taxable items
245 
341 
 
208 
16 
240 
Taxable foreign exchange movements
 
Losses brought forward and utilised
 
(29)
(8)
Adjustments in respect of prior periods
196 
355 
 
137 
74 
             
Actual tax (charge)/credit
(1,250)
(634)
 
186 
(791)

The high tax charge in the year ended 31 December 2011 reflects profits in high tax regimes (principally US) and losses in low tax regimes (principally Ireland), losses in overseas subsidiaries for which a deferred tax asset has not been recognised (principally Ireland and the Netherlands) and the effect of the two reductions of 1% in the rate of UK corporation tax enacted in March 2011 and July 2011 on the net deferred tax balance.

The combined effect of the tax losses in Ireland and the Netherlands (including the sovereign debt impairment and related interest rate hedge adjustments) in the year ended 31 December 2011 for which no deferred tax asset has been recognised and the two 1% changes in the standard rate of UK corporation tax, account for £1,020 million (70%) of the difference between the actual tax charge and the tax credit derived from applying the standard UK Corporation Tax rate to the results for the period. The impact of these items for the quarter ended 31 December 2011 is £165 million (49%).
 
 
92

 

Notes (continued)

6. Tax (continued)
The Group has recognised a deferred tax asset at 31 December 2011 of £3,878 million (30 September 2011 - £4,988 million; 31 December 2010 - £6,373 million), of which £2,933 million (30 September 2011 - £3,014 million; 31 December 2010 - £3,849 million) relates to carried forward trading losses in the UK. Under UK tax legislation, these UK losses can be carried forward indefinitely to be utilised against profits arising in the future. The deferred tax asset balance has reduced over the period primarily as a result of the utilisation of tax losses brought forward and the impact of the reductions in the rate of UK corporation tax. The Group has considered the carrying value of this asset as at 31 December 2011 and concluded that it is recoverable based on future profit projections.

7. Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling interests

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Trust preferred securities
10 
 
RBS Sempra Commodities JV
(18)
35 
 
(5)
(8)
(11)
RFS Holdings BV Consortium Members
35 
(726)
 
49 
RBS Life Holdings
26 
 
Other
11 
(10)
 
15 
(2)
(9)
             
Profit/(loss) attributable to non-controlling
  interests
28 
(665)
 
18 
(7)
38 

8. Dividends
The Group has undertaken that, unless otherwise agreed with the European Commission, neither the company nor any of its direct or indirect subsidiaries (other than companies in the RBS Holdings N.V. group, which are subject to different restrictions) will pay external investors any dividends or coupons on existing hybrid capital instruments (including preference shares, B shares and upper and lower tier 2 instruments) from 30 April 2010 and for a period of two years thereafter ("the Deferral period"), or exercise any call rights in relation to these capital instruments between 24 November 2009 and the end of the deferral period, unless there is a legal obligation to do so. Hybrid capital instruments issued after 24 November 2009 will generally not be subject to the restriction on dividend or coupon payments or call options.
 
 
93

 

Notes (continued)

9. Earnings per ordinary and B share
Earnings per ordinary and B share have been calculated based on the following:

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
Earnings
           
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
  attributable to ordinary and B shareholders
(2,002)
(1,097)
 
(1,798)
1,225 
12 
Gain on redemption of preference shares and
  paid-in equity
610 
 
             
(Loss)/adjusted profit from continuing
  operations attributable to ordinary and
  B shareholders
(2,002)
(487)
 
(1,798)
1,225 
12 
             
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations
  attributable to ordinary and B shareholders
(28)
 
             
Ordinary shares in issue during the period
  (millions)
57,219 
56,245 
 
57,552 
57,541 
56,166 
B shares in issue during the period (millions)
51,000 
51,000 
 
51,000 
51,000 
51,000 
             
Weighted average number of ordinary
  and B shares in issue during the
  period (millions)
108,219 
107,245 
 
108,552 
108,541 
107,166 
Effect of dilutive share options and
  convertible securities
 
891 
             
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary
  and B shares in issue during the period
108,219 
107,245 
 
108,552 
109,432 
107,166 
             
Basic (loss)/earnings per ordinary and B
  share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
             
Diluted (loss)/earnings per ordinary and
  B share from continuing operations
(1.8p)
(0.5p)
 
(1.7p)
1.1p 
 
 
94

 

Notes (continued)


10. Segmental analysis
There have been no significant changes in the Group’s divisions during the year.

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss)
The following tables provide an analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) for the years ended 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2010 and the quarters ended 31 December 2011, 30 September 2011 and 31 December 2010 by main income statement captions.

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Year ended 31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
4,272 
1,206 
5,478 
(2,699)
(788)
1,991 
UK Corporate
2,585 
1,275 
3,860 
(1,661)
(785)
1,414 
Wealth
718 
459 
1,177 
(831)
(25)
321 
Global Transaction Services
1,076 
1,175 
2,251 
(1,342)
(166)
743 
Ulster Bank
696 
211 
907 
(547)
(1,384)
(1,024)
US Retail & Commercial
1,896 
1,004 
2,900 
(2,096)
(325)
479 
Global Banking & Markets
665 
5,276 
5,941 
(4,331)
(49)
1,561 
RBS Insurance
343 
3,729 
4,072 
(846)
(2,772)
454 
Central items
(228)
213 
(15)
170 
(1)
156 
               
Core
12,023 
14,548 
26,571 
(14,183)
(2,773)
(3,520)
6,095 
Non-Core
666 
540 
1,206 
(1,295)
(195)
(3,919)
(4,203)
               
Managed basis
12,689 
15,088 
27,777 
(15,478)
(2,968)
(7,439)
1,892 
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
1,846 
1,846 
1,846 
Asset Protection Scheme
(906)
(906)
(906)
Payment Protection Insurance costs
(850)
(850)
Sovereign debt impairment
(1,099)
(1,099)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(222)
(222)
Integration and restructuring costs
(2)
(3)
(5)
(1,059)
(1,064)
Gain on redemption of own debt
255 
255 
255 
Strategic disposals
(24)
(24)
(80)
(104)
Bank levy
(300)
(300)
Bonus tax
(27)
(27)
Write-down of goodwill and other
  intangible assets
(11)
(11)
Interest rate hedge adjustments on
  impaired available-for-sale Greek
  government bonds
(169)
(169)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(8)
(6)
(2)
(7)
               
Statutory basis
12,679 
16,258 
28,937 
(18,026)
(2,968)
(8,709)
(766)

 
95

 

Notes (continued)


10. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Year ended 31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
4,078 
1,422 
5,500 
(2,883)
(85)
(1,160)
1,372 
UK Corporate
2,572 
1,323 
3,895 
(1,671)
(761)
1,463 
Wealth
609 
447 
1,056 
(734)
(18)
304 
Global Transaction Services
974 
1,587 
2,561 
(1,464)
(9)
1,088 
Ulster Bank
761 
214 
975 
(575)
(1,161)
(761)
US Retail & Commercial
1,917 
1,029 
2,946 
(2,123)
(517)
306 
Global Banking & Markets
1,215 
6,697 
7,912 
(4,397)
(151)
3,364 
RBS Insurance
381 
4,135 
4,516 
(879)
(3,932)
(295)
Central items
10 
327 
337 
272 
(29)
(3)
577 
               
Core
12,517 
17,181 
29,698 
(14,454)
(4,046)
(3,780)
7,418 
Non-Core
1,683 
1,281 
2,964 
(2,256)
(737)
(5,476)
(5,505)
               
Managed basis
14,200 
18,462 
32,662 
(16,710)
(4,783)
(9,256)
1,913 
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
174 
174 
174 
Asset Protection Scheme
(1,550)
(1,550)
(1,550)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(369)
(369)
Integration and restructuring costs
(1,032)
(1,032)
Gain on redemption of own debt
553 
553 
553 
Strategic disposals
171 
171 
171 
Bonus tax
(99)
(99)
Write-down of goodwill and other
  intangible assets
(10)
(10)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(151)
(142)
(8)
(150)
               
Statutory basis
14,209 
17,659 
31,868 
(18,228)
(4,783)
(9,256)
(399)
 
 
96

 


Notes (continued)


10. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,036 
277 
1,313 
(661)
(191)
461 
UK Corporate
634 
291 
925 
(416)
(234)
275 
Wealth
191 
112 
303 
(194)
(13)
96 
Global Transaction Services
277 
296 
573 
(329)
(47)
197 
Ulster Bank
171 
49 
220 
(132)
(327)
(239)
US Retail & Commercial
493 
258 
751 
(529)
(65)
157 
Global Banking & Markets
159 
753 
912 
(939)
(68)
(95)
RBS Insurance
82 
841 
923 
(209)
(589)
125 
Central items
(40)
43 
79 
(1)
85 
               
Core
3,003 
2,920 
5,923 
(3,330)
(590)
(941)
1,062 
Non-Core
73 
(377)
(304)
(314)
61 
(751)
(1,308)
               
Managed basis
3,076 
2,543 
5,619 
(3,644)
(529)
(1,692)
(246)
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
(370)
(370)
(370)
Asset Protection Scheme
(209)
(209)
(209)
Sovereign debt impairment
(224)
(224)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(53)
(53)
Integration and restructuring costs
(478)
(478)
Gain on redemption of own debt
(1)
(1)
(1)
Strategic disposals
(2)
(2)
(80)
(82)
Bank levy
(300)
(300)
Write-down of goodwill and other
  intangible assets
(11)
(11)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(2)
(1)
(2)
(2)
               
Statutory basis
3,074 
1,964 
5,038 
(4,567)
(529)
(1,918)
(1,976)
 
 
97

 
 
Notes (continued)


10. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 30 September 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,074 
292 
1,366 
(672)
(195)
499 
UK Corporate
621 
327 
948 
(419)
(228)
301 
Wealth
178 
118 
296 
(221)
(4)
71 
Global Transaction Services
276 
300 
576 
(336)
(45)
195 
Ulster Bank
185 
60 
245 
(137)
(327)
(219)
US Retail & Commercial
483 
257 
740 
(541)
(84)
115 
Global Banking & Markets
161 
938 
1,099 
(1,019)
32 
112 
RBS Insurance
84 
949 
1,033 
(215)
(695)
123 
Central items
(94)
103 
62 
(1)
(3)
67 
               
Core
2,968 
3,344 
6,312 
(3,498)
(696)
(854)
1,264 
Non-Core
110 
(64)
46 
(323)
(38)
(682)
(997)
               
Managed basis
3,078 
3,280 
6,358 
(3,821)
(734)
(1,536)
267 
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
2,357 
2,357 
2,357 
Asset Protection Scheme
(60)
(60)
(60)
Sovereign debt impairment and related
  interest rate hedge adjustments
(202)
(202)
Amortisation of purchased intangible
  assets
(69)
(69)
Integration and restructuring costs
(233)
(233)
Gain on redemption of own debt
Strategic disposals
(49)
(49)
(49)
Bonus tax
(5)
(5)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(1)
(3)
(4)
(3)
               
Statutory basis
3,077 
5,526 
8,603 
(4,127)
(734)
(1,738)
2,004 

 
98

 

Notes (continued)


10. Segmental analysis (continued)

Analysis of divisional operating profit/(loss) (continued)

 
Net 
interest 
 income 
Non- 
interest 
 income 
 
Total 
 income 
 
Operating 
 expenses 
 Insurance 
net claims 
 
Impairment 
 losses 
 
Operating 
 profit/(loss)
Quarter ended 31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
UK Retail
1,088 
402 
1,490 
(679)
(31)
(222)
558 
UK Corporate
653 
330 
983 
(431)
(219)
333 
Wealth
160 
111 
271 
(178)
(6)
87 
Global Transaction Services
263 
375 
638 
(368)
(3)
267 
Ulster Bank
187 
56 
243 
(138)
(376)
(271)
US Retail & Commercial
467 
231 
698 
(529)
(105)
64 
Global Banking & Markets
214 
1,373 
1,587 
(1,065)
527 
RBS Insurance
96 
1,016 
1,112 
(223)
(898)
(9)
Central items
92 
24 
116 
11 
(8)
(4)
115 
               
Core
3,220 
3,918 
7,138 
(3,600)
(937)
(930)
1,671 
Non-Core
358 
(37)
321 
(481)
(245)
(1,211)
(1,616)
               
Managed basis
3,578 
3,881 
7,459 
(4,081)
(1,182)
(2,141)
55 
Reconciling items
             
Fair value of own debt
582 
582 
582 
Asset Protection Scheme
(725)
(725)
(725)
Amortisation of purchased
  intangible assets
(96)
(96)
Integration and restructuring costs
(299)
(299)
Strategic disposals
502 
502 
502 
Bonus tax
(15)
(15)
RFS Holdings minority interest
(6)
 (2)
Write-down of goodwill and other
  intangible assets
(10)
(10)
               
Statutory basis
3,580 
4,242 
7,822 
(4,507)
(1,182)
(2,141)
(8)

 
99

 


Notes (continued)


Total assets by division
 
31 December
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
 2010 
Total assets
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
UK Retail
114,469 
113,308 
111,793 
UK Corporate
111,835 
112,737 
114,550 
Wealth
21,718 
21,946 
21,073 
Global Transaction Services
25,937 
29,889 
25,221 
Ulster Bank
34,810 
37,356 
40,081 
US Retail & Commercial
74,502 
72,879 
71,173 
Global Banking & Markets
874,848 
952,374 
802,578 
RBS Insurance
12,912 
13,031 
12,555 
Central items
130,306 
135,545 
99,728 
       
Core
1,401,337 
1,489,065 
1,298,752 
Non-Core
104,726 
117,671 
153,882 
       
 
1,506,063 
1,606,736 
1,452,634 
RFS Holdings minority interest
804 
992 
942 
       
 
1,506,867 
1,607,728 
1,453,576 

11. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups

Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Discontinued operations
           
Total income
42 
1,433 
 
15 
10 
Operating expenses
(5)
(803)
 
(1)
(3)
(2)
Insurance net claims
(161)
 
Impairment recoveries/(losses)
(42)
 
(3)
(3)
             
Profit before tax
45 
427 
 
11 
Gain on disposal before recycling
  of reserves
113 
 
56 
Recycled reserves
(1,076)
 
             
Operating profit/(loss) before tax
45 
(536)
 
11 
57 
Tax
(11)
(92)
 
(1)
(3)
(3)
             
Profit/(loss) after tax
34 
(628)
 
10 
54 
Businesses acquired exclusively with a
  view to disposal
           
Profit/(loss) after tax
13 
(5)
 
             
Profit/(loss) from discontinued operations,
  net of tax
47 
(633)
 
10 
55 

Discontinued operations reflect the results of RFS Holdings attributable to the State of the Netherlands and Santander following the legal separation of ABN AMRO Bank N.V. on 1 April 2010.
 
 
100

 

Notes (continued)


11. Discontinued operations and assets and liabilities of disposal groups (continued)

 
31 December 2011
30 September 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m 
 
UK branch 
based 
businesses 
Other 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Assets of disposal groups
         
Cash and balances at central banks
100 
27 
127 
119 
184 
Loans and advances to banks
87 
87 
95 
651 
Loans and advances to customers
18,676 
729 
19,405 
1,711 
5,013 
Debt securities and equity shares
10 
20 
Derivatives
431 
439 
24 
5,148 
Intangible assets
15 
15 
Settlement balances
14 
14 
206 
555 
Property, plant and equipment
112 
4,637 
4,749 
220 
18 
Other assets
456 
456 
448 
704 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
19,319 
5,978 
25,297 
2,833 
12,293 
Assets acquired exclusively with a view to disposal
153 
153 
211 
191 
           
 
19,319 
6,131 
25,450 
3,044 
12,484 
           
Liabilities of disposal groups
         
Deposits by banks
288 
266 
Customer accounts
21,784 
826 
22,610 
1,743 
2,267 
Derivatives
117 
126 
24 
5,042 
Settlement balances
264 
907 
Other liabilities
1,233 
1,233 
178 
925 
           
Discontinued operations and other disposal groups
21,901 
2,077 
23,978 
2,497 
9,407 
Liabilities acquired exclusively with a view  to disposal
17 
17 
19 
21 
           
 
21,901 
2,094 
23,995 
2,516 
9,428 

The assets and liabilities of disposal groups at 31 December 2011 primarily comprise the RBS England and Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses (“UK branch-based businesses”) and the RBS Aviation Capital business.

The disposal of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV was substantially completed in 2010. Certain contracts of the RBS Sempra Commodities JV were sold in risk transfer transactions prior to being novated to the purchaser, the majority of which completed during 2011.

UK branch-based businesses
Loans, REIL and impairment provisions at 31 December 2011 relating to the Group's UK branch-based businesses are set out below.

 
Gross loans 
REIL 
Impairment 
 provisions 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Residential mortgages
5,662 
186 
34 
Personal lending
1,801 
333 
284 
Property
4,290 
446 
132 
Construction
416 
181 
58 
Service industries and business activities
4,497 
329 
156 
Other
2,783 
50 
30 
Latent
79 
       
Total
19,449 
1,525 
773 
 
 
101

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments

Classification
The following tables analyse the Group’s financial assets and liabilities in accordance with the categories of financial instruments in IAS 39 with assets and liabilities outside the scope of IAS 39 shown separately.

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at
  central banks
79,269 
     
79,269 
Loans and advances to
  banks
               
  - reverse repos
34,659 
4,781 
     
39,440 
  - other
20,317 
23,553 
     
43,870 
Loans and advances to
  Customers
               
  - reverse repos
53,584 
7,910 
     
61,494 
  - other
25,322 
476 
419,895 
 
8,419 
 
454,112 
Debt securities
95,076 
647 
107,298 
6,059 
     
209,080 
Equity shares
12,433 
774 
1,976 
     
15,183 
Settlement balances
7,771 
     
7,771 
Derivatives
529,618 
           
529,618 
Intangible assets
           
14,858 
14,858 
Property, plant and
  equipment
           
11,868 
11,868 
Deferred tax
           
3,878 
3,878 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,309 
   
9,667 
10,976 
Assets of disposal groups
           
25,450 
25,450 
                 
 
771,009 
1,897 
109,274 
550,547 
 
8,419 
65,721 
1,506,867 

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
102

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
23,342 
   
16,349 
   
39,691 
  - other
34,172 
   
34,941 
   
69,113 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
65,526 
   
23,286 
   
88,812 
  - other
14,286 
5,627 
   
394,230 
   
414,143 
Debt securities in issue
11,492 
35,747 
   
115,382 
   
162,621 
Settlement balances
   
7,477 
   
7,477 
Short positions
41,039 
         
41,039 
Derivatives
523,983 
   
     
523,983 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,683 
19 
21,423 
23,125 
Retirement benefit
  liabilities
       
 
2,239 
2,239 
Deferred tax
       
 
1,945 
1,945 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,312 
6,312 
Subordinated liabilities
903 
   
25,416 
   
26,319 
Liabilities of disposal
  groups
           
23,995 
23,995 
                 
 
713,840 
42,277 
 
618,764 
19 
55,914 
1,430,814 
                 
Equity
             
76,053 
                 
               
1,506,867 

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
103

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
30 September 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at
  central banks
78,445 
     
78,445 
Loans and advances to
  banks
               
  - reverse repos
40,181 
7,946 
     
48,127 
  - other
20,423 
32,179 
     
52,602 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
41,692 
12,440 
     
54,132 
  - other
24,608 
1,040 
450,193 
 
9,732 
 
485,573 
Debt securities
112,568 
162 
110,401 
6,526 
     
229,657 
Equity shares
12,044 
834 
2,010 
     
14,888 
Settlement balances
21,526 
     
21,526 
Derivatives
572,344 
           
572,344 
Intangible assets
           
14,744 
14,744 
Property, plant and
  equipment
           
17,060 
17,060 
Deferred tax
           
4,988 
4,988 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,394 
   
9,204 
10,598 
Assets of disposal groups
           
3,044 
3,044 
                 
 
823,860 
2,036 
112,411 
610,649 
 
9,732 
49,040 
1,607,728 

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
104

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
30 September 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
24,583 
   
11,644 
   
36,227 
  - other
34,754 
   
43,616 
   
78,370 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
67,447 
   
28,244 
   
95,691 
  - other
14,459 
5,836 
   
413,365 
   
433,660 
Debt securities in issue
10,754 
37,910 
   
145,847 
   
194,511 
Settlement balances
   
17,983 
   
17,983 
Short positions
48,495 
         
48,495 
Derivatives
561,790 
           
561,790 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,629 
471 
20,838 
22,938 
Retirement benefit
  liabilities
       
 
1,855 
1,855 
Deferred tax
       
 
1,913 
1,913 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,628 
6,628 
Subordinated liabilities
934 
   
25,341 
   
26,275 
Liabilities of disposal
  groups
           
2,516 
2,516 
                 
 
762,282 
44,680 
   
687,669 
471 
33,750 
1,528,852 
                 
Equity
             
78,876 
                 
               
1,607,728 

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
105

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and balances at
  central banks
57,014 
     
57,014 
Loans and advances to
  banks
               
  - reverse repos
38,215 
4,392 
     
42,607 
  - other
26,082 
31,829 
     
57,911 
Loans and advances to
  customers
               
  - reverse repos
41,110 
11,402 
     
52,512 
  - other
19,903 
1,100 
471,308 
 
10,437 
 
502,748 
Debt securities
98,869 
402 
111,130 
7,079 
     
217,480 
Equity shares
19,186 
1,013 
1,999 
     
22,198 
Settlement balances
11,605 
     
11,605 
Derivatives
427,077 
           
427,077 
Intangible assets
           
14,448 
14,448 
Property, plant and
  equipment
           
16,543 
16,543 
Deferred tax
           
6,373 
6,373 
Prepayments, accrued
  income and other assets
1,306 
   
11,270 
12,576 
Assets of disposal groups
           
12,484 
12,484 
                 
 
670,442 
2,515 
113,129 
595,935 
 
10,437 
61,118 
1,453,576 

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
106

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Classification (continued)

   
AFS (3)
LAR (4)
Other 
financial 
instruments 
(amortised 
cost)
Finance 
leases 
Non 
financial 
assets/ 
liabilities 
Total 
At fair value
through profit or loss
HFT (1)
DFV (2)
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Liabilities
               
Deposits by banks
               
  - repos
20,585 
   
12,154 
   
32,739 
  - other
28,216 
   
37,835 
   
66,051 
Customer accounts
               
  - repos
53,031 
   
29,063 
   
82,094 
  - other
14,357 
4,824 
   
409,418 
   
428,599 
Debt securities in issue
7,730 
43,488 
   
167,154 
   
218,372 
Settlement balances
   
10,991 
   
10,991 
Short positions
43,118 
         
43,118 
Derivatives
423,967 
           
423,967 
Accruals, deferred income
  and other liabilities
   
1,793 
458 
20,838 
23,089 
Retirement benefit
  liabilities
       
 
2,288 
2,288 
Deferred tax
       
 
2,142 
2,142 
Insurance liabilities
       
 
6,794 
6,794 
Subordinated liabilities
1,129 
   
25,924 
   
27,053 
Liabilities of disposal
  groups
           
9,428 
9,428 
                 
 
591,004 
49,441 
   
694,332 
458 
41,490 
1,376,725 
                 
Equity
             
76,851 
                 
               
1,453,576 

Notes:
(1)
Held-for-trading.
(2)
Designated as at fair value through profit or loss.
(3)
Available-for-sale.
(4)
Loans and receivables.

There were no reclassifications in 2011 or 2010.
 
 
107

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Financial instruments carried at fair value
Detailed explanations of the valuation techniques are set out in the Group’s 2011 Annual Report and Accounts. Certain aspects relating to the valuation of financial instruments carried at fair value are discussed below.

Valuation reserves
When valuing financial instruments in the trading book, adjustments are made to mid-market valuations to cover bid-offer spread, liquidity and credit risk. CVA represent an estimate of the adjustment to fair value that a market participant would make to incorporate the credit risk inherent in counterparty derivative exposures.

The table below shows the valuation reserves and adjustments.

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Credit valuation adjustments (CVA)
     
  Monoline insurers
1,198 
2,827 
2,443 
  Credit derivative product companies (CDPCs)
1,034 
1,233 
490 
  Other counterparties
2,254 
2,222 
1,714 
       
 
4,486 
6,282 
4,647 
Bid-offer, liquidity  and other reserves
2,704 
2,712 
2,797 
       
 
7,190 
8,994 
7,444 

Key points

31 December 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
The exposure to monolines reduced over the period primarily due to the restructuring of some  exposures, partially offset by lower prices of underlying reference instruments. The CVA decreased due to the reduction in exposure partially offset by wider credit spreads.
   
·
The exposure to CDPCs has increased over the period, primarily driven by wider credit spreads of the underlying reference loans and bonds. The CVA increased in line with the increase in exposure.
   
·
The CVA held against exposures to other counterparties increased over the period primarily due to wider credit spreads, together with the impact of counterparty rating downgrades.

31 December 2011 compared with 30 September 2011
·
The exposure to monolines reduced over the period primarily due to the restructuring of some exposures. The CVA decreased in line with the reduction in exposure.
   
·
The exposure to CDPCs has decreased over the period, primarily driven by tighter credit spreads of the underlying reference loans and bonds together with a decrease in the relative value of senior tranches compared with the underlying reference portfolios. The CVA decreased in line with the decrease in exposure.
   
·
The CVA held against exposures to other counterparties increased slightly over the period with the impact of counterparty rating downgrades partially offset by tighter credit spreads.
 
 
108

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation reserves (continued)

Own credit
Until the first half of 2011, primary issuance spreads were used to calculate the own credit adjustment for senior debt issuances.  As issuances by the Group declined significantly during 2011, the credit spread used for this adjustment was refined to reference more liquid secondary market senior debt issuance spreads, as they are considered to provide a fairer representation of fair value.

   
Subordinated 
liabilities 
DFV 
£m 
Total (3)
£m 
Derivatives 
£m 
Total 
£m 
Cumulative own credit adjustment (1)
Debt securities in issue (2)
HFT 
£m 
DFV 
£m 
Total 
£m 
               
31 December 2011
882 
2,647 
3,529 
679 
4,208 
602 
4,810 
30 September 2011
939 
3,054 
3,993 
657 
4,650 
700 
5,350 
31 December 2010
517 
1,574 
2,091 
325 
2,416 
534 
2,950 
               
Carrying values of underlying liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
   
               
31 December 2011
11.5 
35.7 
47.2 
0.9 
48.1 
   
30 September 2011
10.8 
37.9 
48.7 
0.9 
49.6 
   
31 December 2010
7.7 
43.5 
51.2 
1.1 
52.3 
   

Notes:
(1)
The own credit adjustment for fair value does not alter cash flows, is not used for performance management and is disregarded for regulatory capital reporting and will reverse over time as the liabilities mature.
(2)
Consists of wholesale and retail note issuances.
(3)
The reserve movement between periods will not equate to the reported profit or loss for own credit. The balance sheet reserves are stated by conversion of underlying currency balances at spot rates for each period whereas the income statement includes intra-period foreign exchange sell-offs.

Key points
·
Own credit adjustment increased significantly during the year reflecting widening credit spreads across all tenors.
   
·
Liabilities decreased due to maturities, redemptions, lower issuances and the appreciation of sterling against the euro.
 
 
 
109

 
 
Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy

 
31 December 2011
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
34.7 
34.7 
 
  - collateral
19.7 
19.7 
 
  - other
0.2 
0.4 
0.6 
 
40 
(50)
               
 
54.6 
0.4 
55.0 
 
40 
(50)
               
Loans and advances to customers
             
  - reverse repos
53.6 
53.6 
 
  - collateral
22.0 
22.0 
 
  - other
3.4 
0.4 
3.8 
 
80 
(20)
               
 
79.0 
0.4 
79.4 
 
80 
(20)
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
22.4 
22.4 
 
  - US government
35.5 
5.0 
40.5 
 
  - other government
53.9 
8.7 
62.6 
 
  - corporate
5.0 
0.5 
5.5 
 
30 
(30)
  - other financial institutions
3.0 
61.6 
7.4 
72.0 
 
560 
(180)
               
 
114.8 
80.3 
7.9 
203.0 
 
590 
(210)
               
Equity shares
12.4 
1.8 
1.0 
15.2 
 
140 
(130)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
72.9 
1.6 
74.5 
 
100 
(100)
  - interest rate
0.2 
420.8 
1.1 
422.1 
 
80 
(80)
  - equities and commodities
5.9 
0.2 
6.1 
 
  - credit
23.1 
3.8 
26.9 
 
680 
(400)
               
 
0.2 
522.7 
6.7 
529.6 
 
860 
(580)
               
 
127.4 
738.4 
16.4 
882.2 
 
1,710 
(990)
               
Proportion
14.4% 
83.7% 
1.9% 
100.0% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
126.9 
724.5 
7.2 
858.6 
     
Non-Core
0.5 
13.9 
9.2 
23.6 
     
               
 
127.4 
738.4 
16.4 
882.2 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 107.
 
 
110

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 December 2010
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Loans and advances to banks
             
  - reverse repos
38.2 
38.2 
 
  - collateral
25.1 
25.1 
 
  - other
0.6 
0.4 
1.0 
 
40 
(20)
               
 
63.9 
0.4 
64.3 
 
40 
(20)
               
Loans and advances to customers
 
           
  - reverse repos
41.1 
41.1 
 
  - collateral
14.4 
14.4 
 
  - other
6.2 
0.4 
6.6 
 
30 
(40)
               
 
61.7 
0.4 
62.1 
 
30 
(40)
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
13.5 
13.5 
 
  - US government
31.0 
7.0 
38.0 
 
  - other government
62.3 
13.6 
75.9 
 
  - corporate
6.5 
1.2 
7.7 
 
210 
(170)
  - other financial institutions
3.5 
64.8 
7.0 
75.3 
 
540 
(180)
               
 
110.3 
91.9 
8.2 
210.4 
 
750 
(350)
               
Equity shares
18.4 
2.8 
1.0 
22.2 
 
160 
(160)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
83.2 
0.1 
83.3 
 
  - interest rate
1.7 
308.3 
1.7 
311.7 
 
150 
(140)
  - equities and commodities
0.1 
4.9 
0.2 
5.2 
 
  - credit - APS (2)
0.6 
0.6 
 
860 
(940)
  - credit - other
23.2 
3.1 
26.3 
 
320 
(170)
               
 
1.8 
419.6 
5.7 
427.1 
 
1,330 
(1,250)
               
 
130.5 
639.9 
15.7 
786.1 
 
2,310 
(1,820)
               
Proportion
16.6% 
81.4% 
2.0% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
129.4 
617.6 
7.2 
754.2 
     
Non-Core
1.1 
22.3 
8.5 
31.9 
     
               
 
130.5 
639.9 
15.7 
786.1 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 114.
 
 
111

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

The following tables detail AFS assets included within total assets on pages 102 and 106.

 
31 December 2011
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
13.4 
13.4 
 
  - US government
18.1 
2.7 
20.8 
 
  - other government
21.6 
4.0 
25.6 
 
  - corporate
2.3 
0.2 
2.5 
 
10 
(10)
  - other financial institutions
0.2 
39.3 
5.5 
45.0 
 
310 
(50)
               
 
53.3 
48.3 
5.7 
107.3 
 
320 
(60)
Equity shares
0.3 
1.3 
0.4 
2.0 
 
70 
(70)
               
 
53.6 
49.6 
6.1 
109.3 
 
390 
(130)
               
Of which
             
Core
53.6 
46.9 
0.6 
101.1 
     
Non-Core
2.7 
5.5 
8.2 
     
               
 
53.6 
49.6 
6.1 
109.3 
     


 
31 December 2010
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Assets
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Debt securities
             
  - UK government
8.4 
8.4 
 
  - US government
17.8 
4.4 
22.2 
 
  - other government
26.5 
6.4 
32.9 
 
  - corporate
1.4 
0.1 
1.5 
 
20 
(20)
  - other financial institutions
0.4 
41.4 
4.3 
46.1 
 
280 
(40)
               
 
53.1 
53.6 
4.4 
111.1 
 
300 
(60)
Equity shares
0.3 
1.4 
0.3 
2.0 
 
60 
(60)
               
 
53.4 
55.0 
4.7 
113.1 
 
360 
(120)
               
Of which
             
Core
52.8 
49.2 
1.0 
103.0 
     
Non-Core
0.6 
5.8 
3.7 
10.1 
     
               
 
53.4 
55.0 
4.7 
113.1 
     


For the notes to this table refer to page 114.
 
 
112

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 December 2011
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
23.3 
23.3 
 
  - collateral
31.8 
31.8 
 
  - other
2.4 
2.4 
 
               
 
57.5 
57.5 
 
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
65.5 
65.5 
 
  - collateral
9.2 
9.2 
 
  - other
10.8 
10.8 
 
20 
(20)
               
 
85.5 
85.5 
 
20 
(20)
               
Debt securities in issue
45.0 
2.2 
47.2 
 
80 
(60)
               
Short positions
34.4 
6.3 
0.3 
41.0 
 
10 
(100)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
80.5 
0.4 
80.9 
 
30 
(20)
  - interest rate
0.4 
405.5 
1.1 
407.0 
 
80 
(90)
  - equities and commodities
8.9 
0.5 
9.4 
 
10 
(10)
  - credit - APS (2)
0.2 
0.2 
 
300 
(40)
  - credit - other
24.9 
1.6 
26.5 
 
80 
(130)
               
 
0.4 
519.8 
3.8 
524.0 
 
500 
(290)
               
Subordinated liabilities
0.9 
0.9 
 
               
Total
34.8 
715.0 
6.3 
756.1 
 
610 
(470)
               
Proportion
4.6% 
94.6% 
0.8% 
100.0% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
34.8 
708.9 
5.7 
749.4 
     
Non-Core
6.1 
0.6 
6.7 
     
               
Total
34.8 
715.0 
6.3 
756.1 
     

For the notes to this table refer to page 114.
 
 
113

 
 

Notes (continued)

12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

 
31 December 2010
           
Level 3 sensitivity (1)
 
Level 1 
Level 2 
Level 3 
Total 
 
Favourable 
Unfavourable 
Liabilities
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£m 
£m 
               
Deposits by banks
             
  - repos
20.6 
20.6 
 
  - collateral
26.6 
26.6 
 
  - other
1.6 
1.6 
 
               
 
48.8 
48.8 
 
               
Customer accounts
             
  - repos
53.0 
53.0 
 
  - collateral
10.4 
10.4 
 
  - other
8.7 
0.1 
8.8 
 
60 
(60)
               
 
72.1 
0.1 
72.2 
 
60 
(60)
               
Debt securities in issue
49.0 
2.2 
51.2 
 
90 
(110)
               
Short positions
35.0 
7.3 
0.8 
43.1 
 
20 
(50)
               
Derivatives
             
  - foreign exchange
0.1 
89.3 
89.4 
 
(10)
  - interest rate
0.2 
298.0 
1.0 
299.2 
 
70 
(90)
  - equities and commodities
0.1 
9.6 
0.4 
10.1 
 
10 
  - credit - other
25.0 
0.3 
25.3 
 
40 
(40)
               
 
0.4 
421.9 
1.7 
424.0 
 
120 
(140)
               
Subordinated liabilities
1.1 
1.1 
 
               
Total
35.4 
600.2 
4.8 
640.4 
 
290 
(360)
               
Proportion
5.5% 
93.7% 
0.8% 
100% 
     
               
Of which
             
Core
35.4 
586.9 
3.8 
626.1 
     
Non-Core
13.3 
1.0 
14.3 
     
               
Total
35.4 
600.2 
4.8 
640.4 
     

Notes:
(1)
Sensitivity represents the favourable and unfavourable effect respectively on the income statement or the statement of comprehensive income due to reasonably possible changes to valuations using reasonably possible alternative inputs to the Group’s valuation techniques or models. The level 3 sensitivities are calculated at a sub-portfolio level and hence these aggregated figures do not reflect the correlation between some of the sensitivities.
(2)
Asset Protection Scheme.
 

 
 
114

 

Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Valuation hierarchy (continued)

Key points
·
Total assets carried at fair value increased by £96.1 billion in the year to £882.2 billion at 31 December 2011, principally reflecting increases in derivative assets (£102.5 billion) and reverse repos of (£9.0 billion), partially offset by decreases in debt securities (£7.4 billion), equity shares  (£7.0 billion) and derivative collateral (£2.2 billion).
   
·
Total liabilities carried at fair value increased by £115.7 billion, with increases in derivative liabilities (£100.0 billion), repos (£15.2 billion) and collateral (£4.0 billion), partially offset by decreases in debt securities in issue (£4.0 billion) and short positions (£2.1 billion).
   
·
Level 3 assets of £16.4 billion represented 1.9% (2010 - £15.7 billion and 2.0%), an increase of £0.7 billion.  This reflected transfers from level 2 to level 3 of £5.7 billion in the latter part of 2011 in light of liquidity in the market as well as maturity and sale of instruments. These transfers to level 3 principally related to structured credit assets in Non-Core and certain foreign exchange options and credit derivatives in GBM.  £1.9 billion (derivatives £1.4 billion, securities £0.5 billion) was transferred from level 3 to level 2, based on the re-assessment of the impact and nature of unobservable inputs used in valuation models.
   
·
Level 3 liabilities increased to £6.3 billion in the year from £4.8 billion, mainly in credit derivatives due to market liquidity and resultant transfers from level 2 to level 3.
   
·
The favourable and unfavourable effects of reasonably possible alternative assumptions on level 3 instruments carried at fair value excluding APS credit derivatives were £2.0 billion (2010 - £1.7 billion) and £(1.4) billion (2010 - £(1.2) billion) respectively. Favourable and unfavourable sensitivities for APS credit derivatives were £0.3 billion (2010 - £0.9 billion) and £(0.1) billion (2010 - (0.9) billion). The change in APS sensitivities reflected the decrease in overall value of the Scheme.
   
·
There were no significant transfers between level 1 and level 2.
 
 
115

 

 
Notes (continued)


12. Financial instruments (continued)

Movement in level 3 portfolios

 
1 January 
 2011 
Gains or 
losses (1)
 
Purchases 
and issues 
Sales and 
settle- 
ments 
FX (2)
31 December
 2011
 
Amounts 
recorded in the 
income statement 
relating to 
instruments held at 
31 December 
2011 
 
Level 3 transfers
In 
Out 
 
£m 
£m  
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m
£m
 
£m
                     
Assets
                   
Fair value through
profit or loss:
                   
Loans and
  advances
843 
(15)
145 
701 
(920)
760 
 
(11)
Debt securities
3,784 
(177)
164 
(380)
1,014 
(2,175)
13 
2,243 
 
(61)
Equity shares
716 
(46)
143 
(33)
56 
(258)
(5)
573 
 
(43)
Derivatives
5,737 
(511)
3,042 
(1,441)
684 
(834)
55 
6,732 
 
(522)
                     
 
11,080 
(749)
3,494 
(1,854)
2,455 
(4,187)
69 
10,308 
 
(637)
                     
AFS:
                   
Debt securities
4,379 
2,097 
(21)
98 
(864)
5,697 
 
Equity shares
279 
61 
82 
(30)
(4)
395 
 
(4)
                     
 
4,658 
66 
2,179 
(21)
105 
(894)
(1)
6,092 
 
(2)
                     
Total
15,738 
(683)
5,673 
(1,875)
2,560 
(5,081)
68 
16,400 
 
(639)
                     
Liabilities
                   
Deposits
84 
(35)
(24)
(4)
22 
 
(25)
Debt securities
  in issue
2,203 
(201)
948 
(520)
688 
(886)
(33)
2,199 
 
(50)
Short positions
776 
(71)
58 
(3)
34 
(506)
291 
 
(207)
Derivatives
1,740 
279 
1,822 
(240)
538 
(366)
38 
3,811 
 
325 
Other
(1)
 
                     
Total
4,804 
(28)
2,828 
(788)
1,260 
(1,762)
6,323 
 
43 
                     
Net losses
 
(655)
             
(682)

Notes:
(1)
Net (losses)/gains recognised in the income statement and statement of comprehensive income during the year were £(717) million and £62 million respectively.
(2)
Foreign exchange movements.
 
 
116

 

Notes (continued)


13. Available-for-sale financial assets
The 2011 full year movement in available-for-sale financial assets reflects net unrealised gains on securities of £2,339 million, primarily as yields tightened on high quality sovereign bonds. This was partially offset by the transfer to profit or loss of realised gains primarily from routine portfolio management in Group Treasury of £545 million, along with disposals across several divisions.  Impairment of Greek government debt led to the recycling of unrealised losses to the income statement.

The Q4 2011 movement mainly reflects net realised gains of £155 million. Unrealised gains in Q3 2011 principally related to gains in UK government bonds, reflecting flight to quality.

The 2011 full year and Q4 2011 tax charge include a £664 million write-off of deferred tax assets in The Netherlands.

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Available-for-sale reserve
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
At beginning of period
(2,037)
(1,755)
 
(292)
(1,026)
(1,242)
Unrealised losses on Greek sovereign debt
(570)
(437)
 
(224)
(202)
(7)
Impairment of Greek sovereign debt
1,268 
 
224 
202 
Other unrealised net gains/(losses)
2,339 
616 
 
45 
1,207 
(1,141)
Realised net (gains)/losses
(782)
(519)
 
(155)
(214)
16 
Tax
(1,175)
74 
 
(555)
(259)
337 
Recycled to profit or loss on disposal of
  businesses (1)
(16)
 
             
At end of period
(957)
(2,037)
 
(957)
(292)
(2,037)

Note:
(1)
Net of tax - £5 million credit.

In Q2 2011, as a result of the deterioration in Greece’s fiscal position and the announcement of proposals to restructure Greek government debt, the Group concluded that the Greek sovereign debt was impaired. Accordingly, £733 million of unrealised losses recognised in available-for-sale reserves together with £109 million related interest rate hedge adjustments were recycled to the income statement. Further losses of £142 million and £224 million were recorded in Q3 2011 and Q4 2011 respectively, along with £60 of million related interest rate hedge adjustments in Q3 2011.

Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain are facing less acute fiscal difficulties and the Group’s sovereign exposures to these countries were not considered impaired at 31 December 2011.
 
 
117

 

Notes (continued)


14. Contingent liabilities and commitments

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Contingent liabilities
                     
Guarantees and assets pledged
  as collateral security
23,702 
1,330 
25,032 
 
24,518 
1,417 
25,935 
 
28,859 
2,242 
31,101 
Other contingent liabilities
10,667 
245 
10,912 
 
10,916 
215 
11,131 
 
11,833 
421 
12,254 
                       
 
34,369 
1,575 
35,944 
 
35,434 
1,632 
37,066 
 
40,692 
2,663 
43,355 
                       
Commitments
                     
Undrawn formal standby
  facilities, credit lines and other
  commitments to lend
227,419 
12,544 
239,963 
 
230,369 
14,258 
244,627 
 
245,425 
21,397 
266,822 
Other commitments
301 
2,611 
2,912 
 
1,163 
2,228 
3,391 
 
1,560 
2,594 
4,154 
                       
 
227,720 
15,155 
242,875 
 
231,532 
16,486 
248,018 
 
246,985 
23,991 
270,976 
                       
Total contingent liabilities
  and commitments
262,089 
16,730 
278,819 
 
266,966 
18,118 
285,084 
 
287,677 
26,654 
314,331 

Additional contingent liabilities arise in the normal course of the Group’s business. It is not anticipated that any material loss will arise from these transactions.

15. Litigation
The Group and certain Group members are party to legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters in the United Kingdom, the United States and other jurisdictions, arising out of their normal business operations. All such matters are periodically reassessed with the assistance of external professional advisers, where appropriate, to determine the likelihood of the Group incurring a liability. The Group recognises a provision for a liability in relation to these matters when it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle an obligation which has arisen as a result of past events, and for which a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.

In many proceedings, it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss.  Numerous legal and factual issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings in question, before a liability can be reasonably estimated for any claim.  The Group cannot predict if, how, or when such claims will be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, may be, particularly for claims that are at an early stage in their development or where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages.

While the outcome of the legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters in which the Group is involved is inherently uncertain, management believes that, based on the information available to it, appropriate provisions have been made in respect of legal proceedings, investigations and regulatory matters as at 31 December 2011.
 
 
118

 

 
Notes (continued)


15. Litigation (continued)
Other than as set out in these sections entitled “Litigation” and “Investigations, reviews and proceedings”, no member of the Group is or has been involved in any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings (including any such proceedings which are pending or threatened of which RBS is aware) during the 12 months prior to the date of this document which may have, or have had in the recent past, significant effects on the financial position or profitability of RBS and/or the Group taken as a whole.

In each of the material legal proceedings and investigations, reviews and proceedings described below, unless specifically noted otherwise, it is not possible to reliably estimate with any certainty the liability, if any, or the effect these proceedings investigations and reviews, and any related developments, may have on the Group.  However, in the event that any such matters were resolved against the Group, these matters could, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Set out below are descriptions of the material legal proceedings involving the Group.

Shareholder litigation
RBS and certain of its subsidiaries, together with certain current and former individual officers and directors have been named as defendants in purported class actions filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York involving holders of RBS preferred shares (the “Preferred Shares litigation”) and holders of American Depositary Receipts (the “ADR claims”).

In the Preferred Shares litigation, the consolidated amended complaint alleges certain false and misleading statements and omissions in public filings and other communications during the period 1 March 2007 to 19 January 2009, and variously asserts claims under Sections 11, 12 and 15 of the US Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”). The putative class is composed of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired Group Series Q, R, S, T and/or U non-cumulative dollar preference shares issued pursuant or traceable to the 8 April 2005 US Securities and Exchange Commission (the SEC) registration statement. Plaintiffs seek unquantified damages on behalf of the putative class. The defendants have moved to dismiss the complaint and briefing on the motions was completed in September 2011.

With respect to the ADR Claims, a complaint was filed in January 2011 and a further complaint was filed in February 2011 asserting claims under Sections 10 and 20 of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) on behalf of all persons who purchased or otherwise acquired the Group’s American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) between 1 March 2007 and 19 January 2009. On 18 August 2011, these two ADR cases were consolidated and lead plaintiff and lead counsel were appointed.  On 1 November 2011, the lead plaintiff filed a consolidated amended complaint asserting ADR-related claims under Sections 10 and 20 of the Exchange Act and Sections 11, 12 and 15 of the Securities Act.  The defendants moved to dismiss the complaint in January 2012 and briefing is ongoing.

The Group has also received notification of similar prospective claims in the United Kingdom and elsewhere but no court proceedings have been commenced in relation to these claims.

The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to the remaining and prospective claims and will defend itself vigorously.

 
119

 

Notes (continued)


15. Litigation (continued)

Other securitisation and securities related litigation in the United States
Recently, the level of litigation activity in the financial services industry focused on residential mortgage and credit crisis related matters has increased.  As a result, the Group has become and expects that it may further be the subject of additional claims for damages and other relief regarding residential mortgages and related securities in the future.

To date, Group companies have been named as defendants in their various roles as issuer, depositor and/or underwriter in a number of claims in the United States that relate to the securitisation and securities underwriting businesses. These cases include actions by individual purchasers of securities and purported class action suits. Together, the individual and class action cases involve the issuance of more than US$83 billion of mortgage-backed securities (MBS) issued primarily from 2005 to 2007. Although the allegations vary by claim, in general, plaintiffs in these actions claim that certain disclosures made in connection with the relevant offerings contained materially false or misleading statements and/or omissions regarding the underwriting standards pursuant to which the mortgage loans underlying the securities were issued. Group companies have been named as defendants in more than 30 lawsuits brought by purchasers of MBS, including five purported class actions.  Among the lawsuits are six cases filed on 2 September 2011 by the US Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA) as conservator for the Federal National Mortgage Association ("Fannie Mae") and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ("Freddie Mac"). The primary FHFA lawsuit pending in the federal court in Connecticut relates to approximately US$32 billion of AAA rated MBS for which Group entities acted as sponsor/depositor and/or lead underwriter or co-lead underwriter.

FHFA has also filed five separate lawsuits (against Ally Financial Group, Countrywide Financial Corporation, JP Morgan, Morgan Stanley and Nomura respectively) in which RBS Securities Inc. is named as a defendant by virtue of the fact that it was an underwriter of some of the securities at issue.

Other lawsuits against Group companies include two cases filed by the National Credit Union Administration Board (on behalf of US Central Federal Credit Union and Western Corporate Federal Credit Union) and eight cases filed by the Federal Home Loan Banks of Boston, Chicago, Indianapolis, Seattle and San Francisco.

The purported MBS class actions in which Group companies are defendants include New Jersey Carpenters Vacation Fund et al. v. The Royal Bank of Scotland plc et al.;  New Jersey Carpenters Health Fund v. Novastar Mortgage Inc. et al.;  In re IndyMac Mortgage-Backed Securities Litigation;  Genesee County Employees’ Retirement System et al.  v. Thornburg Mortgage Securities Trust 2006-3, et al.; and Luther v. Countrywide Financial Corp. et al. and related cases.

Certain other institutional investors have threatened to bring claims against the Group in connection with various mortgage-related offerings. The Group cannot predict with any certainty whether any of these individual investors will pursue these threatened claims (or their outcome), but expects that several may. If such claims are asserted and were successful, the amounts involved may be material.
 
 
120

 

Notes (continued)


15. Litigation (continued)
In many of these actions, the Group has or will have contractual claims to indemnification from the issuers of the securities (where a Group company is underwriter) and/or the underlying mortgage originator (where a Group company is issuer). The amount and extent of any recovery on an indemnification claim, however, is uncertain and subject to a number of factors, including the ongoing creditworthiness of the indemnifying party.

With respect to the current claims described above, the Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and will continue to defend them vigorously.

Madoff
In December 2010, Irving Picard, as trustee for the bankruptcy estates of Bernard L. Madoff and Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC filed a claim against RBS N.V. for approximately US$271 million. This is a clawback action similar to claims filed against six other institutions in December 2010. RBS N.V. (or its subsidiaries) invested in Madoff funds through feeder funds. The Trustee alleges that RBS N.V. received US$71 million in redemptions from the feeder funds and US$200 million from its swap counterparties while RBS N.V. ‘knew or should have known of Madoff’s possible fraud’. The Trustee alleges that those transfers were preferences or fraudulent conveyances under the US bankruptcy code and New York law and he asserts the purported right to claw them back for the benefit of Madoff’s estate. A further claim, for US$21.8 million, was filed in October 2011.  The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and intends to defend itself vigorously.

Unarranged overdraft charges
In the US, Citizens Financial Group, Inc (“Citizens”) in common with other US banks, has been named as a defendant in a class action asserting that Citizens charges excessive overdraft fees. The plaintiffs claim that overdraft fees resulting from point of sale and automated teller machine (ATM) transactions violate the duty of good faith implied in Citizens’ customer account agreement and constitute an unfair trade practice. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these claims and will defend them vigorously.

London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)
Certain members of the Group have been named as defendants in a number of class actions and individual claims filed in the US with respect to the setting of LIBOR. The complaints are substantially similar and allege that certain members of the Group and other panel banks individually and collectively violated US commodities and antitrust laws and state common law by manipulating LIBOR and prices of LIBOR-based derivatives in various markets through various means. The Group considers that it has substantial and credible legal and factual defences to these and prospective claims.

Summary of other disputes, legal proceedings and litigation
In addition to the matters described above, members of the Group are engaged in other legal proceedings in the United Kingdom and a number of overseas jurisdictions, including the United States, involving claims by and against them arising in the ordinary course of business. The Group has reviewed these other actual, threatened and known potential claims and proceedings and, after consulting with its legal advisers, does not expect that the outcome of any of these other claims and proceedings will have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.
 
 
121

 
 
Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings
The Group’s businesses and financial condition can be affected by the fiscal or other policies and actions of various governmental and regulatory authorities in the United Kingdom, the European Union, the United States and elsewhere. The Group has engaged, and will continue to engage, in discussions with relevant regulators, including in the United Kingdom and the United States, on an ongoing and regular basis regarding operational, systems and control evaluations and issues including those related to compliance with applicable anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and sanctions regimes. It is possible that any matters discussed or identified may result in investigatory or other action being taken by the regulators, increased costs being incurred by the Group, remediation of systems and controls, public or private censure, restriction of the Group’s business activities or fines. Any of these events or circumstances could have a significant effect on the Group, its business, authorisations and licences, reputation, results of operations or the price of securities issued by it.

Political and regulatory scrutiny of the operation of retail banking and consumer credit industries in the United Kingdom, United States and elsewhere continues. The nature and impact of future changes in policies and regulatory action are not predictable and are beyond the Group’s control but could have a significant effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

The Group is cooperating fully with the investigations and proceedings described below.

Retail banking
In the European Union, regulatory actions included an inquiry into retail banking initiated on 13 June 2005 in all of the then 25 member states by the European Commission’s Directorate General for Competition. The inquiry examined retail banking in Europe generally. On 31 January 2007, the European Commission (EC) announced that barriers to competition in certain areas of retail banking, payment cards and payment systems in the European Union had been identified. The EC indicated that it will consider using its powers to address these barriers and will encourage national competition authorities to enforce European and national competition laws where appropriate. In addition, in late 2010, the EC launched an initiative pressing for increased transparency in respect of bank fees. The EC is currently proposing to legislate for the increased harmonisation of terminology across Member States, with proposals expected in 2012.  The Group cannot predict the outcome of these actions at this stage and is unable reliably to estimate the effect, if any, that these may have on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

Multilateral interchange fees
In 2007, the EC issued a decision that while interchange is not illegal per se, MasterCard’s current multilateral interchange fee (MIF) arrangements for cross-border payment card transactions with MasterCard and Maestro branded consumer credit and debit cards in the European Union are in breach of competition law. MasterCard was required by the decision to withdraw the relevant cross-border MIF (i.e. set these fees to zero) by 21 June 2008.
 
 
122

 

 
Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)
MasterCard appealed against the decision to the European Court of First Instance (subsequently re-named the General Court) on 1 March 2008, and the Group has intervened in the appeal proceedings. In addition, in summer 2008, MasterCard announced various changes to its scheme arrangements. The EC was concerned that these changes might be used as a means of circumventing the requirements of the infringement decision. In April 2009, MasterCard agreed an interim settlement on the level of cross-border MIF with the EC pending the outcome of the appeal process and, as a result, the EC has advised it will no longer investigate the non-compliance issue (although MasterCard is continuing with its appeal). The appeal was heard on 8 July 2011 by the General Court and judgment is awaited. This could be delivered in spring or summer 2012, although it may take longer.

Visa’s cross-border MIFs were exempted in 2002 by the EC for a period of five years up to 31 December 2007 subject to certain conditions. On 26 March 2008, the EC opened a formal inquiry into Visa’s current MIF arrangements for cross border payment card transactions with Visa branded debit and consumer credit cards in the European Union and on 6 April 2009 the EC announced that it had issued Visa with a formal Statement of Objections. At the same time Visa announced changes to its interchange levels and introduced some changes to enhance transparency. There is no deadline for the closure of the inquiry. However, on 26 April 2010 Visa announced it had reached an agreement with the EC as regards immediate cross border debit card MIF rates only and in December 2010 the commitments were finalised for a four year period commencing December 2010 under Article 9 of Regulation 1/2003. The EC is continuing its investigations into Visa’s cross border MIF arrangements for deferred debit and credit transactions.

In the UK, the Office of Fair Trading (OFT) has carried out investigations into Visa and MasterCard domestic credit card interchange rates. The decision by the OFT in the MasterCard interchange case was set aside by the Competition Appeal Tribunal (CAT) in June 2006. The OFT’s investigations in the Visa interchange case and a second MasterCard interchange case are ongoing. On 9 February 2007, the OFT announced that it was expanding its investigation into domestic interchange rates to include debit cards. In January 2010 the OFT advised that it did not anticipate issuing a Statement of Objections prior to the General Court’s judgment, although it has reserved the right to do so if it considers it appropriate.

The outcome of these investigations is not known, but they may have a significant effect on the consumer credit industry in general and, therefore, on the Group’s business in this sector.
 
 
123

 
 
Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)

Payment Protection Insurance
Having conducted a market study relating to Payment Protection Insurance (PPI), in February 2007 the OFT referred the PPI market to the Competition Commission (CC) for an in-depth inquiry. The CC published its final report in January 2009 and announced its intention to order a range of remedies, including a prohibition on actively selling PPI at point of sale of the credit product (and for 7 days thereafter), a ban on single premium policies and other measures to increase transparency (in order to improve customers’ ability to search and improve price competition). Barclays Bank PLC subsequently appealed certain CC findings to the CAT. In October 2009, the CAT handed down a judgment remitting the matter back to the CC for review. Following further review, in October 2010, the CC published its final decision on remedies following the remittal which confirmed the point of sale prohibition. In March 2011, the CC made a final order setting out its remedies with a commencement date of 6 April 2011. The key remedies come into force in two parts. A number came into force in October 2011, and the remainder come into force in April 2012.

The FSA conducted a broad industry thematic review of PPI sales practices and in September 2008, the FSA announced that it intended to escalate its level of regulatory intervention. Substantial numbers of customer complaints alleging the mis-selling of PPI policies have been made to banks and to the Financial Ombudsman Service (FOS) and many of these are being upheld by the FOS against the banks.

Following unsuccessful negotiations with the industry, the FSA issued consultation papers on PPI complaint handling and redress in September 2009 and in March 2010. The FSA published its final policy statement in August 2010. The new rules imposed significant changes with respect to the handling of mis-selling PPI complaints. In October 2010, the British Bankers’ Association (BBA) filed an application for judicial review of the FSA’s policy statement and of related guidance issued by the FOS.   In April 2011 the High Court issued judgment in favour of the FSA and the FOS and in May 2011 the BBA announced that it would not appeal that judgment. The Group then recorded an additional provision of £850 million in respect of PPI.  During 2011, the Group reached agreement with the FSA on a process for implementation of its policy statement and for the future handling of PPI complaints.

Personal current accounts
On 16 July 2008, the OFT published the results of its market study into Personal Current Accounts (PCAs) in the United Kingdom. The OFT found evidence of competition and several positive features in the personal current account market but believed that the market as a whole was not working well for consumers and that the ability of the market to function well had become distorted.

On 7 October 2009, the OFT published a follow-up report summarising the initiatives agreed between the OFT and personal current account providers to address the OFT’s concerns about transparency and switching, following its market study. Personal current account providers will take a number of steps to improve transparency, including providing customers with an annual summary of the cost of their account and making charges prominent on monthly statements. To improve the switching process, a number of steps are being introduced following work with Bacs, the payment processor, including measures to reduce the impact on consumers of any problems with transferring direct debits.

 
124

 

Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)
On 22 December 2009, the OFT published a further report in which it stated that it continued to have significant concerns about the operation of the personal current account market in the United Kingdom, in particular in relation to unarranged overdrafts, and that it believed that fundamental changes are required for the market to work in the best interests of bank customers. The OFT stated that it would discuss these issues intensively with banks, consumer groups and other organisations, with the aim of reporting on progress by the end of March 2010. On 16 March 2010, the OFT announced that it had secured agreement from the banks on four industry-wide initiatives, namely minimum standards on the operation of opt-outs from unarranged overdrafts, new working groups on information sharing with customers, best practice for PCA customers in financial difficulties and incurring charges, and PCA providers to publish their policies on dealing with PCA customers in financial difficulties. The OFT also announced its plan to conduct six-monthly ongoing reviews, fully to review the market again in 2012 and to undertake a brief analysis on barriers to entry.

The first six-monthly ongoing review was completed in September 2010. The OFT noted progress in the areas of switching, transparency and unarranged overdrafts for the period March to September 2010, as well as highlighting further changes the OFT expected to see in the market. On 29 March 2011, the OFT published its update report in relation to personal current accounts. This noted further progress in improving consumer control over the use of unarranged overdrafts. In particular, the Lending Standards Board had led on producing standards and guidance to be included in a revised Lending Code. The OFT stated it would continue to monitor the market and would consider the need for, and appropriate timing of, further update reports in light of other developments, in particular the work of the UK Government’s Independent Commission on Banking (ICB). The OFT has indicated its intention to conduct a more comprehensive review of the market in 2012.

On 26 May 2010, the OFT announced its review of barriers to entry. The review concerned retail banking for individuals and small and medium size enterprises (up to £25 million turnover) and looked at products which require a banking licence to sell mortgages, loan products and, where appropriate, other products such as insurance or credit cards where cross-selling may facilitate entry or expansion. The OFT published its report in November 2010. It advised that it expected its review to be relevant to the ICB, the FSA, HM Treasury and the Department for Business, Innovation and Skills and to the devolved governments in the United Kingdom. The OFT did not indicate whether it would undertake any further work. The report maintained that barriers to entry remain, in particular regarding switching, branch networks and brands. At this stage, it is not possible to estimate the effect of the OFT’s report and recommendations regarding barriers to entry upon the Group.

Private motor insurance
On 14 December 2011, the OFT launched a market study into private motor insurance, with a focus on the provision of third party vehicle repairs and credit hire replacement vehicles to claimants. The OFT aims to complete its market study by spring 2012. At this stage, it is not possible to estimate with any certainty the effect the market study and any related developments may have on the Group.

Independent Commission on Banking
Following an interim report published on 11 April 2011, the ICB published its final report to the Cabinet Committee on Banking Reform on 12 September 2011 (the “Final Report”). The Final Report makes a number of recommendations, including in relation to (i) the implementation of a ring-fence of retail banking operations, (ii) loss-absorbency (including bail-in) and (iii) competition.
 
 
125

 

Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)
On 19 December 2011 the UK Government published a response to the Final Report (the “Response”), reaffirming its intention to accept the majority of the ICB’s recommendations. The Government agreed that “vital banking services - in particular the taking of retail deposits - should only be provided by ‘ring-fenced banks’, and that these banks should be prohibited from undertaking certain investment banking activities.” It also broadly accepted the ICB’s recommendations on loss absorbency and on competition.

The UK Government has now embarked on an extensive consultation on how exactly the general principles outlined by the ICB should be implemented, and intends to bring forward a White Paper in the spring of 2012. Its intention is to complete primary and secondary legislation before the end of the current Parliamentary term in May 2015 and to implement the ring-fencing measures as soon as practicable thereafter and the loss absorbency measures by 2019. The Government also stated its determination that changes to the account switching process should be completed by September 2013, as already scheduled.

With regard to the competition aspects, the Government recommended a number of initiatives aimed at improving transparency and switching in the market and ensuring a level playing field for new entrants. In addition, the Government has recommended that HM Treasury should consult on regulating the UK Payments Council and has confirmed that the Financial Conduct Authority's remit will include competition.

Until the UK Government consultation is concluded and significantly more detail is known on how the precise legislative and regulatory framework is to be implemented it is impossible to estimate the potential impact of these measures with any level of precision.

The Group will continue to participate in the debate and to consult with the UK Government on the implementation of the recommendations set out in the Final Report and the Response, the effects of which could have a negative impact on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

US dollar clearing activities
In May 2010, following a criminal investigation by the United States Department of Justice (DoJ) into its dollar clearing activities, Office of Foreign Assets Control compliance procedures and other Bank Secrecy Act compliance matters, RBS N.V. formally entered into a Deferred Prosecution Agreement (DPA) with the DoJ resolving the investigation. Pursuant to the DPA, RBS N.V. paid a penalty of US$500 million in 2010 and agreed to comply with the terms of the DPA and to co-operate fully with any further investigations. Payment of the penalty was made from a provision established in April 2007 when an agreement in principle to settle was first announced. On 20 December 2011, the DoJ filed a motion with the US District Court to dismiss the criminal information underlying the DPA, stating that RBS N.V. had met the terms and obligations of the DPA.  The US District Court granted the DoJ’s motion on the same day, and this matter is now fully resolved.

 
126

 

Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)

Securitisation and collateralised debt obligation business
In the United States, the Group is also involved in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by federal and state governmental law enforcement and other agencies and self-regulatory organisations relating to, among other things, mortgage-backed securities, collateralised debt obligations (CDOs), and synthetic products.  In connection with these inquiries, Group companies have received requests for information and subpoenas seeking information about, among other things, the structuring of CDOs, financing to loan originators, purchase of whole loans, sponsorship and underwriting of securitisations, due diligence, representations and warranties, communications with ratings agencies, disclosure to investors, document deficiencies, and repurchase requests.

By way of example, in September and October 2010, the SEC requested voluntary production of information concerning residential mortgage-backed securities underwritten by subsidiaries of RBS during the period from September 2006 to July 2007 inclusive. In November 2010, the SEC commenced a formal investigation and requested testimony from a former Group employee. The investigation is in its preliminary stages and it is difficult to predict any potential exposure that may result.

Also in October 2010, the SEC commenced an inquiry into document deficiencies and repurchase requests with respect to certain securitisations, and in January 2011, this was converted to a formal investigation. Among other matters, the investigation seeks information related to document deficiencies and remedial measures taken with respect to such deficiencies. The investigation also seeks information related to early payment defaults and loan repurchase requests.

In June 2009, in connection with an investigation into the role of investment banks in the origination and securitisation of sub-prime loans in Massachusetts, the Massachusetts Attorney General issued subpoenas to various banks, including an RBS subsidiary, seeking information related to residential mortgage lending practices and sales and securitisation of residential mortgage loans. On 28 November 2011, an Assurance of Discontinuance between RBS Financial Products Inc. and the Massachusetts Attorney General was filed in Massachusetts State Court which resolves the Massachusetts Attorney General's investigation as to RBS.  The Assurance of Discontinuance required RBS Financial Products Inc. to make payments totalling approximately US$52 million.

In 2007, the New York State Attorney General issued subpoenas to a wide array of participants in the securitisation and securities industry, focusing on the information underwriters obtained from the independent firms hired to perform due diligence on mortgages. The Group completed its production of documents requested by the New York State Attorney General in 2008, principally producing documents related to loans that were pooled into one securitisation transaction. In May 2011, at the New York State Attorney General's request, representatives of the Group attended an informal meeting to provide additional information about the Group's mortgage securitisation business.  The investigation is ongoing and the Group continues to provide requested information. 
 
 
127

 

 
Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)

In September 2010, RBS subsidiaries received a request from the Nevada State Attorney General requesting information related to securitisations of mortgages issued by three specific originators. The investigation by the Nevada State Attorney General is in the early stages and therefore it is difficult to predict the potential exposure from any such investigation.

US mortgages - Loan Repurchase Matters
The Group’s Global Banking & Markets N.A. (GBM N.A.), has been a purchaser of non-agency US residential mortgages in the secondary market, and an issuer and underwriter of non-agency residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS). GBM N.A. did not originate or service any US residential mortgages and it was not a significant seller of mortgage loans to government sponsored enterprises (GSEs) (e.g., the Federal National Mortgage Association and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Association).

In issuing RMBS, GBM N.A. generally assigned certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans made by the originator of the residential mortgages; however, in some circumstances, GBM N.A. made such representations and warranties itself. Where GBM N.A. has given those or other representations and warranties (whether relating to underlying loans or otherwise), GBM N.A. may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of such representations and warranties. In certain instances where it is required to repurchase loans or related securities, GBM N.A. may be able to assert claims against third parties who provided representations or warranties to GBM N.A. when selling loans to it; although the ability to recover against such parties is uncertain. Since January 2009, GBM N.A. has received approximately US$75 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans made primarily from 2005 to 2008 and related securities sold where obligations in respect of contractual representations or warranties were undertaken by GBM N.A.. However, repurchase demands presented to GBM N.A. are subject to challenge and, to date, GBM N.A. has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

Citizens has not been an issuer or underwriter of non-agency RMBS. However, Citizens is an originator and servicer of residential mortgages, and it routinely sells such mortgage loans in the secondary market and to GSEs. In the context of such sales, Citizens makes certain representations and warranties regarding the characteristics of the underlying loans and, as a result, may be contractually required to repurchase such loans or indemnify certain parties against losses for certain breaches of the representations and warranties concerning the underlying loans. Since January 2009, Citizens has received approximately US$41.2 million in repurchase demands in respect of loans originated primarily since 2003. However, repurchase demands presented to Citizens are subject to challenge and, to date, Citizens has rebutted a significant percentage of these claims.

Although there has been disruption in the ability of certain financial institutions operating in the United States to complete foreclosure proceedings in respect of US mortgage loans in a timely manner (or at all) over the last year (including as a result of interventions by certain states and local governments), to date, Citizens has not been materially impacted by such disruptions and the Group has not ceased making foreclosures.

 
128

 


Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)
The Group cannot estimate what the future level of repurchase demands or ultimate exposure of GBM N.A. or Citizens may be, and cannot give any assurance that the historical experience will continue in the future. It is possible that the volume of repurchase demands will increase in the future.  Furthermore, the Group is unable to estimate the extent to which the matters described above will impact it and future developments may have an adverse impact on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

LIBOR
The Group continues to receive requests from various regulators investigating the setting of LIBOR and other interest rates, including the US Commodity Futures Trading Commission, the US Department of Justice, the European Commission, the FSA and the Japanese Financial Services Agency. The authorities are seeking documents and communications related to the process and procedures for setting LIBOR and other interest rates, together with related trading information. In addition to co-operating with the investigations as described above, the Group is also keeping relevant regulators informed. It is not possible to estimate with any certainty what effect these investigations and any related developments may have on the Group.

Other investigations
The Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors have been reviewing the Group's US operations and RBS and its subsidiaries have been required to make improvements with respect to various matters, including enterprise-wide governance, US Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering compliance, risk management and asset quality. The Group is in the process of implementing measures for matters identified to date.

On 27 July 2011, the Group consented to the issuance of a Cease and Desist Order (“the Order”) setting forth measures required to address deficiencies related to governance, risk management and compliance systems and controls identified by the Federal Reserve and state banking supervisors during examinations of the RBS plc and RBS N.V. branches in 2010. The Order requires the Group to strengthen its US corporate governance structure, to develop an enterprise-wide risk management programme, and to develop and enhance its programmes to ensure compliance with US law, particularly the US Bank Secrecy Act and anti-money laundering laws, rules and regulations. The Group has established a strategic and remedial programme of change to address the identified concerns and is committed to working closely with the US bank regulators to implement the remedial measures required by the Order.

The Group’s operations include businesses outside the United States that are responsible for processing US dollar payments. The Group is conducting a review of its policies, procedures and practices in respect of such payments and has initiated discussions with UK and US authorities to discuss its historical compliance with applicable laws and regulations, including US economic sanctions regulations. Although the Group cannot currently determine when the review of its operations will be completed or what the outcome of its discussions with UK and US authorities will be, the investigation costs, remediation required or liability incurred could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.
 
 
129

 

Notes (continued)


16. Investigations, reviews and proceedings (continued)
The Group may become subject to formal and informal supervisory actions and may be required by its US banking supervisors to take further actions and implement additional remedial measures with respect to these and additional matters. Any limitations or conditions placed on the Group's activities in the United States, as well as the terms of any supervisory action applicable to RBS and its subsidiaries, could have a material adverse effect on the Group's consolidated net assets, operating results or cash flows in any particular period.

In April 2009, the FSA notified the Group that it was commencing a supervisory review of the acquisition of ABN AMRO Holding N.V. in 2007 and the 2008 capital raisings and an investigation into conduct, systems and controls within the Global Banking & Markets division of the Group. RBS and its subsidiaries co-operated fully with this review and investigation. On 2 December 2010, the FSA confirmed that it had completed its investigation and had concluded that no enforcement action, either against the Group or against individuals, was warranted. On 12 December 2011, the FSA published its report ‘The Failure of the Royal Bank of Scotland’, on which the Group engaged constructively with the FSA.

In July 2010, the FSA notified the Group that it was commencing an investigation into the sale by Coutts & Co of the ALICO (American Life Insurance Company) Premier Access Bond Enhanced Variable Rate Fund (“EVRF”) to customers between 2001 and 2008 as well as its subsequent review of those sales. Subsequently, on 11 January 2011 the FSA revised the investigation start date to December 2003.

On 8 November 2011, the FSA published its Final Notice having reached a settlement with Coutts & Co, under which Coutts & Co agreed to pay a fine of £6.3 million.  The FSA did not make any findings on the suitability of advice given in individual cases. Nonetheless, Coutts & Co has agreed to undertake a past business review of its sales of the product.  This review will be overseen by an independent third party and will consider the advice given to customers invested in the EVRF as at the date of its suspension, 15 September 2008.  For any sales which are found to be unsuitable, redress will be paid to the customers to ensure that they have not suffered financially.

On 18 January 2012, the FSA published its Final Notice having reached a settlement with UK Insurance Limited for breaches of Principle 2 by Direct Line and Churchill (the "Firms"), under which UK Insurance Limited agreed to pay a fine of £2.17 million.  The Firms were found to have acted without due skill, care and diligence in the way that they responded to the FSA's request to provide it with a sample of their closed complaint files.  The Firms' breaches of Principle 2 did not result in any customer detriment.

During March 2008, the Group was advised by the SEC that it had commenced a non-public, formal investigation relating to the Group’s United States sub-prime securities exposures and United States residential mortgage exposures. In December 2010, the SEC contacted the Group and indicated that it would also examine valuations of various RBS N.V. structured products, including CDOs.

 
130

 

Notes (continued)


17. Other developments

Proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to The Royal Bank of Scotland plc (RBS plc) 
On 19 April 2011, the Group announced its intention to transfer a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to RBS plc (the "Proposed Transfers"), subject, amongst other matters, to regulatory and other approvals, further tax and other analysis in respect of the assets and liabilities to be transferred and employee consultation procedures.

The Proposed Transfers will streamline the manner in which the GBM and GTS businesses of the Group interact with clients with simplified access to the GBM and GTS product suites. 

It is expected that the Proposed Transfers will be implemented on a phased basis over a period ending 31 December 2013. The transfer of eligible business carried out in the UK, including certain securities issued by RBS N.V. was completed on 17 October 2011. A large part of the remainder of Proposed Transfers (including the transfers of certain securities issued by RBS N.V.) is expected to have taken place by the end of 2012.

Rating agencies
RBS and RBS plc's long-term and short-term ratings remained unchanged in the quarter, however in several of the Group’s credit ratings have been updated during the quarter. During October 2011, both Moody’s and Fitch have taken rating action on RBS and certain subsidiaries. On 7 October 2011, Moody’s Investor Services downgraded the long term ratings of RBS, RBS plc and National Westminster Bank Plc (NatWest), following the conclusion of its review into the systemic support assumptions from the UK government for 14 UK financial institutions. As a result of this review, 12 UK entities, including RBS, were downgraded. RBS was downgraded to A3 from A1 (long-term) and to P-2 from P-1 (short term), RBS plc and NatWest were downgraded to A2 from Aa3 (long-term); their P-1 short-term ratings were affirmed. These ratings will all have a negative outlook assigned due to Moody’s opinion that the likelihood of government support will likely weaken further in the future, however, Moody’s affirmed RBS’s underlying Baa2 rating, noting that these downgrades did not reflect a worsening in the credit quality of UK financial institutions.

On 11 October 2011, following the reduction of support factored into the ratings of RBS, Moody’s downgraded the ratings of Ulster Bank Ltd and Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd to Baa1 from A2 (long term) and to P-2 from P-1 (short term); Moody’s also placed these ratings on negative outlook to be in line with the outlook of RBS plc. In addition, Moody’s has placed the ratings of RBS N.V. on negative outlook, to match those of RBS plc.

On 13 October 2011, Fitch Ratings downgraded RBS and certain subsidiaries, having lowered its ‘Support Rating Floors’ for large UK banks. The ratings of RBS, RBS plc, NatWest, RBS International and RBS N.V. were reduced to A from AA- (long-term) and to F1 from F1+ (short term). The ratings of Citizens Financial Group, Ulster Bank Ltd and Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd were downgraded to A- from A+ (long term). The short term rating of Citizens Financial Group was affirmed at F1 following the downgrade of RBS plc, while the rating of Ulster Bank Ltd and Ulster Bank Ireland Limited was downgraded to F1 from F1+. Fitch assigned all of these ratings a stable outlook. The standalone ratings of RBS Group and RBS plc were unchanged by this action and were upgraded from C/D to C on 29 June 2011, corresponding to a bbb viability rating.

 
131

 

Notes (continued)


17. Other developments (continued)
On 29 November 2011, S&P announced the results of the reviews into a group of 37 of the largest global financial institutions, including all major UK banks. This review has resulted in a one notch downgrade of the long-term ratings of RBS plc and NatWest plc to A from A+, the short term rating of A-1 was affirmed.  RBS was also downgraded one notch bringing the long-term rating to A- from A and the short term to A-2 from A-1.  Standard & Poor's assigned all these ratings a stable outlook.

As a result of the 29 November rating action, S&P also lowered the ratings of RBS Securities Inc and RBS N.V. to A from A+ (long-term) and affirmed the A-1 short-term rating.  Finally, S&P upgraded the long and short term ratings of RBS Citizens NA and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania to A from A- (long-term) and to A-1 from A-2 (short-term). Standard & Poor's assign all these ratings a stable outlook.

Further to its announcements on 11 and 7 of October 2011, on 15 February 2012 Moody’s placed the ratings of RBS and certain subsidiaries on review for possible downgrade, along with 114 other European banks and 17 firms with capital markets activities.  Moody’s have placed Bank Standalone Financial Strength Rating (BFSR) of RBS plc on review for possible downgrade and this has driven a review for downgrade of the long-term ratings of RBS, RBS plc, NatWest plc, RBS N.V., Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd and Ulster Bank Ltd; along with the short-term ratings of RBS plc, NatWest plc and RBS N.V.  The short-term ratings of RBS, Ulster Bank Ireland Ltd and Ulster Bank Ltd were affirmed.  Moody’s cite three reasons for this review across all of the affected firms; the adverse and prolonged impact of the euro area crisis; the deteriorating creditworthiness of euro-area sovereigns; and the substantial challenges faced by banks and securities firms with significant capital market activities.

18. Post balance sheet events
There have been no significant events between 31 December 2011 and the date of approval of this announcement which would require a change to or additional disclosure in the announcement.

 
132

 
 

Risk and balance sheet management


General overview
The following table defines the main types of risk managed by the Group and presents the key areas of focus for each risk in 2011.

Risk type
Definition
2011 key areas of focus
Capital, liquidity and funding risk
The risk that the Group has insufficient capital or is unable to meet its financial liabilities as they fall due.
Active run-down of capital intensive assets in Non-Core and other risk mitigation left the Core Tier 1 ratio strong at 10.6%, despite a £21 billion uplift in RWAs from the implementation of CRD III in December 2011. Refer to pages 135 to 140.
 
Maintaining the structural integrity of the Group’s balance sheet requires active management of both asset and liability portfolios as necessary. Strong term debt issuance and planned reductions in the funded balance sheet enabled the Group to strengthen its liquidity and funding position as market conditions worsened. Refer to pages 141 to 150.
Credit risk (including counterparty risk)
The risk that the Group will incur losses owing to the failure of a customer to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts.
During 2011, asset quality continued to improve, resulting in loan impairment charges 21% lower than in 2010 despite continuing challenges in Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) and corporate real estate portfolios. The Group continued to make progress in reducing key credit concentration risks, with credit exposures in excess of single name concentration limits declining 15% during the year and exposure to commercial real estate declining 14%. Refer to pages 153 to 185.
Country risk
The risk of material losses arising from significant country-specific events.
Sovereign risk increased in 2011, resulting in rating downgrades for a number of countries, including several eurozone members. This resulted in an impairment charge recognised by the Group in 2011 in respect of available-for-sale Greek government bonds. In response the Group further strengthened its country risk appetite setting and risk management systems during the year and brought a number of advanced countries under limit control. This contributed to a reduction in exposure to a range of countries. Refer to pages 186 to 209.

 
133

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


General overview (continued)

Risk type
Definition
2011 key areas of focus
Market risk
The risk arising from changes in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices and risk related factors such as market volatilities.
During 2011, the Group continued to manage down its market risk exposure in Non-Core and reduce the ABS trading inventory such that the trading portfolio became less exposed to credit risk. Refer to pages 210 to 214.
Insurance risk
The risk of financial loss through fluctuations in the timing, frequency and/or severity of insured events, relative to the expectations at the time of underwriting.
During 2011, focus on insurance risk appetite resulted in the de-risking and significant re-pricing of certain classes of business and exiting some altogether.
Operational risk
The risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes, people, systems or from external events.
During 2011, the Group took steps to enhance its management of operational risks. This was particularly evident in respect of risk appetite, the Group Policy Framework, risk assessment, scenario analysis and statistical modelling for capital requirements.
 
The level of operational risk remains high due to the scale of structural change occurring across the Group, the pace of regulatory change, the economic downturn and other external threats, such as e-crime.
Compliance
risk
The risk arising from non-compliance with national and international laws, rules and regulations.
During 2011, the Group managed the increased levels of scrutiny and legislation by enlarging the capacity of its compliance, anti-money laundering and regulatory affairs teams and taking steps to improve its operating model, tools, systems and processes.
Reputational risk
The risk of brand damage arising from financial and non-financial events arising from the failure to meet stakeholders’ expectations of the Group’s performance and behaviour.
In 2011, an Environmental, Social and Ethical (ESE) Risk Policy was developed with sector ESE risk appetite positions drawn up to assess the Group’s appetite to support customers in sensitive sectors including defence, oil and gas. This also included the establishment of divisional reputational risk committees.
 
Stakeholder engagement was broadened with the implementation of formal sessions between the Group Sustainability Commitee and relevant advocacy groups and non-governmental organisations.

 
134

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


General overview (continued)

Risk type
Definition
2011 key areas of focus
Business risk
The risk of lower-than-expected revenues and/or higher-than-expected operating costs.
Business risk is incorporated within the Group’s risk appetite target for earnings volatility that was set in 2011.
Pension risk
The risk that the Group will have to make additional contributions to its defined benefit pension schemes.
In 2011, the Group focused on improved stress testing and risk governance mechanisms. This included the establishment of the Pension Risk Committee and the articulation of its view of risk appetite for the various Group pension schemes.

Balance sheet management

Capital
The Group aims to maintain an appropriate level of capital to meet its business needs and regulatory requirements as capital adequacy and risk management are closely aligned. The Group’s risk asset ratios calculated in accordance with Financial Services Authority (FSA) definitions are set out below.

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Risk-weighted assets (RWAs) by risk
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Credit risk
344.3 
346.8 
385.9 
Counterparty risk
61.9 
72.2 
68.1 
Market risk
64.0 
55.0 
80.0 
Operational risk
37.9 
37.9 
37.1 
       
 
508.1 
511.9 
571.1 
Asset Protection Scheme relief
(69.1)
(88.6)
(105.6)
       
 
439.0 
423.3 
465.5 

Risk asset ratios
       
Core Tier 1
10.6
11.3 
10.7 
Tier 1
13.0
13.8 
12.9 
Total
13.8
14.7 
14.0 

Key points
·
The increase in market risk RWAs of £9 billion in Q4 2011 reflects the impact of the new CRD III rules.
   
·
APS relief decreased by £19.5 billion in Q4 2011, reflecting pool movements, assets moving into default and changes in risk parameters.

 
135

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

The Group’s capital resources in accordance with FSA definitions were as follows:

 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
30 September 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m 
       
Shareholders’ equity (excluding non-controlling interests)
     
Shareholders’ equity per balance sheet
74,819 
77,443 
75,132 
Preference shares - equity
(4,313)
(4,313)
(4,313)
Other equity instruments
(431)
(431)
(431)
 
70,075 
72,699 
70,388 
       
Non-controlling interests
     
Non-controlling interests per balance sheet
1,234 
1,433 
1,719 
Non-controlling preference shares
(548)
(548)
(548)
Other adjustments to non-controlling interests for regulatory purposes
(259)
(259)
(259)
 
427 
626 
912 
       
Regulatory adjustments and deductions
     
Own credit
(2,634)
(2,931)
(1,182)
Unrealised losses on AFS debt securities
1,065 
379 
2,061 
Unrealised gains on AFS equity shares
(108)
(88)
(25)
Cash flow hedging reserve
(879)
(798)
140 
Other adjustments for regulatory purposes
571 
523 
204 
Goodwill and other intangible assets
(14,858)
(14,744)
(14,448)
50% excess of expected losses over impairment provisions (net of tax)
(2,536)
(2,127)
(1,900)
50% of securitisation positions
(2,019)
(2,164)
(2,321)
50% of APS first loss
(2,763)
(3,545)
(4,225)
 
(24,161)
(25,495)
(21,696)
       
Core Tier 1 capital
46,341 
 47,830 
49,604 
       
Other Tier 1 capital
     
Preference shares - equity
4,313 
4,313 
4,313 
Preference shares - debt
1,094 
1,085 
1,097 
Innovative/hybrid Tier 1 securities
4,667 
4,644 
4,662 
 
10,074 
10,042 
10,072 
       
Deductions
     
50% of material holdings
(340)
(303)
(310)
Tax on excess of expected losses over impairment provisions
915 
767 
758 
 
575 
464 
448 
       
Total Tier 1 capital
56,990 
58,336 
60,124 

 
136

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital (continued)

 
31 December 
2011 
£m 
30 September 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m 
       
Qualifying Tier 2 capital
     
Undated subordinated debt
1,838 
1,837 
1,852 
Dated subordinated debt - net of amortisation
14,527 
14,999 
16,745 
Unrealised gains on AFS equity shares
108 
88 
25 
Collectively assessed impairment provisions
635 
728 
778 
Non-controlling Tier 2 capital
11 
11 
11 
 
17,119 
17,663 
19,411 
       
Tier 2 deductions
     
50% of securitisation positions
(2,019)
(2,164)
(2,321)
50% excess of expected losses over impairment provisions
(3,451)
(2,894)
(2,658)
50% of material holdings
(340)
(303)
(310)
50% of APS first loss
(2,763)
(3,545)
(4,225)
 
(8,573)
(8,906)
(9,514)
       
Total Tier 2 capital
8,546 
8,757 
9,897 
       
Supervisory deductions
     
Unconsolidated Investments
     
  - RBS Insurance
(4,354)
(4,292)
(3,962)
  - Other investments
(239)
(262)
(318)
Other deductions
(235)
(311)
(452)
 
(4,828)
(4,865)
(4,732)
       
Total regulatory capital (1)
60,708 
62,228 
65,289 

Movement in Core Tier 1 capital
2011 
£m 
   
At beginning of the year
49,604 
Attributable loss net of movements in fair value of own debt
(3,449)
Foreign currency reserves
(363)
Decrease in non-controlling interests
(485)
Decrease in capital deductions including APS first loss
1,128 
Other movements
(94)
   
At end of the year
46,341 

Note:
(1)
Total capital includes certain instruments issued by RBS N.V. Group that are treated consistent with the local implementation of the Capital Requirements Directive (including the transitional provisions of that Directive). The FSA formally confirmed this treatment in 2012.

 
137

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Capital: Risk-weighted assets by division
Risk-weighted assets by risk category and division are set out below.

 
Credit 
risk 
Counterparty 
risk 
Market 
risk 
Operational 
risk 
Gross 
RWAs 
APS 
relief 
Net 
RWAs 
31 December 2011
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
               
UK Retail
41.1 
7.3 
48.4 
(9.4)
39.0 
UK Corporate
69.4 
6.7 
76.1 
(15.5)
60.6 
Wealth
10.9 
0.1 
1.9 
12.9 
12.9 
Global Transaction Services
12.4 
4.9 
17.3 
17.3 
Ulster Bank
33.6 
0.6 
0.3 
1.8 
36.3 
(6.8)
29.5 
US Retail & Commercial
53.4 
1.0 
4.4 
58.8 
58.8 
               
Retail & Commercial
220.8 
1.6 
0.4 
27.0 
249.8 
(31.7)
218.1 
Global Banking & Markets
45.1 
39.9 
50.6 
15.5 
151.1 
(8.5)
142.6 
Other
9.9 
0.2 
0.7 
10.8 
10.8 
               
Core
275.8 
41.7 
51.0 
43.2 
411.7 
(40.2)
371.5 
Non-Core
65.6 
20.2 
13.0 
(5.5)
93.3 
(28.9)
64.4 
               
Group before RFS MI
341.4 
61.9 
64.0 
37.7 
505.0 
(69.1)
435.9 
RFS MI
2.9 
0.2 
3.1 
3.1 
               
Group
344.3 
61.9 
64.0 
37.9 
508.1 
(69.1)
439.0 
               
30 September 2011
             
UK Retail
41.4 
7.3 
48.7 
(9.9)
38.8 
UK Corporate
69.0 
6.7 
75.7 
(16.9)
58.8 
Wealth
11.0 
0.1 
1.9 
13.0 
13.0 
Global Transaction Services
13.7 
4.9 
18.6 
18.6 
Ulster Bank
32.0 
0.5 
0.1 
1.8 
34.4 
(6.7)
27.7 
US Retail & Commercial
51.0 
1.1 
4.4 
56.5 
56.5 
Retail & Commercial
218.1 
1.6 
0.2 
27.0 
246.9 
(33.5)
213.4 
Global Banking & Markets
46.1 
35.1 
37.6 
15.5 
134.3 
(10.4)
123.9 
Other
8.8 
0.3 
0.7 
9.8 
9.8 
Core
273.0 
37.0 
37.8 
43.2 
391.0 
(43.9)
347.1 
Non-Core
71.0 
35.2 
17.2 
(5.5)
117.9 
(44.7)
73.2 
Group before RFS MI
344.0 
72.2 
55.0 
37.7 
508.9 
(88.6)
420.3 
RFS MI
2.8 
0.2 
3.0 
3.0 
Group
346.8 
72.2 
55.0 
37.9 
511.9 
(88.6)
423.3 

31 December 2010
             
               
UK Retail
41.7 
7.1 
48.8 
(12.4)
36.4 
UK Corporate
74.8 
6.6 
81.4 
(22.9)
58.5 
Wealth
10.4 
0.1 
2.0 
12.5 
12.5 
Global Transaction Services
13.7 
4.6 
18.3 
18.3 
Ulster Bank
29.2 
0.5 
0.1 
1.8 
31.6 
(7.9)
23.7 
US Retail & Commercial
52.0 
0.9 
4.1 
57.0 
57.0 
Retail & Commercial
221.8 
1.4 
0.2 
26.2 
249.6 
(43.2)
206.4 
Global Banking & Markets
53.5 
34.5 
44.7 
14.2 
146.9 
(11.5)
135.4 
Other
16.4 
0.4 
0.2 
1.0 
18.0 
18.0 
Core
291.7 
36.3 
45.1 
41.4 
414.5 
(54.7)
359.8 
Non-Core
91.3 
31.8 
34.9 
(4.3)
153.7 
(50.9)
102.8 
Group before RFS MI
383.0 
68.1 
80.0 
37.1 
568.2 
(105.6)
462.6 
RFS MI
2.9 
2.9 
2.9 
Group
385.9 
68.1 
80.0 
37.1 
571.1 
 (105.6)
465.5 

 
138

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Regulatory capital developments

Basel III and other regulatory impacts

Basel III
The rules issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS), commonly referred to as Basel III, are a comprehensive set of reforms designed to strengthen the regulation, supervision, risk and liquidity management of the banking sector. In the EU they will be enacted through a revised Capital Requirements Directive referred to as CRD IV.

In December 2010, the BCBS issued the final text of the Basel III rules, providing details of the global standards agreed by the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the BCBS and endorsed by the G20 leaders at their November 2010 Seoul summit. There are transition arrangements proposed for implementing these new standards as follows:

·
National implementation of increased capital requirements will begin on 1 January 2013;
   
·
There will be a phased five year implementation of new deductions and regulatory adjustments to Core Tier 1 capital commencing on 1 January 2014;
   
·
The de-recognition of non-qualifying non-common Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital instruments will be phased in over 10 years from 1 January 2013; and
   
·
Requirements for changes to minimum capital ratios, including conservation and countercyclical buffers, as well as additional requirements for Global Systemically Important Banks, will be phased in from 2013 to 2019.

The Group, in conjunction with the FSA, regularly evaluates its models for the assessment of RWAs ascribed to credit risk across various classes. This together with the changes introduced by CRD IV relating primarily to counterparty risk, is expected to increase RWA requirements by the end of 2013 by £50 billion to £65 billion.  These estimates are still subject to change; a degree of uncertainty remains around implementation details as the guidelines are not finalised and must still be enacted into EU law. There could be other future changes and associated impacts from these model reviews.

Other regulatory capital changes
The Group is in the process of implementing changes to the RWA requirements for commercial real estate portfolios consistent with revised industry guidance from the FSA. This is projected to increase RWA requirements by circa £20 billion by the end of 2013, of which circa £10 billion will apply in 2012.

The Group is managing the changes to capital requirements from new regulation and model changes and the resulting impact on the common equity Tier 1 ratio, focusing on risk reduction and deleveraging. This is principally being achieved through the continued run-down and disposal of Non-Core assets and deleveraging in GBM as the business focuses on the most productive returns on capital.

 
139

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Regulatory capital developments (continued)

Basel III and other regulatory impacts (continued)
The major categories of new deductions and regulatory adjustments which are being phased in over a 5 year period from 1 January 2014 include:

·
Expected loss net of provisions;
   
·
Deferred tax assets not relating to timing differences;
   
·
Unrealised losses on available-for-sale securities; and
   
·
Significant investments in non-consolidated financial institutions.

The net impact of these changes is expected to be manageable as the aggregation of these drivers is projected to be lower by 2014 and declining during the phase-in period.

 
140

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk

Liquidity risk

Introduction
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group is unable to meet its obligations, including financing maturities as they fall due. Liquidity risk is heavily influenced by the maturity profile and mix of the Group’s funding base, as well as the quality and liquidity value of its liquidity portfolio. 

Liquidity risk is dynamic, being influenced by movements in markets and perceptions that are driven by firm specific or external factors. Managing liquidity risk effectively is a key component of the Group’s risk reduction strategy. The Group's 2011 performance demonstrates continued improvements in managing liquidity risk and reflects actions taken in light of an uncertain economic outlook, which resulted in improvements in key measures.

·
Deposit growth: Core Retail & Commercial deposits rose by 9%, and together with Non-Core deleveraging, took the Group loan to deposit ratio to 108%, compared with 118% at the end of 2010.
   
·
Wholesale funding: £21 billion of net term wholesale debt was issued in 2011 from secured and unsecured funding programmes, across a variety of maturities and currencies.
   
·
Short-term wholesale funding (STWF): The overall level of STWF fell by £27 billion to £102 billion, below the 2013 target of circa £125 billion.
   
·
Liquidity portfolio: The liquidity portfolio of £155 billion was maintained above the 2013 target level of £150 billion against a backdrop of heightened market uncertainty in the second half of the year and was higher than STWF. This represents a £53 billion cushion over STWF.

Funding issuance
The Group has access to a variety of funding sources across the globe, including short-term money markets, repurchase agreement markets and term debt investors through its secured and unsecured funding programmes. Diversity in funding is provided by its active role in the money markets, along with access to global capital flows through GBM’s international client base. The Group’s wholesale funding franchise is well diversified by currency, geography, maturity and type.

The Group has been a regular issuer in the debt capital markets in both secured and unsecured arrangements. 2011 net new term debt issuance was £21 billion, with 49% secured and 51% unsecured, of which 71% were public transactions and 29% were private.

 
141

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources
The table below shows the Group’s primary funding sources including deposits in disposal groups and excluding repurchase agreements.

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
Deposits by banks
               
  - central banks
3,680 
0.5 
 
3,568 
0.5 
 
6,655 
0.9 
  - derivative cash collateral
31,807 
4.6 
 
32,466 
4.4 
 
28,074 
3.8 
  - other
33,627 
4.8 
 
42,624 
5.8 
 
31,588 
4.3 
 
69,114 
9.9 
 
78,658 
10.7 
 
66,317 
9.0 
Debt securities in issue
               
  - conduit asset backed commercial
    paper (ABCP)
11,164 
1.6 
 
11,783 
1.6 
 
17,320 
2.3 
  - other commercial paper (CP)
5,310 
0.8 
 
8,680 
1.2 
 
8,915 
1.2 
  - certificates of deposits (CDs)
16,367 
2.4 
 
25,036 
3.4 
 
37,855 
5.1 
  - medium-term notes (MTNs)
105,709 
15.2 
 
127,719 
17.4 
 
131,026 
17.6 
  - covered bonds
9,107 
1.3 
 
8,541 
1.1 
 
4,100 
0.6 
  - securitisations
14,964 
2.1 
 
12,752 
1.7 
 
19,156 
2.6 
 
162,621 
23.4 
 
194,511 
26.4 
 
218,372 
29.4 
Subordinated liabilities
26,319 
3.8 
 
26,275 
3.6 
 
27,053 
3.6 
Notes issued
188,940 
27.2 
 
220,786 
30.0 
 
245,425 
33.0 
Wholesale funding
258,054 
37.1 
 
299,444 
40.7 
 
311,742 
42.0 
Customer deposits
               
  - cash collateral
9,242 
1.4 
 
10,278 
1.4 
 
10,433 
1.4 
  - other
427,511 
61.5 
 
425,125 
57.9 
 
420,433 
56.6 
Total customer deposits
436,753 
62.9 
 
435,403 
59.3 
 
430,866 
58.0 
Total funding
694,807 
100.0 
 
734,847 
100.0 
 
742,608 
100.0 
Disposal group deposits included above
               
  - banks
   
288 
   
266 
 
  - customers
22,610 
   
1,743 
   
2,267 
 
 
22,611 
   
2,031 
   
2,533 
 


 
31 December 
2011 
31 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
Short-term wholesale funding
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Deposits
32.9 
41.8 
34.7 
Notes issued
69.5 
99.8 
95.0 
STWF excluding derivative collateral
102.4 
141.6 
129.7 
Derivative collateral
31.8 
32.5 
28.1 
STWF including derivative collateral
134.2 
174.1 
157.8 
       
Interbank funding excluding derivative collateral
     
  - bank deposits
37.3 
46.2 
38.2 
  - bank loans
(24.3)
(33.0)
(31.3)
Net interbank funding
13.0 
13.2 
6.9 

 
142

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Key points
·
Short-term wholesale funding excluding derivative collateral declined £27.3 billion in 2011, from £129.7 billion to £102.4 billion. This is £52.9 billion lower than the Group’s liquidity portfolio. Deleveraging in Non-Core and GBM has led to the reduced need for funding.
   
·
The Group’s customer deposits grew by approximately £7.1 billion in 2011.

The table below shows the Group’s debt securities in issue and subordinated liabilities by remaining maturity.
 
 
Debt securities in issue
     
 
Conduit 
ABCP 
Other 
CP and 
CDs 
MTNs 
Covered 
bonds 
Securitisations 
Total 
Subordinated 
liabilities 
Total 
notes 
issued 
 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
31 December 2011
                 
Less than 1 year
11,164 
21,396 
36,302 
27 
68,889 
624 
69,513 
36.8 
1-3 years
278 
26,595 
2,760 
479 
30,112 
3,338 
33,450 
17.7 
3-5 years
16,627 
3,673 
20,302 
7,232 
27,534 
14.6 
More than 5 years
26,185 
2,674 
14,458 
43,318 
15,125 
58,443 
30.9 
 
11,164 
21,677 
105,709 
9,107 
14,964 
162,621 
26,319 
188,940 
100.0 
30 September 2011
                 
Less than 1 year
11,783 
32,914 
54,622 
43 
99,362 
400 
99,762 
45.2 
1-3 years
795 
28,456 
2,800 
26 
32,077 
2,045 
34,122 
15.5 
3-5 years
18,049 
3,037 
33 
21,121 
8,265 
29,386 
13.3 
More than 5 years
26,592 
2,704 
12,650 
41,951 
15,565 
57,516 
26.0 
 
11,783 
33,716 
127,719 
8,541 
12,752 
194,511 
26,275 
220,786 
100.0 
31 December 2010
                 
Less than 1 year
17,320 
46,051 
30,589 
88 
94,048 
964 
95,012 
38.7 
1-3 years
702 
47,357 
1,078 
12 
49,149 
754 
49,903 
20.3 
3-5 years
12 
21,466 
1,294 
34 
22,806 
8,476 
31,282 
12.8 
More than 5 years
31,614 
1,728 
19,022 
52,369 
16,859 
69,228 
28.2 
 
17,320 
46,770 
131,026 
4,100 
19,156 
218,372 
27,053 
245,425 
100.0 

Key point
·
Debt securities in issue with a maturity of less than one year declined £25.1 billion from £94.0 billion at 31 December 2010 to £68.9 billion at 31 December 2011, largely due to the maturity of £20.1 billion of notes issued under the UK Government’s Credit Guarantee Scheme (CGS). The remaining notes issued under the CGS are due to mature in 2012, £15.6 billion in the first quarter of the year and £5.7 billion in the second quarter.

 
143

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Long-term debt issuances
The table below shows debt securities issued by the Group with an original maturity of one year or more. The Group also executes other long-term funding arrangements (predominantly term repurchase agreements) which are not reflected in the following tables.

 
Year ended
 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Public
           
  - unsecured
5,085 
12,887 
 
- 
775 
  - secured
9,807 
8,041 
 
3,223 
1,721 
1,725 
Private
           
  - unsecured
12,414 
17,450 
 
911 
3,255 
4,623 
  - secured
500 
 
500 
             
Gross issuance
27,806 
38,378 
 
4,634 
4,976 
7,123 
Buy backs
(6,892)
(6,298)
 
(1,270)
(2,386)
(1,702)
             
Net issuance
20,914 
32,080 
 
3,364 
2,590 
5,421 

Key points
·
In line with the Group’s strategic plan, it has been an active issuer in recent years as it improved its liquidity and funding profile. Secured funding has increased as a proportion of total wholesale funding more recently as market dislocation and uncertainty over future regulatory developments have made unsecured markets less liquid.
   
·
As the Group delevers, with Non-Core and GBM third party assets decreasing and Retail & Commercial deposits increasing, net term debt issuance decreased from £32 billion in 2010 to £21 billion in 2011. The net requirement in 2012 is expected not to exceed £10 billion as further deleveraging should cover the differences.
   
·
The Group undertakes voluntary buy-backs of its privately issued debt in order to maintain client relationships and as part of its normal market making activities. These transactions are conducted at prevailing market rates.

The table below shows the original maturity of public long-term debt securities issued in the years ended 31 December 2011 and 2010.

 
1-3 years 
3-5 years 
5-10 years 
>10 years 
Total 
Year ended 31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
MTNs
904 
1,407 
1,839 
935 
5,085 
Covered bonds
1,721 
3,280 
5,001 
Securitisations
4,806 
4,806 
 
904 
3,128 
5,119 
5,741 
14,892 
% of total
21 
34 
39 
100 
           
Year ended 31 December 2010
         
MTNs
1,445 
2,150 
6,559 
2,733 
12,887 
Covered bonds
1,030 
1,244 
1,725 
3,999 
Securitisations
4,042 
4,042 
 
1,445 
3,180 
7,803 
8,500 
20,928 
% of total
15 
37 
41 
100 

 
144

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Funding sources (continued)

Long-term debt issuance (continued)
The table below shows the currency breakdown of public and private long-term debt securities issued in the years ended 31 December 2011 and 2010.

 
GBP 
EUR 
USD 
AUD 
Other 
Total 
Year ended 31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
Public
           
  - MTNs
1,808 
2,181 
1,096 
 - 
5,085 
  - covered bonds
5,001 
5,001 
  - securitisations
478 
1,478 
2,850 
4,806 
Private
2,872 
3,856 
3,183 
302 
2,701 
12,914 
 
3,350 
12,143 
8,214 
1,398 
2,701 
27,806 
             
% of total
12 
44 
29 
10 
100 
             
Year ended 31 December 2010
           
Public
           
  - MTNs
1,260 
3,969 
5,131 
1,236 
1,291 
12,887 
  - covered bonds
3,999 
3,999 
  - securitisations
663 
1,629 
1,750 
4,042 
Private
2,184 
10,041 
2,879 
174 
2,172 
17,450 
 
4,107 
19,638 
9,760 
1,410 
3,463 
38,378 
             
% of total
11 
51 
25 
100 

Key points
·
In line with the Group’s plan to diversify its funding mix, issuances were spread across G10 currencies and maturity bands, including £5.7 billion of public issuance with an original maturity of greater than 10 years.
   
·
The Group has issued approximately £2.8 billion since the year end, including a £1 billion public covered bond issuance and a US$1.2 billion securitisation.

 
145

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Secured funding
The Group has access to secured funding markets through own-asset securitisation and covered bond funding programmes to complement existing wholesale funding programmes and access to the repo markets. The Group monitors and manages encumbrance levels related to these secured funding programmes. This includes the potential encumbrance of Group assets that could be used in own asset securitisations and/or covered bonds that could be used as contingent liquidity.

Own-asset securitisations
The Group has a programme of own-asset securitisations where assets are transferred to bankruptcy remote SPEs funded by the issue of debt securities. The majority of the risks and rewards of the portfolio are retained by the Group and these SPEs are consolidated and all of the transferred assets retained on the Group’s balance sheet. In some own-asset securitisations, the Group may purchase all the issued securities which are available to be pledged as collateral for repurchase agreements with major central banks.

Covered bond programme
Certain loans and advances to customers have been assigned to bankruptcy remote limited liability partnerships to provide security for issues of covered bonds by the Group. The Group retains all of the risks and rewards of these loans, the partnerships are consolidated, the loans retained on the Group’s balance sheet and the related covered bonds included within debt securities in issue.

The following table shows:
(i)
the asset categories that have been pledged to secured funding structures, including assets backing publicly issued own-asset securitisations and covered bonds; and
(ii)
any currently unencumbered assets that could be substituted into those portfolios or used to collateralise debt securities which may be retained by the Group for contingent liquidity purposes.

 
146

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Secured funding (continued)

 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
     
Debt securities in issue
     
Debt securities in issue
Asset type (1)
Assets 
£m 
 
Held by 
third 
parties (2)
£m 
Held by 
the 
Group (3)
£m 
Total 
£m 
 
 
Assets 
£m 
 
Held by 
third 
parties (2)
£m 
Held by 
the 
Group (3)
£m 
Total 
£m 
Mortgages
                     
  - UK (RMBS)
49,549 
 
10,988 
47,324 
58,312 
 
53,132 
 
13,047 
50,028 
63,075 
  - UK (covered bonds)
15,441 
 
9,107 
9,107 
 
8,046 
 
4,100 
4,100 
  - Irish
12,660 
 
3,472 
8,670 
12,142 
 
15,034 
 
5,101 
11,152 
16,253 
UK credit cards
4,037 
 
500 
110 
610 
 
3,993 
 
34 
1,500 
1,534 
UK personal loans
5,168 
 
4,706 
4,706 
 
5,795 
 
5,383 
5,383 
Other
19,778 
 
20,577 
20,581 
 
25,193 
 
974 
23,186 
24,160 
 
106,633 
 
24,071 
81,387 
105,458 
 
111,193 
 
23,256 
91,249 
114,505 
Cash deposits (4)
11,998 
         
13,068 
       
 
118,631 
         
124,261 
       

Notes:
(1)
Assets that have been pledged to the SPEs which itself is a subset of the total portfolio of eligible assets within a collateral pool.
(2)
Debt securities that have been sold to third party investors and represents a source of external wholesale funding.
(3)
Debt securities issued pursuant to own-asset securitisations where the debt securities are retained by the Group as a source of contingent liquidity where those securities can be used in repurchase agreements with central banks.
(4)
Cash deposits, £11.2 billion from mortgage repayments and £0.8 billion from other loan repayments held in the SPEs, to repay debt securities issued by the own-asset securitisation vehicles.

Securities repurchase agreements
The Group enters into securities repurchase agreements and securities lending transactions under which it transfers securities in accordance with normal market practice. Generally, the agreements require additional collateral to be provided if the value of the securities falls below a predetermined level. Under standard terms for repurchase transactions in the UK and US markets, the recipient of collateral has an unrestricted right to sell or repledge it, subject to returning equivalent securities on settlement of the transaction.

Securities sold under repurchase transactions are not derecognised if the Group retains substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership. The fair value (which is equivalent to the carrying value) of securities transferred under such repurchase transactions included within debt securities on the balance sheet is set out below. All of these securities could be sold or repledged by the holder.

Assets pledged against liabilities
31 December 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m 
Debt securities
79,480 
80,100 
Equity shares
6,534 
5,148 

 
147

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Liquidity management
Liquidity risk management requires ongoing assessment and calibration of: how the various sources of the Group’s liquidity risk interact with each other; market dynamics; and regulatory developments to determine the overall size of the Group’s liquid asset buffer. In addition to the size determination, the composition of the buffer is also important. The composition is reviewed on a continuous basis in order to ensure that the Group holds an appropriate portfolio of high quality assets that can provide a cushion against market disruption and dislocation, even in the most extreme stress circumstances.

Liquidity portfolio
The table below shows the composition of the Group’s liquidity portfolio (at estimated liquidity value). All assets within the liquidity portfolio are unencumbered.
 
 
31 December 2011
  30 September 
2011
Period end 
  31 December 
2010 
Period end
 
Average 
Period end 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
         
Cash and balances at central banks
74,711 
69,932 
76,833 
53,661 
Treasury bills
5,937 
4,037 
14,529 
Central and local government bonds (1)
       
  - AAA rated governments and US agencies
37,947 
29,632 
29,850 
41,435 
  - AA- to AA+ rated governments (2)
3,074 
14,102 
18,077 
3,744 
  - governments rated below AA
925 
955 
700 
1,029 
  - local government
4,779 
4,302 
4,700 
5,672 
         
 
46,725 
48,991 
53,327 
51,880 
Other assets (3)
       
  - AAA rated
21,973 
25,202 
24,186 
17,836 
  - below AAA rated and other high quality assets
12,102 
11,205 
11,444 
16,693 
         
 
34,075 
36,407 
35,630 
34,529 
         
Total liquidity portfolio
161,448 
155,330 
169,827 
154,599 

Notes:
(1)
Includes FSA eligible government bonds of £36.7 billion at 31 December 2011 (30 September 2011 - £36.8 billion; 31 December 2010 - £34.7 billion).
(2)
Includes AAA rated US government guaranteed and US government sponsored agencies. The US government was downgraded from AAA to AA+ by S&P on 5 August 2011, although not by Moody’s or Fitch. These securities are reflected here.
(3)
Includes assets eligible for discounting at central banks.

Key point
·
In view of the continuing uncertain market conditions, the liquidity portfolio was maintained above the Group’s target level of £150 billion at £155.3 billion, with an average balance in 2011 of £161.4 billion. In anticipation of challenging market conditions, the composition was altered to become more liquid and conservative, as cash and balances at central banks rose to 45% of the total portfolio at 31 December 2011, from 35% at 31 December 2010.

 
148

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk (continued)

Liquidity and funding metrics
The Group continues to improve and augment liquidity and funding risk management practices, in light of market experience and emerging regulatory and industry standards. The Group monitors a range of liquidity and funding indicators. These metrics encompass short and long-term liquidity requirements under stress and normal operating conditions. Two key structural ratios are described below.

Loan to deposit ratio and funding gap
The table below shows quarterly trends in the Group’s loan to deposit ratio and customer funding gap, including disposal groups.

 
Loan to
deposit ratio
 
Customer 
 funding gap 
 
Group 
Core 
 
Group 
 
 
£bn 
         
31 December 2011
108 
94 
 
37 
30 September 2011
112 
95 
 
52 
30 June 2011
114 
96 
 
60 
31 March 2011
116 
96 
 
67 
31 December 2010
118 
96 
 
77 

Note:
(1)
Loans are net of provisions.

Key points
·
The Group’s loan to deposit ratio improved 1,000 basis points to 108% during 2011, as loans declined and deposits grew.
   
·
The customer funding gap halved with Non-Core contributing £27 billion of the £37 billion reduction.


Net stable funding ratio
The table below shows the Group’s net stable funding ratio (NSFR), estimated by applying the Basel III guidance issued in December 2010. The Group is aiming to meet the minimum required NSFR of 100% over the longer term. This measure seeks to show the proportion of structural term assets which are funded by stable funding, including customer deposits, long-term wholesale funding and equity. One of the main components of the ratio entails categorising retail and SME deposits as either ‘more stable’ or ‘less stable’. The Group’s NSFR will also continue to be refined over time in line with regulatory developments. It may be calculated on a basis that is not consistent with that used by other financial institutions.

 
149

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Liquidity and funding risk: Net stable funding ratio (continued)

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
   
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
   
ASF (1)
 
Weighting 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
Equity
76 
76 
 
79 
79 
 
77 
77 
 
100 
Wholesale funding > 1 year
124 
124 
 
125 
125 
 
154 
154 
 
100 
Wholesale funding < 1 year
134 
 
174 
 
157 
 
Derivatives
524 
 
562 
 
424 
 
Repurchase agreements
129 
 
132 
 
115 
 
Deposits
                   
  - Retail and SME - more stable
227 
204 
 
170 
153 
 
172 
155 
 
90 
  - Retail and SME - less stable
31 
25 
 
25 
20 
 
51 
41 
 
80 
  - Other
179 
89 
 
239 
120 
 
206 
103 
 
50 
Other (2)
83 
 
102 
 
98 
 
Total liabilities and equity
1,507 
518 
 
1,608 
497 
 
1,454 
530 
   
Cash
79 
 
78 
 
57 
 
Inter-bank lending
44 
 
53 
 
58 
 
Debt securities > 1 year
                   
  - central and local governments
    AAA to AA-
77 
 
84 
 
89 
 
  - other eligible bonds
73 
15 
 
75 
15 
 
75 
15 
 
20 
  - other bonds
14 
14 
 
17 
17 
 
10 
10 
 
100 
Debt securities < 1 year
45 
 
54 
 
43 
 
Derivatives
530 
 
572 
 
427 
 
Reverse repurchase agreements
101 
 
102 
 
95 
 
Customer loans and advances > 1 year
                   
  - residential mortgages
145 
94 
 
144 
94 
 
145 
94 
 
65 
  - other
173 
173 
 
176 
176 
 
211 
211 
 
100 
Customer loans and advances < 1 year
                   
  - retail loans
19 
16 
 
20 
17 
 
22 
19 
 
85 
  - other
137 
69 
 
146 
73 
 
125 
63 
 
50 
Other (3)
70 
70 
 
87 
87 
 
97 
97 
 
100 
Total assets
1,507 
455 
 
1,608 
483 
 
1,454 
513 
   
Undrawn commitments
240 
12 
 
245 
12 
 
267 
13 
 
Total assets and undrawn commitments
1,747 
467 
 
1,853 
495 
 
1,721 
526 
   
Net stable funding ratio
 
111% 
   
100% 
   
101% 
   

Notes:
(1)
Available stable funding.
(2)
Deferred tax, insurance liabilities and other liabilities.
(3)
Prepayments, accrued income, deferred tax and other assets.

Key points
·
The NSFR increased by 10% in the year to 111%, with the funding cushion over term assets  and undrawn commitments increasing from £4 billion to £51 billion.
   
·
Available stable funding decreased by £12 billion in the year as a result of a £30 billion reduction in long-term wholesale funding, including the move into short-term of approximately £20 billion of balances under the CGS. This was offset by a £19 billion increase in qualifying deposit balances, including classification of certain deposits as more stable, as some assumptions and methodologies were refined.
   
·
Term assets decreased in the year by £38 billion primarily reflecting Non-Core disposals and run-offs. The decrease in other assets is primarily due to the closures of certain equities businesses in Global Banking & Markets and other asset movements.

 
150

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Interest rate risk
Interest rate risk in the banking book (IRRBB) value-at-risk (VaR) for the Group’s retail and commercial banking activities at a 99% confidence level was as follows:

 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
31 December 2011
63 
51 
80 
44 
31 December 2010
58 
96 
96 
30 

A breakdown of the Group’s IRRBB VaR by currency is shown below.

Currency
31 December 
 2011 
£m 
31 December 
 2010 
£m 
Euro
26 
33 
Sterling
57 
79 
US dollar
61 
121 
Other
10 

Key points
·
Interest rate exposure at 31 December 2011 was considerably lower than at 31 December 2010 but average exposure was 9% higher in 2011 than in 2010.
   
·
The reduction in US dollar VaR reflects, in part, changes in holding period assumptions following changes in Non-Core assets.

 
151

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Balance sheet management: Interest rate risk (continued)

Sensitivity of net interest income
The Group seeks to mitigate the effect of prospective interest rate movements, which could reduce future net interest income (NII) in the Group’s businesses, whilst balancing the cost of such activities on the current net revenue stream. Hedging activities also consider the impact on market value sensitivity under stress.

The following table shows the sensitivity of NII, over the next twelve months, to an immediate upward or downward change of 100 basis points to all interest rates. In addition, the table includes the impact of a gradual 400 basis point steepening and a gradual 300 basis point flattening of the yield curve at tenors greater than a year. This scenario differs from that applied in the previous year in both the severity of the rate shift and the tenors to which this is applied.

Potential favourable/(adverse) impact on NII
31 December 
2011 
£m 
30 September 
2011 
£m 
31 December 
2010 
£m
+ 100 basis points shift in yield curves
244 
188 
232 
– 100 basis points shift in yield curves
(183)
(74)
(352)
Bear steepener
443 
487 
 
Bull flattener
(146)
(248)
 

Key points
·
The Group’s interest rate exposure remains slightly asset sensitive, driven in part by changes to underlying business assumptions as rates rise. The impact of the steepening and flattening scenarios is largely driven by the investment of net free reserves.
   
·
The reported sensitivity will vary over time due to a number of factors such as market conditions and strategic changes to the balance sheet mix and should not therefore be considered predictive of future performance.


Structural foreign currency exposures
The Group does not maintain material non-trading open currency positions, other than the structural foreign currency translation exposures arising from its investments in foreign subsidiaries and associated undertakings and their related currency funding. The Group’s structural foreign currency exposure was £24.2 billion and £17.9 billion before and after economic hedges respectively, broadly unchanged from the 2010 position.

 
152

 
 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk of financial loss due to the failure of a customer to meet its obligation to settle outstanding amounts. The quantum and nature of credit risk assumed across the Group’s different businesses vary considerably, while the overall credit risk outcome usually exhibits a high degree of correlation with the macroeconomic environment.

Loans and advances to customers by sector
In the table below loans and advances exclude disposal groups and repurchase agreements. Totals for disposal groups are also presented.


 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core (1)
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core (1)
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core (1)
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Central and local government
8,359 
1,383 
9,742 
 
8,097 
1,507 
9,604 
 
6,781 
1,671 
8,452 
Finance
46,452 
3,229 
49,681 
 
48,094 
4,884 
52,978 
 
46,910 
7,651 
54,561 
Residential mortgages
138,509 
5,102 
143,611 
 
143,941 
5,319 
149,260 
 
140,359 
6,142 
146,501 
Personal lending
31,067 
1,556 
32,623 
 
32,152 
2,810 
34,962 
 
33,581 
3,891 
37,472 
Property
38,704 
38,064 
76,768 
 
44,072 
40,628 
84,700 
 
42,455 
47,651 
90,106 
Construction
6,781 
2,672 
9,453 
 
7,992 
3,062 
11,054 
 
8,680 
3,352 
12,032 
Manufacturing
23,201 
4,931 
28,132 
 
24,816 
5,233 
30,049 
 
25,797 
6,520 
32,317 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
21,314 
2,339 
23,653 
 
22,207 
2,427 
24,634 
 
21,974 
3,191 
25,165 
  - transport and storage
16,454 
5,477 
21,931 
 
16,236 
6,009 
22,245 
 
15,946 
8,195 
24,141 
  - health, education and
    Recreation
13,273 
1,419 
14,692 
 
16,224 
1,515 
17,739 
 
17,456 
1,865 
19,321 
  - hotels and restaurants
7,143 
1,161 
8,304 
 
7,841 
1,358 
9,199 
 
8,189 
1,492 
9,681 
  - utilities
6,543 
1,849 
8,392 
 
8,212 
1,725 
9,937 
 
7,098 
2,110 
9,208 
  - other
24,228 
3,772 
28,000 
 
24,744 
4,479 
29,223 
 
24,464 
5,530 
29,994 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,471 
129 
3,600 
 
3,767 
135 
3,902 
 
3,758 
135 
3,893 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
8,440 
6,059 
14,499 
 
8,404 
7,467 
15,871 
 
8,321 
8,529 
16,850 
Interest accruals
675 
116 
791 
 
661 
152 
813 
 
831 
278 
1,109 
                       
Gross loans
394,614 
79,258 
473,872 
 
417,460 
88,710 
506,170 
 
412,600 
108,203 
520,803 
                       
Gross loans including disposal
  groups
414,063 
80,005 
494,068 
 
417,510 
90,389 
507,899 
 
412,851 
113,001 
525,852 
                       
Loan impairment provisions
(8,292)
(11,468)
(19,760)
 
(8,748)
(11,849)
(20,597)
 
(7,740)
(10,315)
(18,055)
                       
Loan impairment provisions
  including disposal groups
(9,065)
(11,486)
(20,551)
 
(8,748)
(11,867)
(20,615)
 
(7,740)
(10,351)
(18,091)
                       
Net loans
386,322 
67,790 
454,112 
 
408,712 
76,861 
485,573
 
404,860 
97,888 
502,748 
                       
Net loans including disposal
  groups
404,998 
68,519 
473,517 
 
408,762 
78,522 
487,284 
 
405,111 
102,650 
507,761 
 
Note:
(1)
Non-Core includes amounts relating to RFS MI of £0.4 billion at 31 December 2011 (30 September 2011 - £0.6 billion; 31 December 2010 - £0.6 billion)

Key points
·
Gross loans and advances including disposal groups decreased by £31.8 billion during 2011 and £13.8 billion in Q4 2011, predominantly in Non-Core.
·
Non-Core disposal strategy led to gross loans decreasing by £33 billion (Q4 2011 - £10.4 billion). Property accounted for 40% of this decrease.
 
 
153

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Risk elements in lending
The table below analyses the Group’s risk elements in lending (REIL) without taking account of any security held which could reduce the eventual loss should it occur, nor of any provisions. REIL is split into UK and overseas, based on the location of the lending office.

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Impaired loans (1)
                     
  - UK
8,291 
7,284 
15,575 
 
9,222 
7,471 
16,693 
 
8,575 
7,835 
16,410 
  - Overseas
7,015 
16,157 
23,172 
 
6,695 
16,274 
22,969 
 
4,936 
14,355 
19,291 
                       
 
15,306 
23,441 
38,747 
 
15,917 
23,745 
39,662 
 
13,511 
22,190 
35,701 
                       
Accruing loans past due
  90 days or more (2)
                     
  - UK
1,192 
508 
1,700 
 
1,648 
580 
2,228 
 
1,434 
939 
2,373 
  - Overseas
364 
34 
398 
 
580 
256 
836 
 
262 
262 
524 
                       
 
1,556 
542 
2,098 
 
2,228 
836 
3,064 
 
1,696 
1,201 
2,897 
                       
Total REIL
16,862 
23,983 
40,845 
 
18,145 
24,581 
42,726 
 
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
                       
REIL including disposal groups
   
42,394 
     
42,752 
     
38,651 
                       
REIL as a % of gross
  loans and advances (3)
4.4% 
30.1% 
8.6% 
 
4.3% 
27.4% 
8.4% 
 
3.7% 
20.8% 
7.3% 
Provisions as a % of REIL
50% 
48% 
49% 
 
49% 
48% 
49% 
 
52% 
44% 
47% 

Notes:
(1)
All loans against which an impairment provision is held.
(2)
Loans where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision recognised. This category is used for fully collateralised non-revolving credit facilities.
(3)
Includes disposal groups and excludes reverse repos.
 
Key points
·
REIL, including disposal groups, increased by £3.7 billion in the year.
   
·
Ulster Bank Group’s non-performing loans increased significantly by £3.5 billion (Core - £1.9 billion; Non-Core - £1.6 billion). This principally related to residential mortgages (£0.6 billion, 39% increase) and commercial real estate (£2.4 billion, 25% increase), reflecting the continued deteriorating conditions in property sectors in Ireland. The Non-Core REIL increase related to Ulster Bank was partially offset by run-off in other Non-Core donating divisions in the year.
   
·
UK Corporate REIL increased by £1.0 billion, principally due to extended work-out periods associated with corporate loan restructuring arrangements.
   
·
REIL declined marginally (£0.4 billion) during Q4 2011 principally reflecting Non-Core GBM write-offs.
   
·
Disposal groups REIL at 31 December 2011 of £1.5 billion comprised impaired loans of £1.3 billion; and accruing loans of £0.2 billion in relation to the UK branch based businesses, of which £1 billion was in UK Corporate and £0.5 billion in UK Retail.

For sector, geography and divisional analysis of loans, REIL and impairments, refer to Appendix 2.
 
 
154

 

 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Loans, REIL and impairments by division
The following tables analyse loans and advances to banks and customers (excluding reverse repos) and related REIL, provisions, impairments, write-offs and coverage ratios by division.
 
Gross 
loans 
banks 
Gross 
loans 
customers 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL as a % 
of gross 
customer 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
UK Retail
628 
103,377 
4,087 
2,344 
4.0 
57 
788 
823 
UK Corporate
672 
96,647 
3,972 
1,608 
4.1 
40 
782 
653 
Wealth
2,422 
16,913 
211 
81 
1.2 
38 
25 
11 
Global Transaction Services
3,464 
15,767 
218 
234 
1.4 
107 
166 
79 
Ulster Bank
2,079 
34,052 
5,523 
2,749 
16.2 
50 
1,384 
124 
US Retail & Commercial
208 
51,436 
1,006 
451 
2.0 
45 
247 
371 
                 
Retail & Commercial
9,473 
318,192 
15,017 
7,467 
4.7 
50 
3,392 
2,061 
Global Banking & Markets
30,072 
75,493 
1,845 
947 
2.4 
51 
11 
76 
RBS Insurance and other
3,829 
929 
                 
Core
43,374 
394,614 
16,862 
8,414 
4.3 
50 
3,403 
2,137 
Non-Core
619 
79,258 
23,983 
11,469 
30.3 
48 
3,838 
2,390 
                 
Group
43,993 
473,872 
40,845 
19,883 
8.6 
49 
7,241 
4,527 
                 
Total including disposal groups
44,080 
494,068 
42,394 
20,674 
8.6 
49 
7,241 
4,527 
                 
30 September 2011
               
UK Retail
434 
110,086 
4,651 
2,661 
4.2 
57 
597 
658 
UK Corporate
70 
109,977 
4,904 
1,961 
4.5 
40 
549 
498 
Wealth
2,326 
17,037 
198 
71 
1.2 
36 
13 
Global Transaction Services
3,707 
19,545 
240 
201 
1.2 
84 
119 
66 
Ulster Bank
2,791 
35,546 
5,556 
2,567 
15.6 
46 
1,057 
63 
US Retail & Commercial
186 
49,477 
955 
469 
1.9 
49 
193 
267 
                 
Retail & Commercial
9,514 
341,668 
16,504 
7,930 
4.8 
48 
2,528 
1,560 
Global Banking & Markets
35,900 
73,921 
1,641 
943 
2.2 
57 
(49)
51 
RBS Insurance and other
6,604 
1,871 
                 
Core
52,018 
417,460 
18,145 
8,873 
4.3 
49 
2,479 
1,611 
Non-Core
709 
88,710 
24,581 
11,850 
27.7 
48 
3,108 
1,409 
                 
Group
52,727 
506,170 
42,726 
20,723 
8.4 
49 
5,587 
3,020 
                 
Total including disposal groups
52,822 
507,899 
42,752 
20,741 
8.4 
49 
5,587 
3,020 
                 
31 December 2010
               
UK Retail
408 
108,405 
4,620 
2,741 
4.3 
59 
1,160 
1,135 
UK Corporate
72 
111,672 
3,967 
1,732 
3.6 
44 
761 
349 
Wealth
2,220 
16,130 
223 
66 
1.4 
30 
18 
Global Transaction Services
3,047 
14,437 
146 
147 
1.0 
101 
49 
Ulster Bank
2,928 
36,858 
3,619 
1,633 
9.8 
45 
1,161 
48 
US Retail & Commercial
145 
48,516 
913 
505 
1.9 
55 
483 
547 
                 
Retail & Commercial
8,820 
336,018 
13,488 
6,824 
4.0 
51 
3,591 
2,137 
Global Banking & Markets
46,073 
75,981 
1,719 
1,042 
2.3 
61 
146 
87 
RBS Insurance and other
2,140 
601 
                 
Core
57,033 
412,600  
15,207 
7,866 
3.7 
52 
3,737 
2,224 
Non-Core
1,003 
108,203  
23,391 
10,316 
21.6 
44 
5,407 
3,818 
                 
Group
58,036 
520,803 
38,598 
18,182 
7.4 
47 
9,144 
6,042 
                 
Total including disposal groups
58,687 
525,852 
38,651 
18,218 
7.3 
47 
9,144 
6,042 
 
 
155

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Risk elements in lending
The tables below details the movement in REIL for the year ended 31 December 2011.

 
Impaired loans
 
Other loans (1)
 
REIL
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
At 1 January 2011
13,511 
22,190 
35,701 
 
1,696 
1,201 
2,897 
 
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
Transfers to disposal groups
(1,287)
(1,287)
 
(238)
(238)
 
(1,525)
(1,525)
Intra-group transfers
300 
(300)
 
149 
(149)
 
449 
(449)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(158)
(496)
(654)
 
(14)
(14)
 
(172)
(496)
(668)
Additions
8,379 
8,698 
17,077 
 
2,585 
1,059 
3,644 
 
10,964 
9,757 
20,721 
Transfers
645 
381 
1,026 
 
(362)
(352)
(714)
 
283 
29 
312 
Disposals and restructurings
(407)
(1,470)
(1,877)
 
(9)
(97)
(106)
 
(416)
(1,567)
(1,983)
Repayments
(3,540)
(3,172)
(6,712)
 
(2,251)
(1,120)
(3,371)
 
(5,791)
(4,292)
(10,083)
Amounts written-off
(2,137)
(2,390)
(4,527)
 
 
(2,137)
(2,390)
(4,527)
                       
At 31 December 2011
15,306 
23,441 
38,747 
 
1,556 
542 
2,098 
 
16,862 
23,983 
40,845 

 
Impaired loans
 
Other loans (1)
 
REIL
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
At 1 January 2011
13,511 
22,190 
35,701 
 
1,696 
1,201 
2,897 
 
15,207 
23,391 
38,598 
Intra-group transfers
300 
(300)
 
81 
(81)
 
381 
(381)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(167)
(167)
 
(5)
(3)
(8)
 
(5)
(170)
(175)
Additions
6,261 
6,910 
13,171 
 
2,143 
827 
2,970 
 
8,404 
7,737 
16,141 
Transfers
400 
312 
712 
 
(217)
(235)
(452)
 
183 
77 
260 
Disposals and restructurings
(373)
(1,206)
(1,579)
 
(9)
(97)
(106)
 
(382)
(1,303)
(1,685)
Repayments
(2,571)
(2,585)
(5,156)
 
(1,461)
(776)
(2,237)
 
(4,032)
(3,361)
(7,393)
Amounts written-off
(1,611)
(1,409)
(3,020)
 
 
(1,611)
(1,409)
(3,020)
                       
At 30 September 2011
15,917 
23,745 
39,662 
 
2,228 
836 
3,064 
 
18,145 
24,581 
42,726 
Transfers to disposal groups
(1,287)
(1,287)
 
(238)
(238)
 
(1,525)
(1,525)
Intra-group transfers
 
68 
(68)
 
68
(68)
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(158)
 (329)
(487)
 
(9)
(6)
 
(167)
(326)
(493)
Additions
2,118 
1,788 
3,906 
 
442 
232 
674 
 
2,560 
2,020 
4,580 
Transfers
245 
69 
314 
 
(145)
(117)
(262)
 
100 
(48)
52 
Disposals and restructurings
(34)
(264)
(298)
         
(34)
(264)
(298)
Repayments
(969)
(587)
(1,556)
 
(790)
(344)
(1,134)
 
(1,759)
(931)
(2,690)
Amounts written-off
(526)
(981)
(1,507)
 
 
(526)
(981)
(1,507)
                       
At 31 December 2011
15,306 
23,441 
38,747 
 
1,556 
542 
2,098 
 
16,862 
23,983 
40,845 

Note:
(1)
Accruing loans past due 90 days or more.

 
156

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Impairment provisions

Movement in loan impairment provisions
The following tables show the movement in impairment provisions for loans and advances to banks and customers.
 
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
At beginning of period
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
 
6,921 
8,252 
2,110 
17,283 
Transfers to disposal groups
(773)
(773)
 
(72)
(72)
Intra-group transfers
177 
(177)
 
(568)
568 
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(76)
(207)
(283)
 
(16)
59 
43 
Disposals
 
(20)
(2,152)
(2,172)
Amounts written-off
(2,137)
(2,390)
(4,527)
 
(2,224)
(3,818)
(6,042)
Recoveries of amounts
  previously written-off
167 
360 
527 
 
213 
198
411 
Charge to income statement
                 
  - continued
3,403 
3,838 
7,241 
 
3,737 
5,407
9,144 
  - discontinued
(8)
(8)
 
42 
42 
Unwind of discount
(213)
(271)
(484)
 
(197)
(258)
(455)
                   
At end of period
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS 
MI 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                           
At beginning of period
8,873 
11,850 
20,723 
 
8,752 
12,007 
20,759 
 
7,791 
9,879 
17,670 
Transfers to disposal
  groups
(773)
(773)
 
 
(5)
 
(5)
Intra-group transfers
 
 
(217)
217 
Currency translation and
  other adjustments
(75)
(162)
(237)
 
(90)
(285)
(375)
 
147 
(235)
(88)
Disposals
(3)
(3)
 
 
(3)
(3)
(6)
Amounts written-off
(526)
(981)
(1,507)
 
(593)
(497)
(1,090)
 
(745)
(771)
(1,516)
Recoveries of amounts
  previously written-off
48 
99 
147 
 
39 
55 
94 
 
29 
67 
96 
Charge to income
   statement
                         
  - continued
924 
730 
1,654 
 
817 
635 
1,452 
 
912 
1,243 
2,155 
  - discontinued
 
 
Unwind of discount
(57)
(67)
(124)
 
(52)
(65)
(117)
 
(51)
(76)
(127)
                           
At end of period
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
8,873 
11,850 
20,723 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 

Key points
·
Impairment provisions excluding £0.8 billion relating to disposal groups increased by £1.7 billion during 2011.
   
·
Ulster Bank Group’s provisions increased by £3.1 billion during the year (Core - £1.1 billion; Non-Core - £2.0 billion), with REIL coverage increasing to 53% (Core - 50%; Non-Core - 54%) from 44% at the end of 2010, predominantly reflecting the deterioration in value of the commercial real estate development portfolio.
 
 
157

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Impairment provisions (continued)

Movement in loan impairment provisions (continued)
The following table analyses impairment provisions in respect of loans and advances to banks and customers.

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Latent loss
1,339 
647 
1,986 
 
1,516 
751 
2,267 
 
1,653 
997 
2,650 
Collectively assessed
4,279 
861 
5,140 
 
4,675 
1,114 
5,789 
 
4,139 
1,157 
5,296 
Individually assessed
2,674 
9,960 
12,634 
 
2,557 
9,984 
12,541 
 
1,948 
8,161 
10,109 
                       
Customer loans
8,292 
11,468 
19,760 
 
8,748 
11,849 
20,597 
 
7,740 
10,315 
18,055 
Bank loans
122 
123 
 
125 
126 
 
126 
127 
                       
Total provisions
8,414 
11,469 
19,883 
 
8,873 
11,850 
20,723 
 
7,866 
10,316 
18,182 
                       
% of loans (1)
2.2% 
14.4% 
4.2% 
 
2.1% 
13.2% 
4.1% 
 
1.9% 
9.1% 
3.4% 

Note:
(1)
Customer provisions as a percentage of gross loans and advances to customers including assets of disposal groups and excluding reverse repos.

Impairment charge
The following table analyses the impairment charge for loans and securities.

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non-Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Latent loss
(252)
(293)
(545)
 
(5)
(116)
(121)
Collectively assessed
2,075 
516 
2,591 
 
2,258 
812 
3,070 
Individually assessed
1,580 
3,615 
5,195 
 
1,489 
4,719 
6,208 
                 
Customer loans
3,403 
3,838 
7,241 
 
3,742 
5,415 
9,157 
Bank loans
 
(5)
(8)
(13)
Securities - sovereign debt impairment and
  related interest rate hedge adjustments
1,268 
1,268 
 
Securities - other
117 
81 
200 
 
44 
68 
112 
                 
Charge to income statement
4,788 
3,919 
8,709 
 
3,781 
5,475 
9,256 
                 
Charge relating to customer loans as a %
  of gross customer loans (1)
0.8% 
4.8% 
1.5% 
 
0.9% 
4.9% 
1.7% 

 
158

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Impairment charge (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
RFS MI 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                         
Latent loss
(87)
(103)
(190)
 
(33)
(27)
(60)
 
(68)
(48)
(116)
Collectively assessed
478 
113 
591 
 
548 
141 
689 
 
559 
170 
729 
Individually assessed
533 
720 
1,253 
 
302 
521 
823 
 
426 
1,129 
1,555 
                         
Customer loans
924 
730 
1,654 
 
817 
635 
1,452 
 
917 
1,251 
2,168 
Bank loans
 
- 
 
(5)
(8)
(13)
Securities - sovereign debt
  impairment and related
  interest rate hedge
  adjustments
224 
224 
 
202 
202 
 
Securities - other
17 
21 
40 
 
37 
47 
84 
 
19  
(33)
(14)
                         
Charge to income
  statement
1,165 
751 
1,918 
 
1,056 
682 
1,738 
 
931 
1,210 
2,141 
                         
Charge relating to
  customer loans as a % of
  gross customer loans (1)
0.9% 
3.7% 
1.3% 
 
0.8% 
2.8% 
1.1% 
 
0.9% 
4.4% 
1.6% 

Note:
(1)
Customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of gross loans and advances to customers including assets of disposal groups and excluding reverse purchase agreements.

Key points
·
The impairment charge, excluding securities, decreased by £1.9 billion or 21% compared with 2010, driven largely by a £1.6 billion reduction in Non-Core, despite continuing challenges in Ulster Bank and corporate real estate portfolios.
   
·
The Group’s customer loan impairment charge as a percentage of loans and advances was 1.5% compared with 1.7% for 2010.
   
·
The securities impairment in 2011 primarily reflects an impairment charge of £1.3 billion in respect of the Group’s holdings of Greek sovereign bonds and related interest rate hedges.
 
 
159

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Restructuring and forbearance

Wholesale loan restructuring
The total amount of wholesale restructurings that achieved legal completion in 2011 was £8.6 billion. In addition, a further £14.7 billion was in the process of being completed at 31 December 2011. Restructured loans, related internal asset quality bands, sector breakdown and types of restructuring are set out below.

31 December 2011
AQ1-AQ9 (1)
£m 
 
AQ10 (2)
£m 
AQ10 (2)
Provision 
coverage 
         
Wholesale restructurings by sector
       
Property
1,980 
 
2,600 
18 
Transport
686 
 
694 
11 
Non-bank financial institutions
228 
 
420 
65 
Retail and leisure
503 
 
148 
24 
Other
1,078 
 
251 
28 
         
Total
4,475 
 
4,113 
22 

Notes:
(1)
Probability of default less than 100%.
(2)
Probability of default is 100%.

The incidence of the main types of restructuring is analysed below.

31 December 2011
Loans 
 by value 
   
Wholesale restructurings by type of arrangement
 
Variation in margin
12 
Payment holidays and loan rescheduling
87 
Forgiveness of all or part of the outstanding debt
31 
Other

Note:
(1)
The total above exceeds 100% as an individual case can involve more than one type of arrangement.

 
160

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Restructuring and forbearance (continued)

Retail forbearance
Retail mortgage accounts in forbearance arrangements at 31 December 2011 totalled £6.6 billion. The mortgage arrears information for retail accounts in forbearance and related provision arrangements are shown in the table below.

 
No missed
payments
 
1-3 months
in arrears
 
>3 months
in arrears
 
Total
   
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Balance 
Provision 
 
Accounts 
forborne 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
                           
Arrears status and
  provisions
                         
UK Retail (1,2)
3,677 
16 
 
351 
13 
 
407 
59 
 
4,435 
88 
 
4.7 
Ulster Bank (1,2)
893 
78 
 
516 
45 
 
421 
124 
 
1,830 
247 
 
9.1 
Citizens
 
91 
10 
 
89 
10 
 
180 
20 
 
0.8 
Wealth
121 
 
 
 
123 
 
1.3 
                           
Total
4,691 
94 
 
958 
68 
 
919 
193 
 
6,568 
355 
 
4.4 

Notes:
(1)
Includes all forbearance arrangements regardless of whether or not the customer is experiencing financial difficulty.
(2)
Comprises the current stock position of forbearance deals agreed since January 2008 for UK Retail and since July 2008 for Ulster Bank.
(3)
Refer to page 178 for details of the proportion of UK Retail and Citizens mortgage loans that have missed three or more payments, compared to the forbearance population above.


 
UK Retail (1)
Ulster Bank 
Citizens 
Wealth 
Total (2)
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
Forbearance arrangements
         
Interest only conversions
1,269 
795 
2,067 
Term extensions - capital repayment and interest only
1,805 
58 
97 
1,960 
Payment concessions/holidays
198 
876 
180 
1,254 
Capitalisation of arrears
864 
101 
965 
Other
517 
23 
540 
           
Total
4,653 
1,830 
180 
123 
6,786 

Notes:
(1)
For unsecured portfolios in UK Retail, 1.1% of the total unsecured population was subject to forbearance at 31 December 2011.
(2)
As an individual case can include more than one type of arrangement, the analysis in the table on forbearance arrangements exceeds the total forbearance.

 
161

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Debt securities
The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and measurement classification. The categorisation of debt securities has been revised to include asset-backed securities (ABS) by class of issuer. The main changes are to US central and local government which includes US federal agencies, and financial institutions which now includes US government sponsored agencies and securitisation entities. 2010 data are presented on the revised basis.
 
    Central and local government          
 
UK
US 
Other
Banks
Other
financial
institutions
Corporate
Total
Of which
ABS
 
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
£m
                 
31 December 2011
               
Held-for-trading
9,004 
19,636 
36,928 
3,400 
23,160 
2,948 
95,076 
20,816 
Designated as at fair value
127 
53 
457 
647 
558 
Available-for-sale
13,436 
20,848 
25,552 
13,175 
31,752 
2,535 
107,298 
40,735 
Loans and receivables
10 
312 
5,259 
477 
6,059 
5,200 
                 
Long positions
22,451 
40,484 
62,608 
16,940 
60,628 
5,969 
209,080 
67,309 
                 
Of which US agencies
4,896 
25,924 
30,820 
28,558 
                 
Short positions (HFT)
(3,098)
(10,661)
(19,136)
(2,556)
(2,854)
(754)
(39,059)
(352)
                 
Available-for-sale
               
Gross unrealised gains
1,428 
1,311 
1,180 
52 
913 
94 
4,978 
1,001 
Gross unrealised losses
(171)
(838)
(2,386)
(13)
(3,408)
(3,158)
                 
30 September 2011
               
                 
Held-for-trading
8,434 
20,120 
47,621 
4,216 
27,511 
4,666 
112,568 
24,123 
Designated as at fair value
140 
10 
162 
Available-for-sale
13,328 
20,032 
28,976 
17,268 
28,463 
2,334 
110,401 
41,091 
Loans and receivables
10 
274 
5,764 
478 
6,526 
5,447 
                 
Long positions
21,773 
40,152 
76,737 
21,762 
61,745 
7,488 
229,657 
70,662 
                 
Of which US agencies
5,311 
27,931 
33,242 
30,272 
                 
Short positions (HFT)
(2,896)
(12,763)
(21,484)
(2,043)
(4,437)
(1,680)
(45,303)
(895)
                 
Available-for-sale
               
Gross unrealised gains
1,090 
1,240 
1,331 
310 
1,117 
81 
5,169 
1,242 
Gross unrealised losses
(124)
(1,039)
(2,371)
(24)
(3,558)
(3,114)

 
162

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Debt securities (continued)
 
  Central and local government          
 
UK
US
Other
Banks
Other 
financial 
institutions
Corporate
Total
Of which 
ABS
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Held-for-trading
5,097 
15,648 
42,828 
5,486 
23,711 
6,099 
98,869 
21,988 
Designated as at fair value
117 
262 
10 
402 
119 
Available-for-sale
8,377 
22,244 
32,865 
16,982 
29,148 
1,514 
111,130 
42,515 
Loans and receivables
11 
6,686 
381 
7,079 
6,203 
                 
Long positions
13,486 
38,009 
75,955 
22,473 
59,553 
8,004 
217,480 
70,825 
                 
Of which US agencies
6,811 
21,686 
28,497 
25,375 
                 
Short positions (HFT)
(4,200)
(10,943)
(18,913)
(1,844)
(3,356)
(1,761)
(41,017)
(1,335)
                 
Available-for-sale
               
Gross unrealised gains
349 
525 
700 
143 
827 
51 
2,595 
1,057 
Gross unrealised losses
(10)
(2)
(618)
(786)
(2,626)
(55)
(4,097)
(3,396)


Key points
·
Held-for-trading debt securities decreased by £3.8 billion during the year due to a reduction in trading volumes. A managed reduction in sovereign exposures in the eurozone and other countries, in response to the current economic environment, was offset by an increase in UK and US government bonds.
   
·
The Group’s available-for-sale portfolio decreased by £3.8 billion. An increase in UK government bonds of £5.1 billion, principally in Group Treasury partially offset reductions in holdings of securities issued by other central and local governments and banks.

The table below analyses available-for-sale debt securities and related reserves, gross of tax.

 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
US 
UK 
Other (1)
Total 
 
US 
UK 
Other (1)
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Central and local
  Government
20,848 
13,436 
25,552 
59,836 
 
22,244 
8,377 
32,865 
63,486 
Banks
376 
1,391 
11,408 
13,175 
 
704 
4,297 
11,981 
16,982 
Other financial institutions
17,453 
3,100 
11,199 
31,752 
 
15,973 
1,662 
11,513 
29,148 
Corporate
131 
1,105 
1,299 
2,535 
 
65 
438 
1,011 
1,514 
                   
Total
38,808 
19,032 
49,458 
107,298 
 
38,986 
14,774 
57,370 
111,130 
                   
Of which ABS
20,256 
3,659 
16,820 
40,735 
 
20,872 
4,002 
17,641 
42,515 
                   
AFS reserves (gross)
486 
845 
(1,815)
(484)
 
(304)
158 
(2,559)
(2,705)

Note:
(1)
Includes eurozone countries that are detailed on pages 191 to 208.

 
163

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Debt securities (continued)

The table below analyses debt securities by issuer and external ratings. Ratings are based on the lowest of S&P, Moody’s and Fitch.

 
  Central and local  government            
 
31 December 2011
UK
£m
US
£m
Other
£m
Banks
£m
Other
financial
institutions
£m
Corporate
£m
Total
£m
 
% of
total
Of which
ABS
£m
AAA
22,451 
45 
32,522 
5,155 
15,908 
452 
76,533 
37 
17,156 
AA to AA+
40,435 
2,000 
2,497 
30,403 
639 
75,974 
36 
33,615 
A to AA-
24,966 
6,387 
4,979 
1,746 
38,079 
18 
6,331 
BBB- to A-
2,194 
2,287 
2,916 
1,446 
8,843 
4,480 
Non-investment grade
924 
575 
5,042 
1,275 
7,816 
4,492 
Unrated
39 
1,380 
411 
1,835 
1,235 
                   
 
22,451 
40,484 
62,608 
16,940 
60,628 
5,969 
209,080 
100 
67,309 
                   
30 September 2011
                 
                   
AAA
21,773 
27 
43,712 
9,363 
14,120 
553 
89,548 
39 
18,771 
AA to AA+
40,094 
4,247 
4,279 
31,785 
661 
81,066 
35 
35,954 
A to AA-
25,043 
5,087 
4,783 
1,894 
36,816 
16 
5,670 
BBB- to A-
2,460 
2,032 
3,873 
2,104 
10,469 
4,431 
Non-investment grade
1,242 
709 
5,242 
1,778 
8,971 
4,619 
Unrated
22 
33 
292 
1,942 
498 
2,787 
1,217 
                   
 
21,773 
40,152 
76,737 
21,762 
61,745 
7,488 
229,657 
100 
70,662 
                   
31 December 2010
                 
                   
AAA
13,486 
38,009 
44,123 
10,704 
39,388 
878 
146,588 
67 
51,235 
AA to AA+
18,025 
3,511 
6,023 
616 
28,175 
13 
6,335 
A to AA-
9,138 
4,926 
2,656 
1,155 
17,875 
3,244 
BBB- to A-
2,845 
1,324 
3,412 
2,005 
9,586 
3,385 
Non-investment grade
1,770 
1,528 
5,522 
2,425 
11,245 
4,923 
Unrated
54 
480 
2,552 
925 
4,011 
1,703 
                   
 
13,486 
38,009 
75,955 
22,473 
59,553 
8,004 
217,480 
100 
70,825 

Key points
·
The decrease in AAA rated debt securities relates to the downgrading of US government and agencies to AA+ by S&P during the year.
   
·
The proportion of debt securities rated A to AA- increased to 18%, principally reflecting the Japanese government downgrade in 2011.
   
·
Non-investment grade and unrated debt securities now account for 5% of the debt securities portfolio, down from 7% at the start of the year.

 
164

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Asset-backed securities

 
RMBS (1)
             
 
Government 
sponsored 
or similar (2)
Prime 
Non-
conforming
Sub-prime 
MBS 
covered 
bond 
CMBS (3)
CDOs (4)
CLOs (5)
ABS 
covered 
bonds 
ABS 
other 
Total 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
AAA
4,169 
3,599 
1,488 
105 
2,595 
647 
135 
2,171 
625 
1,622 
17,156 
AA to AA+
29,252 
669 
106 
60 
379 
710 
35 
1,533 
321 
550 
33,615 
A to AA-
131 
506 
110 
104 
2,567 
1,230 
161 
697 
100 
725 
6,331 
BBB- to A-
39 
288 
93 
1,979 
333 
86 
341 
1,321 
4,480 
Non-investment grade
21 
784 
658 
396 
415 
1,370 
176 
672 
4,492 
Unrated
148 
29 
146 
56 
170 
423 
263 
1,235 
                       
 
33,573 
5,745 
2,679 
904 
7,520 
3,391 
1,957 
5,341 
1,046 
5,153 
67,309 
                       
Of which in Non-Core
837 
477 
308 
830 
1,656 
4,227 
1,861 
10,196 
                       
30 September 2011
                     
                       
AAA
4,391 
4,152 
1,509 
144 
3,462 
893 
194 
2,198 
651 
1,177 
18,771 
AA to AA+
31,037 
117 
111 
97 
1,162 
839 
125 
1,496 
407 
563 
35,954 
A to AA-
137 
603 
124 
175 
1,680 
1,326 
166 
569 
367 
523 
5,670 
BBB- to A-
147 
295 
59 
1,553 
383 
92 
601 
1,301 
4,431 
Non-investment grade
768 
676 
486 
327 
1,516 
170 
676 
4,619 
Unrated
146 
47 
213 
67 
134 
331 
279 
1,217 
                       
 
35,565 
5,933 
2,762 
1,174 
7,857 
3,835 
2,227 
5,365 
1,425 
4,519 
70,662 
                       
Of which in Non-Core
269 
463 
276 
1,158 
1,953 
4,698 
1,976 
10,793 

For the notes to this table refer to page 166.
 
 
165

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Asset-backed securities (continued)

 
RMBS (1)
             
 
Government
sponsored
or similar (2)
Prime 
Non- 
conforming 
Sub-prime 
MBS 
covered 
bond 
CMBS (3)
CDOs (4)
CLOs (5)
ABS 
covered 
bonds 
ABS 
other 
Total 
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
AAA
28,835 
4,355 
1,754 
317 
7,107 
2,789 
444 
2,490 
989 
2,155 
51,235 
AA to AA+
1,529 
147 
144 
116 
357 
392 
567 
1,786 
681 
616 
6,335 
A to AA-
67 
60 
212 
408 
973 
296 
343 
190 
695 
3,244 
BBB- to A-
82 
316 
39 
500 
203 
527 
1,718 
3,385 
Non-investment grade
900 
809 
458 
296 
1,863 
332 
265 
4,923 
Unrated
196 
52 
76 
85 
596 
698 
1,703 
                       
 
30,364 
5,747 
3,135 
1,218 
7,872 
4,950 
3,458 
6,074 
1,860 
6,141 
70,825 
                       
Of which in Non-Core
81 
336 
379 
1,278 
3,159 
5,094 
2,386 
12,713 
Notes:
(1)
Residential mortgage-backed securities.
(2)
Includes US agency and Dutch government guaranteed securities.
(3)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities.
(4)
Collateralised debt obligations.
(5)
Collateralised loan obligations.

For analyses of ABS by geography and measurement classification, refer to Appendix 2.

Key points
·
Carrying value of total ABS decreased by £3.5 billion during 2011. US government sponsored RMBS of £3.6 billion, reflecting a move towards G10 government generally, partially off-set by decrease in European exposure. There were reductions across all other portfolios.
   
·
The decrease in AAA rated debt securities mainly relates to the downgrading of US government and agencies to AA+ by S&P during the year.
   
·
CDOs and CLOs decreased by £2.2 billion principally reflecting asset reductions in Non-Core.
   
·
The decrease in CMBS of £1.6 billion, primarily reflecting restructuring of monoline exposures.
   
·
The average mark on total ABS was 83%, broadly the same as 2010 and 2009.

 
166

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives
The Group’s derivative assets by internal grading scale and residual maturity are analysed below. Master netting arrangements in respect of mark-to-market (mtm) positions and collateral shown below do not result in a net presentation in the Group’s balance sheet under IFRS.
 
    31 December 2011    
Asset
quality
 
Probability
of default range
 
0-3
months
£m
3-6
months
£m
6-12
months
£m
1-5
years
£m
Over 5
years
£m
Total
£m
30 September
2011
Total
£m
31 December
2010
Total
£m
AQ1
0% - 0.034%
24,580 
10,957 
17,178 
126,107 
302,800 
481,622 
517,097 
408,489 
AQ2
0.034% - 0.048%
326 
236 
431 
2,046 
5,138 
8,177 
7,265 
2,659 
AQ3
0.048% - 0.095%
975 
390 
459 
2,811 
6,184 
10,819 
14,523 
3,317 
AQ4
0.095% - 0.381%
1,465 
782 
713 
4,093 
7,368 
14,421 
10,405 
3,391 
AQ5
0.381% - 1.076%
890 
93 
219 
1,787 
3,527 
6,516 
13,709 
4,860 
AQ6
1.076% - 2.153%
121 
30 
81 
803 
1,186 
2,221 
2,471 
1,070 
AQ7
2.153% - 6.089%
101 
29 
56 
1,674 
533 
2,393 
3,368 
857 
AQ8
6.089% - 17.222%
16 
21 
11 
143 
1,061 
1,252 
1,174 
403 
AQ9
17.222% - 100%
254 
876 
1,150 
1,140 
450 
AQ10
100%
13 
20 
35 
658 
321 
1,047 
1,192 
1,581 
                   
   
28,492 
12,566 
19,190 
140,376 
328,994 
529,618 
572,344 
427,077 
Counterparty mtm netting
         
(441,626)
(473,256)
(330,397)
Cash collateral held against derivative exposures
     
(37,222)
(38,202)
(31,096)
               
Net exposure
       
50,770 
60,886 
65,584 

At 31 December 2011, the Group also held collateral in the form of securities of £5.3 billion (30 September 2011 - £5.5 billion; 31 December 2010 - £2.9 billion) against derivative positions.

The table below analyses the fair value of the Group’s derivatives by type of contract.

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Notional 
Assets 
Liabilities 
 
Notional 
Assets 
Liabilities 
 
Notional 
Assets 
Liabilities 
Contract type
£bn 
£m 
£m 
 
£bn 
£m 
£m 
 
£bn 
£m 
£m 
                       
Interest rate
38,722 
422,156 
406,709 
 
42,732 
424,130 
407,814 
 
39,760 
311,731 
299,209 
Exchange rate
4,479 
74,492 
80,980 
 
5,329 
107,024 
112,184 
 
4,854 
83,253 
89,375 
Credit
  derivatives
1,054 
26,836 
26,743 
 
1,343 
33,884 
31,574 
 
1,357 
26,872 
25,344 
Equity and
  commodity
123 
6,134 
9,551 
 
120 
7,306 
10,218 
 
179 
5,221 
10,039 
                       
   
529,618 
523,983 
   
572,344 
561,790 
   
427,077 
423,967 

 
167

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives (continued)

Key points

31 December 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
Net exposure declined by 23%, despite an increase in derivative carrying values, primarily due to the increased use of netting arrangements.
   
·
Interest rate contracts increased due to continued reductions in interest rate yields and the depreciation of sterling against the US dollar. This was partially offset by the appreciation of sterling against the euro.
   
·
Exchange rate contracts decreased due to a reduction in trade volumes and the appreciation of sterling against the euro. This was partially offset by the depreciation of sterling against the US dollar.
   
·
Credit derivatives remained flat as the increase from the widening of credit spreads and the depreciation of sterling against the US dollar was offset by a reduction in trade volume.

31 December 2011 compared with 30 September 2011
·
Net exposure, after taking account of position and collateral netting arrangements, decreased by 17% due to lower derivative fair values, primarily driven by market movements.
   
·
Interest rate contract fair values remained flat reflecting the combined effect of exchange rate movements and movements in indices.
   
·
Exchange rate contracts decreased due to a reduction in trade volumes and exchange rate volatilities. The appreciation of sterling against the euro was partially offset by the depreciation of sterling against the US dollar.
   
·
Credit derivative fair values decreased due to a tightening of credit spreads, partially offset by the depreciation of sterling against the US dollar.

 
168

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives (continued)
The Group’s exposures to monolines and credit derivative product companies (CDPCs) by credit rating are summarised below: ratings are based on the lower of S&P and Moody’s. All of these exposures are held within Non-Core.

Exposures to monoline insurers

 
Notional: 
 protected 
 assets 
Fair value: 
reference 
 protected 
assets 
Gross 
 exposure 
Credit 
valuation 
adjustment 
(CVA)
Hedges 
Net 
 exposure 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
31 December 2011
           
A to AA-
4,939 
4,243 
696 
252 
444 
Non-investment grade
3,623 
2,431 
1,192 
946 
71 
175 
             
 
8,562 
6,674 
1,888 
1,198 
71 
619 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
946 
674 
272 
247 
   
CDOs
500 
57 
443 
351 
   
CLOs
4,616 
4,166 
450 
177 
   
Other ABS
1,998 
1,455 
543 
334 
   
Other
502 
322 
180 
89 
   
             
 
8,562 
6,674 
1,888 
1,198 
   
             
30 September 2011
           
A to AA-
5,411 
4,735 
676 
259 
417 
Non-investment grade
7,098 
3,684 
3,414 
2,568 
70 
776 
             
 
12,509 
8,419 
4,090 
2,827 
70 
1,193 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
3,954 
1,879 
2,075 
1,599 
   
CDOs
988 
156 
832 
619 
   
CLOs
4,806 
4,348 
458 
183 
   
Other ABS
2,275 
1,758 
517 
309 
   
Other
486 
278 
208 
117 
   
             
 
12,509 
8,419 
4,090 
2,827 
   
             
31 December 2010
           
A to AA-
6,336 
5,503 
833 
272 
561 
Non-investment grade
8,555 
5,365 
3,190 
2,171 
71 
948 
             
 
14,891 
10,868 
4,023 
2,443 
71 
1,509 
             
Of which:
           
CMBS
4,149 
2,424 
1,725 
1,253 
   
CDOs
1,133 
256 
877 
593 
   
CLOs
6,724 
6,121 
603 
210 
   
Other ABS
2,393 
1,779 
614 
294 
   
Other
492 
288 
204 
93 
   
             
 
14,891 
10,868 
4,023 
2,443 
   

 
169

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Derivatives: Exposures to monoline insurers (continued)

Key points

31 December 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
The exposure to monolines declined, primarily due to the restructuring of some exposures, partially offset by lower prices of underlying reference instruments.
   
·
The CVA decreased in line with the reduction in exposure partially offset by the impact of wider credit spreads.

31 December 2011 compared with 30 September 2011
·
The exposure to monolines declined, primarily due to the restructuring of some exposures. The CVA decreased in line with the reduction in exposure.

Exposure to CDPCs
 
Notional: 
protected 
 assets 
Fair value: 
reference 
protected 
assets 
Gross 
exposure 
Credit 
valuation 
adjustment 
Net 
exposure 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
           
31 December 2011
         
AAA
213 
212 
A to AA-
646 
632 
14 
11 
Non-investment grade
19,671 
18,151 
1,520 
788 
732 
Unrated
3,974 
3,613 
361 
243 
118 
           
 
24,504 
22,608 
1,896 
1,034 
862 
           
30 September 2011
         
AAA
211 
209 
A to AA-
640 
614 
26 
15 
11 
Non-investment grade
19,294 
17,507 
1,787 
902 
885 
Unrated
3,985 
3,552 
433 
316 
117 
           
 
24,130 
21,882 
2,248 
1,233 
1,015 
           
31 December 2010
         
AAA
213 
212 
A to AA-
644 
629 
15 
11 
Non-investment grade
20,066 
19,050 
1,016 
401 
615 
Unrated
4,165 
3,953 
212 
85 
127 
           
 
25,088 
23,844 
1,244 
490 
754 

Key points

31 December 2011 compared with 31 December 2010
·
The exposure to CDPCs increased, primarily driven by wider credit spreads of the underlying reference loans and bonds.
·
The CVA increased in line with the increase in exposure.

31 December 2011 compared with 30 September 2011
·
The exposure to CDPCs decreased over the period, primarily driven by tighter credit spreads of the underlying reference loans and bonds, together with a decrease in the relative value of senior tranches, compared with the underlying reference portfolios.
·
The CVA decreased in line with the decrease in exposure.
 
 
170

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate

The commercial real estate lending portfolio totalled £74.8 billion at 31 December 2011, a 14% year-on-year decrease (31 December 2010 - £87.4 billion). The commercial real estate sector comprises exposure to entities involved in the development of or investment in commercial and residential properties (including homebuilders). The analysis below excludes rate risk management and contingent obligations.

 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
 
Investment 
Development 
Total 
By division
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
               
Core
             
UK Corporate
25,101 
5,023 
30,124 
 
24,879 
5,819 
30,698 
Ulster Bank
3,882 
881 
4,763 
 
4,284 
1,090 
5,374 
US Retail &
  Commercial
4,235 
70 
4,305 
 
4,322 
93 
4,415 
Global Banking &
  Markets
1,013 
360 
1,373 
 
1,131 
644 
1,775 
               
 
34,231 
6,334 
40,565 
 
34,616 
7,646 
42,262 
               
Non-Core
             
UK Corporate
3,957 
2,020 
5,977 
 
7,591 
3,263 
10,854 
Ulster Bank
3,860 
8,490 
12,350 
 
3,854 
8,760 
12,614 
US Retail &
  Commercial
901 
28 
929 
 
1,325 
70 
1,395 
Global Banking &
  Markets
14,689 
336 
15,025 
 
19,906 
379 
20,285 
               
 
23,407 
10,874 
34,281 
 
32,676 
12,472 
45,148 
               
Total
57,638 
17,208 
74,846 
 
67,292 
20,118 
87,410 


 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
Total 
By geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
31 December 2011
           
UK (excluding NI) (1)
28,653 
6,359 
 
1,198 
6,511 
42,721 
Ireland (ROI & NI) (1)
5,146 
1,132 
 
2,591 
6,317 
15,186 
Western Europe
7,649 
1,048 
 
52 
8,758 
US
5,552 
1,279 
 
59 
46 
6,936 
RoW
785 
35 
 
141 
284 
1,245 
             
 
47,785 
9,853 
 
3,998 
13,210 
74,846 
             
31 December 2010
           
UK (excluding NI) (1)
32,334 
7,255 
 
1,520 
8,288 
49,397 
Ireland (ROI & NI) (1)
5,056 
1,148 
 
2,785 
6,578 
15,567 
Western Europe
10,568 
643 
 
25 
42 
11,278 
US
7,345 
1,296 
 
69 
175 
8,885 
RoW
1,622 
25 
 
138 
498 
2,283 
             
 
56,925 
10,367 
 
4,537 
15,581 
87,410 

Note:
(1)
ROI: Republic of Ireland; NI: Northern Ireland.

 
171

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

 
Investment
 
Development
 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
By geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
             
31 December 2011
           
UK (excluding NI)
25,904 
9,108 
 
5,118 
2,591 
42,721 
Ireland (ROI & NI)
3,157 
3,121 
 
793 
8,115 
15,186 
Western Europe
422 
8,275 
 
20 
41 
8,758 
US
4,521 
2,310 
 
71 
34 
6,936 
RoW
227 
593 
 
332 
93 
1,245 
             
 
34,231 
23,407 
 
6,334 
10,874 
74,846 
             
31 December 2010
           
UK (excluding NI)
26,168 
13,421 
 
5,997 
3,811 
49,397 
Ireland (ROI & NI)
3,159 
3,044 
 
963 
8,401 
15,567 
Western Europe
409 
10,802 
 
25 
42 
11,278 
US
4,636 
4,005 
 
173 
71 
8,885 
RoW
244 
1,404 
 
488 
147 
2,283 
             
 
34,616 
32,676 
 
7,646 
12,472 
87,410 


By sub-sector
UK 
(excl NI)
£m 
Ireland 
(ROI & NI)
£m 
Western 
Europe 
£m 
US 
£m 
RoW 
£m 
Total 
£m 
             
31 December 2011
           
Residential
12,871 
7,449 
1,096 
1,325 
319 
23,060 
Office
7,155 
1,354 
2,248 
404 
352 
11,513 
Retail
8,709 
1,641 
1,893 
285 
275 
12,803 
Industrial
4,317 
507 
520 
24 
105 
5,473 
Mixed/other
9,669 
4,235 
3,001 
4,898 
194 
21,997 
             
 
42,721 
15,186 
8,758 
6,936 
1,245 
74,846 
             
31 December 2010
 
             
Residential
15,543 
7,726 
685 
1,471 
523 
25,948 
Office
8,539 
1,178 
2,878 
663 
891 
14,149 
Retail
10,607 
1,668 
1,888 
1,025 
479 
15,667 
Industrial
4,912 
515 
711 
80 
106 
6,324 
Mixed/other
9,796 
4,480 
5,116 
5,646 
284 
25,322 
             
 
49,397 
15,567 
11,278 
8,885 
2,283 
87,410 

Note:
(1)
Excludes commercial real estate lending in Wealth as these loans are generally supported by personal guarantees in addition to collateral. This portfolio, which totalled £1.3 billion at 31 December 2011 continues to perform in line with expectations and requires minimal provision.

 
172

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

Key points
·
In line with the Group’s strategy, exposure to commercial real estate was reduced during 2011, affecting mainly the UK and Western Europe given that these regions account for the majority of the portfolio. Overall this portfolio decreased circa 25% in the two years to 31 December 2011.
   
·
Most of the decrease is in Non-Core due to run-off and asset sales. The Non-Core portfolio totalled £34.3 billion (46% of the portfolio) at 31 December 2011 (31 December 2010 - £45.1 billion, or 52% of the portfolio) and includes exposures in Ulster Bank as discussed on page 185.
   
·
With the exception of exposure in Spain and in Ireland, the Group has minimal commercial real estate exposure to other eurozone periphery countries. Exposure in Spain is predominantly in the Non-Core portfolio and totals £2.3 billion, of which 36% is in AQ1-AQ9. The remainder of the Spanish portfolio has already been subject to material write-off and provision levels have been assessed based on re-appraised values. There are significant differences in values based on geographic location and asset type.
   
·
The UK portfolio is focused on London and the South East (44%), with the remainder well spread across the UK regions.
   
·
Short-term lending to property developers without sufficient pre-let revenue at origination to support investment financing after practical completion is classified as speculative. Speculative lending at origination represents approximately 1% of the portfolio. The Group’s appetite for originating speculative commercial real estate lending is very limited and any such business requires senior management approval.
   
·
The commercial real estate market is expected to remain challenging in key markets and new business will be accommodated from run-off of existing Core exposure. As liquidity in the market remains tight, the Group is focusing on re-financings and supporting its existing client base.

 
173

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)
 
Maturity profile of portfolio
UK Corporate
£m
Ulster Bank
£m
US Retail &
 Commercial
£m
Global Banking & Markets
£m
Total
£m
31 December 2011
         
Core
         
< 1 year (1)
8,268 
3,030 
1,056 
142 
12,496 
1-2 years 
5,187 
391 
638 
278 
6,494 
2-3 years
3,587 
117 
765 
363 
4,832 
> 3 years
10,871 
1,225 
1,846 
590 
14,532 
Not classified (2)
2,211 
2,211 
           
Total
30,124 
4,763 
4,305 
1,373 
40,565 
           
Non-Core
         
< 1 year (1)
3,224 
11,089 
293 
7,093 
21,699 
1-2 years
508 
692 
163 
3,064 
4,427 
2-3 years
312 
177 
152 
1,738 
2,379 
> 3 years
1,636 
392 
321 
3,126 
5,475 
Not classified (2)
297 
301 
           
Total
5,977 
12,350 
929 
15,025 
34,281 

           
           
31 December 2010
         
Core
         
< 1 year (1)
7,563 
2,719 
1,303 
890 
12,475 
1-2 years
5,154 
829 
766 
247 
6,996 
2-3 years
4,698 
541 
751 
221 
6,211 
> 3 years
10,361 
1,285 
1,595 
417 
13,658 
Not classified (2)
2,922 
2,922 
           
Total
30,698 
5,374 
4,415 
1,775 
42,262 
           
Non-Core
         
< 1 year (1)
4,829 
10,809 
501 
3,887 
20,026 
1-2 years
1,727 
983 
109 
6,178 
8,997 
2-3 years
831 
128 
218 
3,967 
5,144 
> 3 years
2,904 
694 
567 
6,253 
10,418 
Not classified (2)
563 
563 
           
Total
10,854 
12,614 
1,395 
20,285 
45,148 

Notes:
(1)
Includes on demand and past due assets.
(2)
Predominantly comprises multi-option facilities for which there is no single maturity date.

Key point
·
The majority of Ulster Bank’s commercial real estate portfolio is categorised as < 1 year including on demand assets, owing to the high level of non-performing assets in the portfolio. Ulster Bank places most restructured facilities on demand rather than extending the maturity date.

 
174

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

Breakdown of portfolio by AQ band

31 December 2011
AQ1-AQ2 
£m 
AQ3-AQ4 
£m 
AQ5-AQ6 
£m 
AQ7-AQ8 
£m 
AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
£m 
Total 
£m 
               
Core
1,094 
6,714 
19,054 
6,254 
3,111 
4,338 
40,565 
Non-Core
680 
1,287 
5,951 
3,893 
2,385 
20,085 
34,281 
               
Total
1,774 
8,001 
25,005 
10,147 
5,496 
24,423 
74,846 
               
31 December 2010
             
               
Core
1,055 
7,087 
20,588 
7,829 
2,171 
3,532 
42,262 
Non-Core
1,003 
2,694 
11,249 
7,608 
4,105 
18,489 
45,148 
               
Total
2,058 
9,781 
31,837 
15,437 
6,276 
22,021 
87,410 

Key points
·
Approximately 13% of the commercial real estate exposure is within the AQ1-AQ4 bands. This includes unsecured lending to property companies and real estate investment trusts. The high proportion of the exposure in the AQ10 band is driven by Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) and GBM (Non-Core).
   
·
Of the total portfolio of £74.8 billion at 31 December 2011, £34.7 billion (2010 - £45.1 billion) is managed within the Group’s standard credit processes and £5.9 billion (2010 - £9.2 billion) is receiving varying degrees of heightened credit management under the Group Watchlist process (this includes all Watchlist Amber cases and Watchlist Red cases managed outside the Global Restructuring Group (GRG)). A further £34.3 billion (2010 - £33.1 billion) is managed within the GRG and includes both Watchlist and non-performing exposures. The increase in the portfolio managed by the GRG is driven by Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core).

 
175

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

Breakdown of portfolio by AQ band (continued)
The table below analyses commercial real estate lending by loan-to-value (LTV). Due to market conditions in Ireland and to a lesser extent in the UK, there is a shortage of market based data. In the absence of external valuations, the Group deploys a range of alternative approaches including internal expert judgement and indexation.

 
Ulster Bank
 
Rest of the Group
 
Group
LTVs at 31 December 2011
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
£m 
 
AQ1-AQ9 
£m 
AQ10 
 £m 
                 
<= 50%
81 
28 
 
7,091 
332 
 
7,172 
360 
> 50% and <= 70%
642 
121 
 
14,105 
984 
 
14,747 
1,105 
> 70% and <= 90%
788 
293 
 
10,042 
1,191 
 
10,830 
1,484 
> 90% and <= 100%
541 
483 
 
2,616 
1,679 
 
3,157 
2,162 
> 100% and <= 110%
261 
322 
 
1,524 
1,928 
 
1,785 
2,250 
> 110% and <= 130%
893 
1,143 
 
698 
1,039 
 
1,591 
2,182 
> 130%
1,468 
10,004 
 
672 
2,994 
 
2,140 
12,998 
                 
Total with LTVs
4,674 
12,394 
 
36,748 
10,147 
 
41,422 
22,541 
Other (1)
38 
 
8,994 
1,844 
 
9,001 
1,882 
                 
Total
4,681 
12,432 
 
45,742 
11,991 
 
50,423 
24,423 
                 
Total portfolio average LTV (2)
140% 
259% 
 
69% 
129% 
 
77% 
201% 

Notes:
(1)
Other performing loans of £9.0 billion include unsecured lending to commercial real estate clients, such as major UK homebuilders. The credit quality of these exposures is consistent with that of the performing portfolio overall. Other non-performing loans of £1.9 billion are subject to the Group’s standard provisioning policies.
(2)
Weighted average by exposure.

Key points
·
Nearly 85% of the commercial real estate portfolio with LTV > 100% is within Ulster Bank (Core and Non-Core) and GBM (Non-Core). A majority of these portfolios are managed within the GRG and are subject to monthly reviews. Significant levels of provisions have been taken against these portfolios; provisions as a percentage of risk elements in lending for the Ulster Bank commercial real estate portfolio were 53% at 31 December 2011 (31 December 2010 - 44%). The reported LTV levels are based on gross loan values. The weighted average LTV for AQ10 excluding Ulster Bank is 129%.
   
·
The average interest coverage (ICR) ratios for UK Corporate (Core and Non-Core) and GBM (Non-Core) investment properties are 2.37x and 1.25x respectively. The US Retail & Commercial portfolio is managed on the basis of debt service coverage, which includes scheduled principal amortisation. The average debt service interest coverage for this portfolio on this basis was 1.24x at 31 December 2011. There are a number of different approaches used within the Group and across the industry to calculate ICR ratios for different portfolio types, and organisations may not therefore be comparable.

 
176

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Commercial real estate (continued)

Retail assets
The Group’s retail lending portfolio includes mortgages, credit cards, unsecured loans, auto finance and overdrafts. The majority of personal lending exposures are in the UK, Ireland and the US. The analysis below includes both Core and Non-Core balances.
 
31 December 
 2011 
31 December 
 2010 
Personal credit loans and receivables
£m 
£m 
     
UK Retail
   
  - mortgages
96,388 
92,592 
  - cards, loans and overdrafts
16,004 
18,072 
Ulster Bank
   
  - mortgages
20,020 
21,162 
  - other personal
1,533 
1,017 
Citizens
   
  - mortgages
23,829 
24,575 
  - auto and cards
5,731 
6,062 
  - other (1)
2,111 
3,455 
Other (2)
17,545 
18,123 
     
 
183,161 
185,058 

Notes:
(1)
Mainly student loans and loans secured by recreational vehicles or marine vessels.
(2)
Personal exposures in other divisions.

Residential mortgages
The tables below detail the distribution of residential mortgages by indexed LTV. LTV averages are calculated by transaction volume and transaction value. Refer to the section on Ulster Bank Group on page 184 for analysis of Ulster Bank residential mortgages.

 
UK Retail
 
Citizens
LTV distribution calculated on a volume basis
2011 
2010 
 
2011 
2010 
           
<= 70%
62.1 
61.6 
 
43.5 
43.4 
> 70% and <= 90%
27.1 
26.2 
 
26.9 
27.6 
> 90% and <= 110%
9.4 
10.4 
 
16.7 
17.2 
> 110% and <= 130%
1.4 
1.7 
 
6.9 
6.0 
> 130%
0.1 
 
6.0 
5.8 
           
Total portfolio average LTV at 31 December
57.8 
58.2 
 
73.8 
75.3 
           
Average LTV on new originations during the year
58.4 
64.2 
 
63.8 
64.8 

LTV distribution calculated on a value basis
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
<= 70%
47,811 
44,522 
 
9,669 
10,375 
> 70% and <= 90%
34,410 
32,299 
 
7,011 
7,196 
> 90% and <= 110%
11,800 
12,660 
 
3,947 
4,080 
> 110% and <= 130% 
1,713 
1,924 
 
1,580 
1,488 
> 130%
74 
73 
 
1,263 
1,252 
           
Total portfolio average LTV at 31 December
67.2% 
68.1% 
 
75.9% 
75.4% 
           
Average LTV on new originations during the year
63.0% 
68.0% 
 
65.8% 
65.3% 
 
 
177

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Residential mortgages (continued)
The table below details residential mortgages which are three months or more in arrears (by volume).

 
31 December 
 2011 
31 December 
 2010 
Residential mortgages which are three months or more in arrears (by volume)
     
UK Retail (1)
1.6 
1.7 
Citizens
2.0 
1.4 

Note:
(1)
The ‘One Account’ current account mortgage is excluded (£5.4 billion - 5.6% of assets) at 31 December 2011, 0.9% of these accounts were 90 days continually in excess of the limit (31 December 2010 - 0.8%). Consistent with the way the Council of Mortgage Lenders publishes member arrears information, the 3+ months arrears rate now excludes accounts in repossession and cases with shortfalls post property sale.

UK Retail
Key points
·
The UK Retail mortgage portfolio totalled £96.4 billion (98.6% in Core) at 31 December 2011, an increase of 4.1% from 2010, due to continued strong sales growth and lower redemption rates from before the financial crisis.
   
·
Of the total portfolio, 98.6% is designated as Core business, primarily comprising mortgages branded the Royal Bank of Scotland, NatWest, the One Account and First Active. Non-Core comprises Direct Line Mortgages.
   
·
The assets are prime mortgages and include 7.2% (£6.9 billion) of exposure to residential buy-to-let. There is a small legacy self-certification book (0.3% of total assets). Self-certified mortgages were withdrawn from sale in 2004.
   
·
Gross new mortgage lending in 2011 remained strong at £14.7 billion. The average LTV for new business during 2011 declined in comparison to 2010 and the maximum LTV available to new customers remained at 90%. Based on the Halifax House Price index at September 2011, the book average indexed LTV improved marginally when compared to December 2010, with the proportion of balances with an LTV over 100% also lower. Refer to the table on page 177, which details LTV information on a volume and value basis.
   
·
The arrears rate (more than three payments in arrears, excluding repossessions and shortfalls post property sale) has remained broadly stable since late 2009 at 1.6%.
   
·
The number of properties repossessed in 2011 was 1,671, up from 1,392 in 2010.
   
·
The mortgage impairment charge was £187 million for 2011, an increase of 2% from 2010. A significant part of the mortgage impairment charge related to reduced expectations of cash recovery on already defaulted debt. It also included an additional provision charge for mortgage customers who received forbearance.
   
·
Default and arrears rates remain sensitive to economic developments and are currently supported by the low interest rate environment and strong book growth, with recent business yet to fully mature.

 
178

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Residential mortgages (continued)

Citizens
Key points
·
Citizens’ residential mortgage portfolio totalled £23.8 billion at 31 December 2011, a reduction of 3% from 2010 (£24.6 billion).
   
·
The mortgage portfolio comprises £6.4 billion of residential mortgages (99% in first lien position: Core - £5.8 billion; Non-Core - £0.6 billion) and £17.4 billion of home equity loans and lines (41% in first lien position: Core - £14.9 billion; Non-Core - £2.5 billion). Home equity Core consists of 47% in first lien position.
   
·
Citizens continues to focus on the ‘footprint’ states of New England, Mid Atlantic and Mid West, targeting low risk products and maintaining conservative risk policies. At 31 December 2011, the portfolio consisted of £19.5 billion (82% of the total portfolio) within footprint.
   
·
Loan acceptance criteria were tightened during 2009 to address deteriorating economic and market conditions.
   
·
Non-Core comprises 13% of the residential mortgage portfolio. Its largest component (74%) is the serviced by others (SBO) home equity portfolio. The SBO portfolio consists of purchased pools of home equity loans and lines, which resulted in an annualised charge-off rate of 8.7% in 2011. It is characterised by out-of-footprint geographies, high second lien concentration (95%) and high average LTV (113% at 31 December 2011). The SBO book has been closed to new purchases since the third quarter of 2007 and is in run-off, with exposure down from £2.8 billion at 31 December 2010, to £2.3 billion at 31 December 2011. The arrears rate of the SBO portfolio decreased from 3.0% at 31 December 2010, to 2.3% at 31 December 2011, as the legacy of poorer assets receded, and account servicing and collections became more effective following a servicer conversion in 2009.

Personal lending
The Group’s personal lending portfolio includes credit cards, unsecured loans, auto finance and overdrafts. The majority of personal lending exposures exist in the UK and the US. Impairments as a proportion of average loans and receivables are shown in the following table.

 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Average 
loans and 
receivables 
Impairment 
charge as a % 
of average 
loans and 
receivables 
 
Average 
loans and 
receivables 
Impairment 
charge as a % 
of average 
loans and 
receivables 
Personal lending
£m 
 
£m 
           
UK Retail cards (1)
5,675 
3.0 
 
6,025 
5.0 
UK Retail loans (1)
7,755 
2.8 
 
9,863 
4.8 
           
Citizens cards (2)
936 
5.1 
 
1,005 
9.9 
Citizens auto loans (2)
4,856 
0.2 
 
5,256 
0.6 

Notes:
(1)
The ratio for UK Retail assets refers to the impairment charges for the year. This is the Core UK loans book and excludes the Non-Core direct loans book that was sold in late 2011.
(2)
The ratio for Citizens refers to the impairment charges in the year, net of recoveries realised in the year.
 
 
179

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Personal lending (continued)

UK Retail
Key points
·
The UK personal lending portfolio, of which 99.4% is in Core businesses, comprises credit cards, unsecured loans and overdrafts, and totalled £16.0 billion at 31 December 2011 (31 December 2010 - £18.1 billion).
   
·
The decrease in portfolio size of 11.4% was driven by continued subdued loan recruitment activity and a continuing general market trend of customers repaying unsecured debt.
   
·
The Non-Core portfolio consists of the direct finance loan portfolios (Direct Line, Lombard, Mint and Churchill) and totalled £0.1 billion at 31 December 2011 (2010 - £0.4 billion). In the last quarter of 2011, a portfolio of £170 million of balances was disposed of.
   
·
Risk appetite continues to be actively managed across all products with investment in collection and recovery processes continuing, addressing both continued support for the Group’s customers and the management of impairments.
   
·
Support continues for customers experiencing financial difficulties through ‘breathing space initiatives’. Refer to the disclosures on forbearance on page 161 for more information.
   
·
The impairment charge on unsecured lending was £579 million for the year, down 42% on 2010, reflecting the effect of risk appetite tightening. The sale of the direct finance loan book gave rise to a one-off benefit of approximately £30 million.
   
·
Impairments remain sensitive to the external environment, including unemployment levels and interest rates.
   
·
Industry benchmarks for cards arrears remain stable, with the Group continuing to perform favourably.

Citizens
Key points
·
Citizens’ average credit card portfolio totalled £936 million during 2011, with Core assets comprising 90.2% of the portfolio. Citizens’ cards business has traditionally adopted conservative risk strategies compared with the US market and given the economic climate, has introduced tighter lending criteria and lower credit limits. These actions have led to improving new business quality and a business performing better than industry benchmarks (provided by VISA). The latest available metrics show the 60+ days delinquency as a percentage of total outstandings at 2.15% at November 2011 (compared to an industry figure of 2.45%) and net contractual charge-offs as a percentage of total outstandings at 2.89% at November 2011 (compared to an industry figure of 3.69%).
   
·
Citizens’ average auto loan portfolio totalled £4.9 billion during 2011, of which 98% is considered Core. £101 million (2%) is Non-Core and anticipated to run off by 2013. Citizens’ vehicle financing business lends to US consumers through a network of 4,200 auto dealers in 25 US states. Citizens’ credit policy is considered conservative, targeting prime customers and has historically experienced credit losses below those of industry peers. 
   
·
The net write-off rate on the total auto portfolio fell to 0.18% at 31 December 2011, from 0.34% in 2010. The 30+ days past due delinquency rate fell to 1.04% at 31 December 2011, from 1.57% in 2010.

 
180

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core)

Overview
At 31 December 2011, Ulster Bank Group accounted for 10% of the Group’s total gross customer loans (31 December 2010 - 10%) and 9% of the Group’s Core gross customer loans (31 December 2010 - 9%). Ulster Bank’s financial performance continues to be overshadowed by the challenging economic climate in Ireland, with impairments remaining elevated as high unemployment, coupled with higher taxation and limited liquidity in the economy, continues to depress the property market and domestic spending. 

The impairment charge of £3,717 million for the year (31 December 2010 - £3,843 million) was driven by a combination of new defaulting customers and deteriorating security values. Provisions as a percentage of risk elements in lending increased from 44% at 31 December 2010 to 53% at 31 December 2011, predominantly as a result of the deterioration in the value of the Non-Core commercial real estate development portfolio.

Core
The impairment charge for the year of £1,384 million (31 December 2010 - £1,161 million) reflects the difficult economic climate in Ireland, with elevated default levels across both mortgage and other corporate portfolios. The mortgage sector accounted for £570 million (41%) of the total 2011 impairment charge.

Non-Core
The impairment charge for the year was £2,333 million (31 December 2010 - £2,682 million), with the commercial real estate sector accounting for £2,160 million (93%) of the total 2011 charge.

 
181

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Loans, risk elements in lending (REIL) and impairments by sector

 
Gross 
 loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 REIL 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 gross loans 
 
 
Impairment 
charge 
 
Amounts 
 written-off 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Mortgages
20,020 
2,184 
945 
10.9 
43 
4.7 
570 
11 
Personal unsecured
1,533 
201 
184 
13.1 
92 
12.0 
56 
25 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,882 
1,014 
413 
26.1 
41 
10.6 
225 
  - development
881 
290 
145 
32.9 
50 
16.5 
99 
16 
Other corporate
7,736 
1,834 
1,062 
23.7 
58 
13.7 
434 
72 
                 
 
34,052 
5,523 
2,749 
16.2 
50 
8.1 
1,384 
124 
                 
Non-Core
               
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,860 
2,916 
1,364 
75.5 
47 
35.3 
609 
  - development
8,490 
7,536 
4,295 
88.8 
57 
50.6 
1,551 
32 
Other corporate
1,630 
1,159 
642 
71.1 
55 
39.4 
173 
16 
                 
 
13,980 
11,611 
6,301 
83.1 
54 
45.1 
2,333 
49 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
20,020 
2,184 
945 
10.9 
43 
4.7 
570 
11 
Personal unsecured
1,533 
201 
184 
13.1 
92 
12.0 
56 
25 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
7,742 
3,930 
1,777 
50.8 
45 
23.0 
834 
  - development
9,371 
7,826 
4,440 
83.5 
57 
47.4 
1,650 
48 
Other corporate
9,366 
2,993 
1,704 
32.0 
57 
18.2 
607 
88 
                 
 
48,032 
17,134 
9,050 
35.7 
53 
18.8 
3,717 
173 

 
182

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector (continued)

 
Gross 
 loans 
REIL 
Provisions 
REIL 
as a % of 
gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 REIL 
Provisions 
 as a % of 
 gross loans 
 
Impairment 
charge 
 
Amounts 
 written-off 
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Mortgages
21,162 
1,566 
439 
7.4 
28 
2.1 
294 
Personal unsecured
1,282 
185 
158 
14.4 
85 
12.3 
48 
30 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
4,284 
598 
332 
14.0 
56 
7.7 
259 
  - development
1,090 
65 
37 
6.0 
57 
3.4 
116 
Other corporate
9,039 
1,205 
667 
13.3 
55 
7.4 
444 
11 
                 
 
36,857 
3,619 
 1,633 
9.8 
45 
4.4 
1,161 
48 
                 
Non-Core
               
Mortgages
42 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
3,854 
2,391 
1,000 
62.0 
42 
25.9 
630 
  - development
8,760 
6,341 
2,783 
72.4 
44 
31.8 
1,759 
Other corporate
1,970 
 1,310 
561 
66.5 
43 
28.5 
251 
                 
 
14,584 
 10,042 
 4,344 
68.9 
43 
29.8 
2,682 
                 
Ulster Bank Group
               
Mortgages
21,162 
1,566 
439 
7.4 
28 
2.1 
336 
Personal unsecured
1,282 
185 
158 
14.4 
85 
12.3 
48 
30 
Commercial real estate
               
  - investment
8,138 
2,989 
1,332 
36.7 
45 
16.4 
889 
  - development
9,850 
6,406 
2,820 
65.0 
44 
28.6 
1,875 
Other corporate
11,009 
2,515 
1,228 
22.8 
49 
11.2 
695 
11 
                 
 
51,441 
13,661 
5,977 
26.6 
44 
11.6 
3,843 
48 

Key points
·
REIL increased by £3.5 billion during the year, which reflects continuing difficult conditions in both the commercial and residential sectors in Ireland. Growth moderated in the last two quarters of 2011 as default trends for corporate portfolios declined.
   
·
At 31 December 2011, 68% of REIL was in Non-Core (2010 - 74%). The majority of the Non-Core commercial real estate development portfolio (89%) is REIL with a 57% provision coverage.

 
183

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Residential mortgages
The tables below show how the continued decrease in property values has affected the distribution of residential mortgages by indexed LTV. LTV is based upon gross loan amounts and whilst including defaulted loans, does not take account of provisions made.


LTV distribution calculated on a volume basis
2011 
2010 
     
<= 70%
45.0 
50.3 
> 70% and <= 90%
11.4 
13.0 
> 90% and <= 110%
12.0 
14.5 
> 110% and <= 130%
10.9 
13.5 
> 130%
20.7 
8.7 
     
Total portfolio average LTV at 31 December
81.0 
71.2 
     
Average LTV on new originations during the year
67.0 
75.9 

LTV distribution calculated on a value basis
 
£m 
 
£m 
     
<= 70%
4,526 
5,928 
> 70% and <= 90%
2,501 
3,291 
> 90% and <= 110%
3,086 
4,256 
> 110% and <= 130%
3,072 
4,391 
> 130%
6,517 
2,958 
     
Total portfolio average LTV at 31 December
106.1 
91.7 
     
Average LTV on new originations during the year
73.9 
78.9 

Key points
·
The residential mortgage portfolio across Ulster Bank Group totalled £20 billion at 31 December 2011, with 89% in the Republic of Ireland and 11% in Northern Ireland.
   
·
The mortgage REIL continued to increase as a result of the continued challenging economic environment. At 31 December 2011, REIL as a percentage of gross mortgages was 10.9% (by value) compared with 7.4% in 2010. The impairment charge for 2011 was £570 million compared with £336 million for 2010. Repossession levels were higher than in 2010, with a total of 161 properties repossessed during 2011 (compared with 76 during 2010). 76% of repossessions during 2011 were through voluntary surrender or abandonment of the property.
   
·
Ulster Bank Group is assisting customers in this difficult environment. Mortgage forbearance policies which are deployed through the ‘Flex’ initiative are aimed at assisting customers in financial difficulty. At 31 December 2011, 9.1% (by value) of the mortgage book (£1.8 billion) was on a forbearance arrangement compared with 5.8% (£1.2 billion) at 31 December 2010. The majority of these forbearance arrangements are in the performing book (77%) and not 90 days past due, refer to page 161 for further details.

 
184

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Credit risk: Ulster Bank Group (Core and Non-Core) (continued)

Commercial real estate
The commercial real estate lending portfolio for Ulster Bank Group totalled £17.1 billion at 31 December, of which £12.3 billion or 72% is Non-Core. The geographic split of the total Ulster Bank Group commercial real estate portfolio remained similar to 2010, with 26% in Northern Ireland, 63% in the Republic of Ireland and 11% in the UK.

 
Development
 
Investment
   
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Commercial 
Residential 
 
Total 
Exposure by geography
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
               
31 December 2011
             
Ireland (ROI & NI)
2,591 
6,317 
 
5,097 
1,132 
 
15,137 
UK (excluding NI)
95 
336 
 
1,371 
111 
 
1,913 
RoW
32 
 
27 
 
63 
               
 
2,686 
6,685 
 
6,495 
1,247 
 
17,113 
               
31 December 2010
             
Ireland (ROI & NI)
2,785 
6,578 
 
5,032 
1,098 
 
15,493 
UK (excluding NI)
110 
359 
 
1,869 
115 
 
2,453 
RoW
18 
 
23 
 
42 
               
 
2,895 
6,955 
 
6,924 
1,214 
 
17,988 


Key points
·
Commercial real estate remains the primary driver of the increase in the defaulted loan book for Ulster Bank Group. The outlook remains challenging, with limited liquidity in the marketplace to support sales or refinancing. The decrease in asset valuations has placed pressure on the portfolio.
   
·
Within its early problem management framework, Ulster Bank may agree various remedial measures with customers whose loans are performing but who are experiencing temporary financial difficulties. During 2011, commercial real estate loans amounting to £0.8 billion (exposures greater than £10 million) benefited from such measures.
   
·
During 2011, impaired commercial real estate loans amounting to £1 billion (exposures greater than £10 million) were restructured and remain in the non-performing book.

 
185

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk
Country risk is the risk of material losses arising from significant country-specific events such as sovereign events (default or restructuring); economic events (contagion of sovereign default to other parts of the economy, cyclical economic shock); political events (transfer or convertibility restrictions and expropriation or nationalisation); and natural disaster or conflict. Such events have the potential to affect elements of the Group’s credit portfolio that are directly or indirectly linked to the country in question and can also give rise to market, liquidity, operational and franchise risk related losses.

For a discussion of the Group’s approach to country risk management and the external risk environment, refer to the 2011 Annual Report and Accounts: Business review: Risk and balance sheet management: Country risk.

The following tables show the Group’s exposure by country of incorporation of the counterparty at 31 December 2011. Countries shown are those where the Group’s balance sheet exposure to counterparties incorporated in the country exceeded £1 billion and the country had an external rating of A+ or below from S&P, Moody’s or Fitch at 31 December 2011, as well as selected eurozone countries. The numbers are stated before taking into account the impact of mitigating actions, such as collateral, insurance or guarantees, that may have been taken to reduce or eliminate exposure to country risk events. Exposures relating to ocean-going vessels are not included due to their multinational nature.

For definitions of headings in the following tables, refer to page 209.

‘Other eurozone’ comprises Austria, Cyprus, Estonia, Finland, Malta, Slovakia and Slovenia.

References to Non-Core in the following pages relate to Non-Core lending disclosures in the summary tables on pages 187-188.

 
186

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Summary

 
31 December 2011
 
Lending
                           
 
Central 
and local 
 government 
Central 
 banks 
Other 
 banks 
 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
lending 
 
Of which 
Non-Core 
 
Debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
(gross of 
collateral)
 and repos 
 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Contingent 
liabilities and 
commitments 
 
Total 
 
CDS 
notional 
less fair 
value 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Eurozone
                                         
Ireland
45 
1,467 
136 
336 
18,994 
18,858 
39,836 
 
10,156 
 
886 
 
2,824 
 
43,546 
 
2,928 
 
46,474 
 
53 
Spain
206 
154 
5,775 
362 
6,509 
 
3,735 
 
6,155 
 
2,393 
 
15,057 
 
2,630 
 
17,687 
 
(1,013)
Italy
73 
233 
299 
2,444 
23 
3,072 
 
1,155 
 
1,258 
 
2,314 
 
6,644 
 
3,150 
 
9,794 
 
(452)
Greece
31 
427 
14 
485 
 
94 
 
409 
 
355 
 
1,249 
 
52 
 
1,301 
 
Portugal
10 
495 
510 
 
341 
 
113 
 
519 
 
1,142 
 
268 
 
1,410 
 
55 
Germany
18,068 
653 
305 
6,608 
155 
25,789 
 
5,402 
 
15,767 
 
16,037 
 
57,593 
 
7,527 
 
65,120 
 
(2,401)
Netherlands
2,567 
7,654 
623 
1,575 
4,827 
20 
17,266 
 
2,498 
 
9,893 
 
10,285 
 
37,444 
 
10,216 
 
47,660 
 
(1,295)
France
481 
1,273 
437 
3,761 
79 
6,034 
 
2,317 
 
7,794 
 
9,058 
 
22,886 
 
10,217 
 
33,103 
 
(2,846)
Luxembourg
101 
1,779 
2,228 
4,110 
 
1,497 
 
130 
 
3,689 
 
7,929 
 
2,007 
 
9,936 
 
(404)
Belgium
213 
287 
354 
588 
20 
1,470 
 
480 
 
652 
 
3,010 
 
5,132 
 
1,359 
 
6,491 
 
(99)
Other eurozone
121 
28 
115 
1,375 
26 
1,665 
 
324 
 
710 
 
1,971 
 
4,346 
 
1,365 
 
5,711 
 
(25)
                                           
Total eurozone
3,443 
27,282 
3,550 
5,385 
47,522 
19,564 
106,746 
 
27,999 
 
43,767 
 
52,455 
 
202,968 
 
41,719 
 
244,687 
 
(8,426)
                                           
Other countries
                                       
India
275 
610 
35 
2,949 
127 
3,996 
 
350 
 
1,530 
 
218 
 
5,744 
 
1,280 
 
7,024 
 
(105)
China
74 
178 
1,237 
17 
654 
30 
2,190 
 
50 
 
597 
 
413 
 
3,200 
 
1,559 
 
4,759 
 
(62)
South Korea
812 
576 
1,397 
 
 
845 
 
404 
 
2,646 
 
627 
 
3,273 
 
(22)
Turkey
215 
193 
253 
66 
1,072 
16 
1,815 
 
423 
 
361 
 
94 
 
2,270 
 
437 
 
2,707 
 
10 
Russia
36 
970 
659 
62 
1,735 
 
76 
 
186 
 
66 
 
1,987 
 
356 
 
2,343 
 
(343)
Brazil
936 
227 
1,167 
 
70 
 
790 
 
24 
 
1,981 
 
319 
 
2,300 
 
(377)
Romania
66 
145 
30 
413 
392 
1,054 
 
1,054 
 
220 
 
 
1,280 
 
160 
 
1,440 
 
Mexico
233 
683 
924 
 
39 
 
83 
 
131 
 
1,138 
 
353 
 
1,491 
 
10 
Poland
35 
208 
624 
885 
 
45 
 
116 
 
56 
 
1,057 
 
701 
 
1,758 
 
(99)
 
 
187

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Summary (continued)

 
31 December 2010
 
Lending
                           
 
Central 
and local 
 government 
Central 
 banks 
Other 
 banks 
 
Other 
financial 
institutions 
Corporate 
Personal 
Total 
lending 
 
Of which 
Non-Core 
 
Debt 
securities 
 
Derivatives 
(gross of 
collateral)
 and repos 
 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Contingent 
liabilities and 
commitments 
 
Total 
 
CDS 
notional 
less fair 
value 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
                                           
Eurozone
                                         
Ireland
61 
2,119 
87 
813 
19,886 
20,228 
43,194 
 
10,758 
 
1,323 
 
2,940 
 
47,457 
 
4,316 
 
51,773 
 
(32)
Spain
19 
166 
92 
6,991 
407 
7,680 
 
4,538 
 
7,107 
 
2,047 
 
16,834 
 
3,061 
 
19,895 
 
(964)
Italy
45 
78 
668 
418 
2,483 
27 
3,719 
 
1,901 
 
3,836 
 
2,032 
 
9,587 
 
3,853 
 
13,440 
 
(838)
Greece
14 
36 
18 
31 
191 
16 
306 
 
130 
 
974 
 
227 
 
1,507 
 
164 
 
1,671 
 
182 
Portugal
86 
63 
611 
766 
 
316 
 
242 
 
394 
 
1,402 
 
734 
 
2,136 
 
41 
Germany
10,894 
1,060 
422 
7,519 
162 
20,057 
 
6,471 
 
14,747 
 
15,266 
 
50,070 
 
8,917 
 
58,987 
 
(1,551)
Netherlands
914 
6,484 
554 
1,801 
6,170 
81 
16,004 
 
3,205 
 
12,523 
 
9,058 
 
37,585 
 
18,141 
 
55,726 
 
(1,530)
France
511 
1,095 
470 
4,376 
102 
6,557 
 
2,787 
 
14,041 
 
8,607 
 
29,205 
 
11,640 
 
40,845 
 
(1,925)
Luxembourg
25 
26 
734 
2,503 
3,291 
 
1,517 
 
378 
 
2,545 
 
6,214 
 
2,383 
 
8,597 
 
(532)
Belgium
102 
14 
441 
32 
893 
327 
1,809 
 
501 
 
803 
 
2,238 
 
4,850 
 
1,492 
 
6,342 
 
57 
Other eurozone
124 
142 
119 
1,505 
24 
1,915 
 
332 
 
535 
 
1,370 
 
3,820 
 
2,037 
 
5,857 
 
(82)
                                           
Total eurozone
1,876 
19,659 
4,320 
4,932 
53,128 
21,383 
105,298 
 
32,456 
 
56,509 
 
46,724 
 
208,531 
 
56,738 
 
265,269 
 
(7,174)
                                           
Other countries
                                       
India
1,307 
307 
2,665 
273 
4,552 
 
653 
 
1,686 
 
178 
 
6,416 
 
1,281 
 
7,697 
 
(195)
China
17 
298 
1,223 
16 
753 
64 
2,371 
 
236 
 
573 
 
252 
 
3,196 
 
1,589 
 
4,785 
 
(117)
South Korea
276 
1,033 
558 
1,874 
 
53 
 
1,353 
 
493 
 
3,720 
 
1,143 
 
4,863 
 
(159)
Turkey
282 
68 
448 
37 
1,386 
12 
2,233 
 
692 
 
550 
 
111 
 
2,894 
 
686 
 
3,580 
 
(91)
Russia
110 
244 
1,181 
58 
1,600 
 
125 
 
124 
 
51 
 
1,775 
 
596 
 
2,371 
 
(134)
Brazil
825 
315 
1,145 
 
120 
 
687 
 
15 
 
1,847 
 
190 
 
2,037 
 
(369)
Romania
36 
178 
21 
21 
426 
446 
1,128 
 
1,123 
 
310 
 
 
1,446 
 
319 
 
1,765 
 
23 
Mexico
149 
999 
1,157 
 
303 
 
144 
 
122 
 
1,423 
 
840 
 
2,263 
 
84 
Poland
168 
655 
843 
 
108 
 
271 
 
69 
 
1,183 
 
1,020 
 
2,203 
 
(94)

 
188

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk (continued)

Key points
Reported exposures are affected by currency movements. Over the year, sterling fell 0.3% against the US dollar and rose 3.1% against the euro. In the fourth quarter, sterling fell 0.9% against the US dollar and rose 2.9% against the euro.

·
Exposure to most countries shown in the table declined over 2011 as the Group maintained a cautious stance and many bank clients reduced debt levels. Decreases were seen in balance sheet and off-balance sheet exposures in many countries. Increases in derivatives and repos were in line with the Group’s strategy, driven partly by customer demand for hedging solutions and partly by market movements; risks are generally mitigated by active collateralisation.
   
·
India - strong economic growth in 2011 resulted in increased exposure across most product types until the fourth quarter, when a decline took place, driven by a Global Transaction Services (GTS) exercise in the region to manage down risk-weighted assets, natural run-offs/maturities and a sharp rupee depreciation. Year-on-year increases in lending to corporate clients (£0.3 billion) and the central bank (£0.3 billion) were offset by reductions in lending to banks (£0.7 billion) and other financial institutions (£0.3 billion).
   
·
China - lending to Chinese banks increased in the first three quarters of the year, supporting trade finance activities and on-shore regulatory needs, but by the end of 2011 exposure had decreased close to December 2010 levels. The Group reduced lending in the interbank money markets over the final quarter. This reduction in lending was offset by significant growth in repo trading with Chinese financial institutions helping to support the Group’s funding requirements, with highly liquid US Treasuries being the main underlying security. A reduction in off-balance sheet exposures, including guarantees and undrawn commitments, was in part due to the run-off of performance bonds in respect of shipping deliveries and also due to reduced appetite for trade finance assets.
   
·
South Korea - exposure decreased by £1.6 billion during 2011. This was largely due to a reduction in debt securities as the Group managed its wrong-way risk exposure. The Group maintained a cautious stance given the current global economic downturn.
   
·
Turkey - exposures were managed down in most categories, with the non-strategic (mid-market) portfolio significantly reduced in 2011. Nonetheless, Turkey continues to be one of the Group’s key emerging markets. The strategy remains client-centric, with the product offering tailored to selected client segments across large Turkish international corporate clients and financial institutions as well as Turkish subsidiaries of global clients.

 
189

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk (continued)

Key points (continued)
·
Mexico - asset sales and a number of early repayments in the corporate portfolio led to exposure falling £0.8 billion in the year. This decline also reflects the Group’s cautious approach to new business during the fourth quarter following its decision to close its onshore operation in Mexico.
   
·
Eurozone periphery (Ireland, Spain, Italy, Greece and Portugal) - exposure decreased across most of the periphery, with derivatives (gross of collateral) and repos being the only component that still saw some increases year on year (partly an effect of market movements on existing positions). Most of the Group’s country risk exposure to the eurozone periphery countries arises from the activities of GBM and Ulster Bank (with respect to Ireland). The Group has some large holdings of Spanish bank and financial institution MBS bonds and smaller quantities of Italian bonds and Greek sovereign debt. GTS provides trade finance facilities to clients across Europe including the eurozone periphery.
   
 
The Group primarily transacts CDS contracts with investment-grade global financial institutions that are active participants in the CDS market. These transactions are subject to regular margining. For European peripheral sovereigns, credit protection has been purchased from a number of major European banks, predominantly outside the country of the reference entity. In a few cases where protection was bought from banks in the country of the reference entity, giving rise to wrong-way risk, this risk is mitigated through specific collateralisation. Due to their bespoke nature, exposures relating to CDPCs and related hedges have not been included, as they cannot be meaningfully attributed to a particular country or a reference entity. Exposures to CDPCs are disclosed on page 170.
 
The Group used CDS contracts throughout 2011 to manage both eurozone country and counterparty exposures. As shown in the individual country tables, this resulted in increases in both gross notional bought and sold eurozone CDS contracts, mainly on Italy, France and the Netherlands. The magnitude of the fair value of bought and sold CDS contracts increased over 2011 in line with the widening of eurozone CDS spreads.

For more specific commentary on the Group’s exposure to each of the eurozone periphery countries, refer to pages 193 to 201. For commentary on the Group’s exposure to other eurozone countries, see page 208.

 
190

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Eurozone
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
3,443 
 
18,406 
81 
 
19,597 
15,049 
22,954 
 
1,925 
 
28,322 
 
37,080 
36,759 
 
6,488 
(6,376)
Central banks
27,282 
 
20 
 
26 
 
5,770 
 
33,078 
 
 
Other banks
3,550 
 
8,423 
(752)
 
1,272 
1,502 
8,193 
 
29,685 
 
41,428 
 
19,736 
19,232 
 
2,303 
(2,225)
Other financial
  institutions
5,385 
 
10,494 
(1,129)
 
1,138 
471 
11,161 
 
10,956 
 
27,502 
 
17,949 
16,608 
 
693 
(620)
Corporate
47,522 
14,152 
7,267 
 
964 
23 
 
528 
59 
1,433 
 
4,118 
 
53,073 
 
76,966 
70,119 
 
2,241 
(1,917)
Personal
19,564 
2,280 
1,069 
 
 
 
 
19,565 
 
 
 
106,746 
16,432 
8,336 
 
38,307 
(1,777)
 
22,541 
17,081 
43,767 
 
52,455 
 
202,968 
 
151,731 
142,718 
 
11,725 
(11,138)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
1,876 
 
23,201 
(893)
 
25,041 
14,256 
33,986 
 
1,537 
 
37,399 
 
28,825 
29,075 
 
2,899 
(2,843)
Central banks
19,659 
 
 
 
6,382 
 
26,048 
 
 
Other banks
4,320 
 
9,192 
(916)
 
1,719 
1,187 
9,724 
 
25,639 
 
39,683 
 
16,616 
16,256 
 
1,042 
(1,032)
Other financial
  institutions
4,932 
 
10,583 
(737)
 
908 
83 
11,408 
 
9,025 
 
25,365 
 
12,921 
12,170 
 
173 
(182)
Corporate
53,128 
12,404 
5,393 
 
813 
45 
 
831 
260 
1,384 
 
4,141 
 
58,653 
 
70,354 
63,790 
 
(267)
461 
Personal
21,383 
1,642 
537 
 
 
 
 
21,383 
 
 
 
105,298 
14,046 
5,930 
 
43,789 
(2,501)
 
28,506 
15,786 
56,509 
 
46,724 
 
208,531 
 
128,716 
121,291 
 
3,847 
(3,596)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
67,624 
5,585 
 
1,085 
131 
 
198 
23 
 
 
68,907 
5,739 
Other financial Institutions
79,824 
5,605 
 
759 
89 
 
2,094 
278 
 
147 
14 
 
82,824 
5,986 
Total
147,448 
11,190 
 
1,844 
220 
 
2,292 
301 
 
147 
14 
 
151,731 
11,725 
 
 
191

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Ireland
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
45 
 
102 
(46)
 
20 
19 
103 
 
92 
 
240 
 
2,145 
2,223 
 
466 
(481)
Central banks
1,467 
 
 
 
 
1,467 
 
 
Other banks
136 
 
177 
(39)
 
195 
14 
358 
 
1,459 
 
1,953 
 
110 
107 
 
21 
(21)
Other financial
  institutions
336 
 
61 
 
116 
35 
142 
 
855 
 
1,333 
 
523 
630 
 
64 
(74)
Corporate
18,994 
10,269 
5,689 
 
148 
 
135 
283 
 
417 
 
19,694 
 
425 
322 
 
(11)
10
Personal
18,858 
2,258 
1,048 
 
 
 
 
18,859 
 
 
 
39,836 
12,527 
6,737 
 
488 
(82)
 
466 
68 
886 
 
2,824 
 
43,546 
 
3,203 
3,282 
 
540 
(566)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
61 
 
104 
(45)
 
93 
88 
109 
 
20 
 
190 
 
1,872 
2,014 
 
360 
(387)
Central banks
2,119 
 
 
 
126 
 
2,252 
 
 
Other banks
87 
 
435 
(51)
 
96 
45 
486 
 
1,523 
 
2,096 
 
317 
312 
 
103 
(95)
Other financial
  institutions
813 
 
291 
(1)
 
205 
496 
 
837 
 
2,146 
 
566 
597 
 
45 
(84)
Corporate
19,886 
8,291 
4,072 
 
91 
(2)
 
140 
225 
 
434 
 
20,545 
 
483 
344 
 
(20)
17 
Personal
20,228 
1,638 
534 
 
 
 
 
20,228 
 
 
 
43,194 
9,929 
4,606 
 
921 
(99)
 
541 
139 
1,323 
 
2,940 
 
47,457 
 
3,238 
3,267 
 
488 
(549)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
1,586 
300 
 
 
 
 
1,588 
300 
Other financial Institutions
1,325 
232 
 
161 
 
129 
 
 
1,615 
240 
Total
2,911 
532 
 
163 
 
129 
 
 
3,203 
540 

 
192

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Ireland (continued)

Key points
The Group’s exposure to Ireland is driven by Ulster Bank Group (87% of the Group’s Irish exposure at 31 December 2011). The portfolio is predominantly personal lending of £18.9 billion (largely mortgages) and corporate lending of £19.0 billion (largely loans to the property sector). In addition, the Group has lending and derivatives exposure to the Central Bank of Ireland, financial institutions and large international clients with funding units based in Ireland.
   
Group exposure declined in all categories, with notable reductions in lending of £3.4 billion and in off-balance sheet items of £1.4 billion over the year, as a result of currency movements and de-risking in the portfolio.

Central and local government and central bank
Exposure to the central bank fluctuates, driven by regulatory requirements and by deposits of excess liquidity as part of the Group’s assets and liabilities management. Exposures fell by £0.7 billion over the year, with most of the decline occurring in the fourth quarter.

Financial institutions
GBM and Ulster Bank account for the majority of the Group’s exposure to financial institutions. Exposure to the financial sector fell by £1.1 billion during the year, caused by a £0.4 billion reduction in lending, a £0.5 billion reduction in debt securities and smaller reductions in derivatives and repos and in off-balance sheet exposure. The largest category is derivatives and repos where exposure is affected predominantly by market movements and transactions are typically collateralised.

Corporate
Corporate lending exposure fell approximately £0.9 billion over the year, driven by a combination of exchange rate movements and write-offs. At the end of 2011, lending exposure was highest in the property sector (£11.6 billion), which is also the sector that experienced the largest year-on-year reduction (£0.4 billion). REIL and impairment provisions rose by £2.0 billion and £1.6 billion respectively over the year.

Personal
The Ulster Bank retail portfolio mainly consists of mortgages (approximately 95% of Ulster Bank personal lending at 31 December 2011), with the remainder comprising credit card and other personal lending. Overall personal lending exposure fell approximately £1.4 billion over the year as a result of exchange rate fluctuations, amortisation, a small amount of write-offs and a lack of demand in the market.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
Ireland Non-Core lending exposure was £10.2 billion at 31 December 2011, down by £0.6 billion or 6% since December 2010. The remaining lending portfolio largely consists of exposures to real estate (79%), retail (7%) and leisure (4%).

 
193

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Spain
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
 
33 
(15)
 
360 
751 
(358)
 
35 
 
(314)
 
5,151 
5,155 
 
538 
(522)
Central banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
206 
 
4,892 
(867)
 
162 
214 
4,840 
 
1,622 
 
6,668 
 
1,965 
1,937 
 
154 
(152)
Other financial
  institutions
154 
 
1,580 
(639)
 
65 
1,637 
 
282 
 
2,073 
 
2,417 
2,204 
 
157 
(128)
Corporate
5,775 
1,190 
442 
 
 
27 
36 
 
454 
 
6,265 
 
4,831 
3,959 
 
448 
(399)
Personal
362 
 
 
 
 
362 
 
 
 
6,509 
1,190 
442 
 
6,514  
(1,521)
 
614  
973 
6,155 
 
2,393 
 
15,057 
 
14,364 
13,225 
 
1,297 
(1,201)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
19 
 
88 
(7)
 
1,172 
1,248 
12 
 
53 
 
84 
 
3,820 
3,923 
 
436 
(435)
Central banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
166 
 
5,264 
(834)
 
147 
118 
5,293 
 
1,482 
 
6,941 
 
2,087 
2,159 
 
133 
(135)
Other financial
  institutions
92 
 
1,724 
(474)
 
34 
1,751 
 
22 
 
1,865 
 
1,648 
1,388 
 
72 
(45)
Corporate
6,991 
1,871 
572 
 
38 
 
50 
51 
 
490 
 
7,532 
 
5,192 
4,224 
 
231 
(168)
Personal
407 
 
 
 
 
407 
 
 
 
7,680 
1,872 
572 
 
7,085 
(1,277)
 
1,403 
1,381 
7,107 
 
2,047 
 
16,834 
 
12,747 
11,694 
 
872 
(783)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
6,595 
499 
 
68 
 
32 
 
 
6.695 
508 
Other financial Institutions
7,238 
736 
 
162 
 
269 
50 
 
 
7,669 
789 
Total
13,833 
1,235 
 
230 
 
301 
54 
 
 
14,364 
1,297 

 
194

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Spain (continued)

Key points
The Group maintains strong relationships with Spanish government entities, banks, other financial institutions and large corporate clients. The exposure to Spain is driven by corporate lending and a large MBS covered bond portfolio.
   
Exposure fell in most categories in 2011, particularly in corporate lending, as a result of steps to de-risk the portfolio.

Central and local government and central bank
The Group’s exposure to the government was negative at 31 December 2011, reflecting net short held-for-trading debt securities.

Financial institutions
A sizeable covered bond portfolio of £6.5 billion is the Group’s largest exposure to the Spanish financial sector. The portfolio continued to perform satisfactorily in 2011. Stress analysis conducted to date on these available-for-sale debt securities indicated that this exposure is unlikely to suffer material credit losses. However, the Group continues to monitor the situation closely.
   
A further £1.9 billion of the Group’s exposure to financial institutions consists of derivatives exposure to Spanish international banks and a few of the large regional banks, the majority of which is collateralised. This increased £0.4 billion in 2011, due partly to market movements.
   
Lending to banks consists mainly of short-term uncommitted credit lines with the top two international Spanish banks.

Corporate
Exposure to corporate clients declined during 2011, with reductions in lending of £1.2 billion and in off-balance sheet items of £0.4 billion, driven by reductions in exposure to property, transport and technology, media and telecommunications sectors. The majority of REIL relates to commercial real estate lending and decreased over the year, reflecting disposals and restructurings.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
At 31 December 2011, Non-Core had lending exposure of £3.7 billion to Spain, a reduction of £0.8 billion or 18% since December 2010. The real estate (66%), construction (11%), electricity (7%) and land transport (3%) sectors account for the majority of this lending exposure.

 
195

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Italy
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
 
704 
(220)
 
4,336 
4,725 
315 
 
90 
 
405 
 
12,125 
12,218 
 
1,750 
(1,708)
Central banks
73 
 
 
 
 
73 
 
 
Other banks
233 
 
119 
(14)
 
67 
88 
98 
 
1,064 
 
1,395 
 
6,078 
5,938 
 
1,215 
(1,187)
Other financial
  institutions
299 
 
685 
(15)
 
40 
13 
712 
 
686 
 
1,697 
 
872 
762 
 
60 
(51)
Corporate
2,444 
361 
113 
 
75 
 
58 
133 
 
474 
 
3,051 
 
4,742 
4,299 
 
350 
(281)
Personal
23 
 
 
 
 
23 
 
 
 
3,072 
361 
113 
 
1,583 
(249)
 
4,501 
4,826 
1,258 
 
2,314 
 
6,644 
 
23,817 
23,217 
 
3,375 
(3,227)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
45 
 
906 
(99)
 
5,113 
3,175 
2,844 
 
71 
 
2,960 
 
8,998 
8,519 
 
641 
(552)
Central banks
78 
 
 
 
 
78 
 
 
Other banks
668 
 
198 
(11)
 
67 
16 
249 
 
782 
 
1,699 
 
4,417 
4,458 
 
421 
(414)
Other financial
  institutions
418 
 
646 
(5)
 
49 
695 
 
759 
 
1,872 
 
723 
697 
 
21 
(13)
Corporate
2,483 
314 
141 
 
20 
 
36 
48 
 
420 
 
2,951 
 
4,506 
3,966 
 
150 
(88)
Personal
27 
 
 
 
 
27 
 
 
 
3,719 
314 
141 
 
1,770 
(115)
 
5,265 
3,199 
3,836 
 
2,032 
 
9,587 
 
18,644 
 17,640 
 
1,233 
(1,067)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
12,904 
1,676 
 
487 
94 
 
61 
10 
 
 
13,452 
1,780 
Other financial Institutions
10,138 
1,550 
 
 
219 
43 
 
 
10,365 
1,595 
Total
23,042 
3,226 
 
495 
96 
 
280 
53 
 
 
23,817 
3,375 

 
196

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Italy (continued)

Key points
The Group maintains strong relationships with Italian government entities, banks, other financial institutions and large corporate clients. Since the start of 2011, the Group has taken steps to reduce its risks through strategic exits where appropriate, or to mitigate these risks through increased collateral requirements, in line with its evolving appetite for Italian risk. As a result, the Group reduced lending exposure to Italian counterparties by £0.6 billion over 2011 to £3.1 billion.

Central and local government and central bank
The Group is an active market-maker in Italian government bonds, resulting in large gross long and short positions in held-for-trading securities. Given this role, the Group left itself in a relatively modest long position at 31 December 2011 to avoid being temporarily over exposed as a result of its expected participation in the purchase of new government bonds being issued in January 2012.
   
Over 2011, the total government debt securities position declined by £2.5 billion to £0.3 billion, reflecting a rebalancing of the trading portfolio.

Financial institutions
The majority of the Group’s exposure to Italian financial institutions relates to the top five banks. The Group’s product offering consists largely of collateralised trading products and, to a lesser extent, short-term uncommitted lending lines for liquidity purposes. During the fourth quarter of the year, gross mtm derivatives exposure increased due to market movements but the risk was mitigated since most facilities are fully collateralised.

Corporate
Lending exposure fell slightly during 2011, with reductions in lending to the property industry offset by increased lending to manufacturing companies, particularly in the fourth quarter.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
Non-Core lending exposure was £1.2 billion at 31 December 2011, a £0.7 billion (39%) reduction since December 2010. The remaining lending exposure comprises mainly commercial real estate finance (22%), leisure (20%), unleveraged funds (16%), electricity (15%) and industrials (10%).

 
197

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Greece
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
 
312 
 
102 
409 
 
 
416 
 
3,158 
3,165 
 
2,228 
(2,230)
Central banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
 
 
 
290 
 
290 
 
22 
22 
 
(3)
Other financial
  institutions
31 
 
 
 
 
33 
 
34 
34 
 
(8)
Corporate
427 
256 
256 
 
 
 
63 
 
490 
 
434 
428 
 
144 
(142)
Personal
14 
 
 
 
 
14 
 
 
 
485 
256 
256 
 
312 
 
102 
409 
 
355 
 
1,249 
 
3,648 
3,649 
 
2,383 
(2,383)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
14 
 
895 
(694)
 
118 
39 
974 
 
 
995 
 
2,960 
3,061 
 
854 
(871)
Central banks
36 
 
 
 
 
36 
 
 
Other banks
18 
 
 
 
167 
 
185 
 
21 
19 
 
(3)
Other financial
  institutions
31 
 
 
 
 
34 
 
35 
35 
 
11 
(11)
Corporate
191 
48 
48 
 
 
 
50 
 
241 
 
511 
616 
 
44 
(49)
Personal
16 
 
 
 
 
16 
 
 
 
306 
48 
48 
 
895 
(694)
 
118 
39 
974 
 
227 
 
1,507 
 
3,527 
3,731 
 
912 
(934)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
2,001 
1,345 
 
 
 
 
2,002 
1,346 
Other financial Institutions
1,507 
945 
 
63 
45 
 
76 
47 
 
 
1,646 
1,037 
Total
3,508 
2,290 
 
64 
46 
 
76 
47 
 
 
3,648 
2,383 

 
198

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Greece (continued)

Key points
The Group has reduced its effective exposure to Greece and continues to actively manage its exposure to the country, in line with the de-risking strategy that has been in place since early 2010. Much of the remaining exposure is collateralised or guaranteed.

Central and local government and central bank
As a result of the continued deterioration in Greece’s fiscal position, coupled with the potential for the restructuring of Greek sovereign debt, the Group recognised an impairment charge in respect of available-for-sale Greek government bonds.

Financial institutions
Activity with Greek financial companies is under close scrutiny; exposure is minimal.
   
Due to market movements, the gross derivatives exposure to banks increased by £0.1 billion during the year. The portfolio is largely collateralised.

Corporate
At the start of 2011, the Group reclassified the domicile of exposures to a number of defaulted clients, resulting in an increase in reported exposure to Greek corporate clients as well as increases in REIL and impairment provisions.
   
The Group’s focus is now on short-term trade facilities to the domestic subsidiaries of international clients, increasingly supported by parental guarantees.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
The Non-Core division’s lending exposure to Greece was £0.1 billion at 31 December 2011, a reduction of 28% since December 2010. The remaining lending portfolio primarily consists of the following sectors: financial intermediaries (33%), construction (20%), other services (16%) and electricity (14%).

 
199

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Portugal
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
 
56 
(58)
 
36 
152 
(60)
 
19 
 
(41)
 
3,304 
3,413 
 
997 
(985)
Other banks
10 
 
91 
(36)
 
12 
101 
 
389 
 
500 
 
1,197 
1,155 
 
264 
(260)
Other financial
  institutions
 
 
12 
 
30 
 
42 
 
 
(1)
Corporate
495 
27 
27 
 
42 
 
18 
60 
 
81 
 
636 
 
366 
321 
 
68 
(48)
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
                                         
 
510 
27 
27 
 
194 
(94)
 
73 
154 
113 
 
519 
 
1,142 
 
4,875 
4,894 
 
1,330 
(1,294)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
86 
 
92 
(26)
 
68 
122 
38 
 
29 
 
153 
 
2,844 
2,923 
 
471 
(460)
Other banks
63 
 
106 
(24)
 
46 
150 
 
307 
 
520 
 
1,085 
1,107 
 
231 
(243)
Other financial
  institutions
 
47 
 
54 
 
 
61 
 
 
(1)
Corporate
611 
27 
21 
 
 
 
51 
 
662 
 
581 
507 
 
48 
(29)
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
766 
27 
21 
 
245 
(49)
 
121 
124 
242 
 
394 
 
1,402 
 
4,519 
4,543 
 
749 
(732)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
2,922 
786 
 
46 
12 
 
 
 
2,968 
798 
Other financial Institutions
1,874 
517 
 
 
33 
15 
 
 
1,907 
532 
Total
4,796 
1,303 
 
46 
12 
 
33 
15 
 
 
4,875 
1,330 

 
200

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Portugal (continued)

Key points
In early 2011, RBS closed its local operations in Portugal, leaving the Group with modest overall exposure of £1.4 billion by year-end. The portfolio, now managed out of Spain, is focused on corporate lending and derivatives trading with the largest local banks. Medium-term activity has ceased with the exception of that carried out under a Credit Support Annex.

Central and local government and central bank
During 2011, the Group’s exposure to the Portuguese government was reduced to a very small derivatives position, the result of decreases in contingent and lending exposures to public sector entities by way of facility maturities. The Group’s exposure to the government was negative at 31 December 2011, reflecting net short held-for-trading debt securities.

Financial institutions
A major proportion of the remaining exposures is focused on the top four systemically important financial groups. Exposures generally consist of collateralised trading products.

Corporate
The largest non-financial corporate exposure is to the energy and transport sectors. The Group’s exposure is concentrated on a few large, highly creditworthy clients.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
The Non-Core division’s lending exposure to Portugal was £0.3 billion at 31 December 2011, an increase of 8% in the portfolio since December 2010, due to an infrastructure project drawing committed facilities. The portfolio comprises lending exposure to the land transport and logistics (52%), electricity (30%) and commercial real estate (14%) sectors. There is no exposure to central or local government.

 
201

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Germany
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
 
12,035 
523 
 
4,136 
2,084 
14,087 
 
423 
 
14,510 
 
2,631 
2,640 
 
76 
(67)
Central banks
18,068 
 
 
 
5,704 
 
23,772 
 
 
Other banks
653 
 
1,376 
 
294 
761 
909 
 
6,003 
 
7,565 
 
4,765 
4,694 
 
307 
(310)
Other financial
  institutions
305 
 
563 
(33)
 
187 
95 
655 
 
3,321 
 
4,281 
 
3,653 
3,403 
 
(2)
Corporate
6,608 
191 
80 
 
109 
 
14 
116 
 
586 
 
7,310 
 
20,433 
18,311 
 
148 
(126)
Personal
155 
19 
19 
 
 
 
 
155 
 
 
 
25,789 
210 
99 
 
14,083 
504 
 
4,631 
2,947 
15,767 
 
16,037 
 
57,593 
 
31,482 
29,048 
 
538 
(505)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
 
10,648 
 
5,964 
4,124 
12,488 
 
160 
 
12,648 
 
2,056 
2,173 
 
25 
(19)
Central banks
10,894 
 
 
 
6,233 
 
17,127 
 
 
Other banks
1,060 
 
1,291 
 
567 
481 
1,377 
 
6,289 
 
8,726 
 
3,848 
3,933 
 
73 
(88)
Other financial
  institutions
422 
 
494 
(47)
 
195 
17 
672 
 
1,951 
 
3,045 
 
2,712 
2,633 
 
(18)
18 
Corporate
7,519 
163 
44 
 
219 
 
44 
53 
210 
 
633 
 
8,362 
 
20,731 
19,076 
 
(382)
372 
Personal
162 
 
 
 
 
162 
 
 
 
20,057 
163 
44 
 
12,652 
(39)
 
6,770 
4,675 
14,747 
 
15,266 
 
50,070 
 
29,347 
27,815 
 
(302)
283 

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
14,644 
171 
 
163 
 
 
 
14,815 
175 
Other financial Institutions
16,315 
357 
 
18 
 
334 
 
 
16,667 
363 
                             
Total
30,959 
528 
 
181 
 
342 
 
 
31,482 
538 
 
 
202

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Netherlands
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
2,567 
 
1,447 
74 
 
849 
591 
1,705 
 
41 
 
4,313 
 
1,206 
1,189 
 
31 
(31)
Central banks
7,654 
 
 
 
 
7,667 
 
 
Other banks
623 
 
802 
217 
 
365 
278 
889 
 
7,574 
 
9,086 
 
965 
995 
 
41 
(42)
Other financial
  institutions
1,575 
 
6,804 
(386)
 
290 
108 
6,986 
 
1,914 
 
10,475 
 
5,772 
5,541 
 
142 
(131)
Corporate
4,827 
621 
209 
 
199 
 
113 
307 
 
749 
 
5,883 
 
15,416 
14,238 
 
257 
(166)
Personal
20 
 
 
 
 
20 
 
 
 
17,266 
624 
211 
 
9,252 
(89)
 
1,623 
982 
9,893 
 
10,285 
 
37,444 
 
23,359 
21,963 
 
471 
(370)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
914 
 
3,469 
16 
 
1,426 
607 
4,288 
 
46 
 
5,248 
 
1,195 
999 
 
(2)
(4)
Central banks
6,484 
 
 
 
 
6,484 
 
 
Other banks
554 
 
984 
 
223 
275 
932 
 
5,021 
 
6,507 
 
784 
789 
 
12 
(10)
Other financial
  institutions
1,801 
 
6,612 
(185)
 
344 
12 
6,944 
 
3,116 
 
11,861 
 
4,210 
3,985 
 
48 
(46)
Corporate
6,170 
388 
149 
 
264 
 
152 
57 
359 
 
875 
 
7,404 
 
12,330 
11,113 
 
(72)
177 
Personal
81 
 
 
 
 
81 
 
 
 
16,004 
391 
152 
 
11,329 
(164)
 
2,145 
951 
12,523 
 
9,058 
 
37,585 
 
18,519 
16,886 
 
(14)
117

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
7,605 
107 
 
88 
 
 
 
7,699 
108 
Other financial Institutions
14,529 
231 
 
308 
37 
 
676 
81 
 
147 
14 
 
15,660 
363 
Total
22,134 
338 
 
396 
38 
 
682 
81 
 
147 
14 
 
23,359 
471 

 
203

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: France
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
481 
 
2,648 
(14)
 
8,705 
5,669 
5,684 
 
357 
 
6,522 
 
3,467 
2,901 
 
228 
(195)
Central banks
 
20 
 
20 
 
12 
 
35 
 
 
Other banks
1,273 
 
889 
(17)
 
157 
75 
971 
 
7,271 
 
9,515 
 
4,232 
3,995 
 
282 
(236)
Other financial
  institutions
437 
 
642 
(40)
 
325 
126 
841 
 
675 
 
1,953 
 
2,590 
2,053 
 
136 
(117)
Corporate
3,761 
128 
74 
 
240 
 
72 
34 
278 
 
743 
 
4,782 
 
23,224 
21,589 
 
609 
(578)
Personal
79 
 
 
 
 
79 
 
 
 
6,034 
128 
74 
 
4,439 
(62)
 
9,259 
5,904 
7,794 
 
9,058 
 
22,886 
 
33,513 
30,538 
 
1,255 
(1,126)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
511 
 
5,912 
40 
 
10,266 
3,968 
12,210 
 
362 
 
13,083 
 
2,225 
2,287 
 
87 
(92)
Central banks
 
 
 
15 
 
18 
 
 
Other banks
1,095 
 
774 
 
410 
204 
980 
 
7,183 
 
9,258 
 
3,631 
3,071 
 
63 
(43)
Other financial
  institutions
470 
 
666 
(22)
 
42 
23 
685 
 
375 
 
1,530 
 
1,722 
1,609 
 
(2)
Corporate
4,376 
230 
46 
 
71 
 
185 
90 
166 
 
672 
 
5,214 
 
19,771 
18,466 
 
(181)
159 
Personal
102 
 
 
 
 
102 
 
 
 
6,557 
230 
46 
 
7,423 
19 
 
10,903 
4,285 
14,041 
 
8,607 
 
29,205 
 
27,349 
25,433 
 
(31)
22 

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
13,353 
453 
 
162 
13 
 
79 
 
 
13,594 
474 
Other financial Institutions
19,641 
758 
 
24 
 
254 
22 
 
 
19,919 
781 
Total
32,994 
1,211 
 
186 
14 
 
333 
30 
 
 
33,513 
1,255 

 
204

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Luxembourg
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Other banks
101 
 
10 
 
17 
 
546 
 
664 
 
 
Other financial
  institutions
1,779 
 
54 
(7)
 
82 
80 
56 
 
2,963 
 
4,798 
 
2,080 
1,976 
 
118 
(108)
Corporate
2,228 
897 
301 
 
 
58 
57 
 
180 
 
2,465 
 
2,478 
2,138 
 
146 
(116)
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,110 
897 
301 
 
69 
(7)
 
147 
86 
130 
 
3,689 
 
7,929 
 
4,558 
4,114 
 
264 
(224)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
 
 
24
24 
 
 
24 
 
 
Central banks
25 
 
 
 
 
25 
 
 
Other banks
26 
 
30 
(1)
 
45 
75 
 
499 
 
600 
 
 
Other financial
  institutions
734 
 
99 
(3)
 
32 
19 
112 
 
1,800 
 
2,646 
 
1,296 
1,220 
 
(5)
Corporate
2,503 
807 
206 
 
 
183 
21 
167 
 
246 
 
2,916 
 
2,367 
1,918 
 
(16)
13 
Personal
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,291 
807 
206 
 
134 
(3)
 
284 
40 
378 
 
2,545 
 
6,214 
 
3,663 
3,138 
 
(21)
14 

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
1,535 
93 
 
16 
 
 
 
1,551 
93 
Other financial Institutions
2,927 
164 
 
10 
 
70 
 
 
3,007 
171 
Total
4,462 
257 
 
26 
 
70 
 
 
4,558 
264 

 
205

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Belgium
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Central and local
  government
213 
 
742 
(116)
 
608 
722 
628 
 
89 
 
930 
 
1,612 
1,505 
 
120 
(110)
Central banks
 
 
 
 
11 
 
 
Other banks
287 
 
 
 
2,450 
 
2,741 
 
312 
302 
 
14 
(13)
Other financial
  institutions
354 
 
 
(3)
 
191 
 
542 
 
 
Corporate
588 
31 
21 
 
 
20 
23 
 
277 
 
888 
 
563 
570 
 
12 
(12)
Personal
20 
 
 
 
 
20 
 
 
 
1,470 
31 
21 
 
749 
(116)
 
629 
726 
652 
 
3,010 
 
5,132 
 
2,487 
2,377 
 
146 
(135)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
102 
 
763 
(54)
 
529 
602 
690 
 
92 
 
884 
 
880 
986 
 
53 
(57)
Central banks
14 
 
 
 
 
21 
 
 
Other banks
441 
 
39 
 
66 
103 
 
1,822 
 
2,366 
 
278 
266 
 
(1)
Other financial
  institutions
32 
 
 
 
126 
 
158 
 
 
Corporate
893 
27 
27 
 
 
11 
10 
 
191 
 
1,094 
 
628 
594 
 
(6)
Personal
327 
 
 
 
 
327 
 
 
 
1,809 
27 
27 
 
803 
(53)
 
606 
606 
803 
 
2,238 
 
4,850 
 
1,786 
1,846 
 
49 
(52)

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
1,602 
97 
 
 
12 
 
 
1,616 
98 
Other financial Institutions
866 
48 
 
 
 
 
871 
48 
Total
2,468  
145 
 
 
16 
 
 
2,487 
146 

 
206

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Rest of eurozone (1)
                              CDS by reference entity
         
AFS and 
 LAR debt 
 securities
AFS 
 reserves
 
HFT
debt securities
Total debt 
 securities
 
Derivatives 
 (gross of 
 collateral)
and repos 
 
Balance 
sheet 
exposures 
 
Notional
  Fair value
 
Lending 
REIL 
Provisions 
Long 
Short 
Bought 
Sold 
 
Bought 
Sold 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
  
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
Central and local
  government
121 
 
327 
(47)
 
445 
331 
441 
 
779 
 
1,341 
 
2,281 
2,350 
 
54 
(47)
Central banks
 
 
 
44 
 
44 
 
 
Other banks
28 
 
63 
(1)
 
13 
70 
 
1,017 
 
1,051 
 
90 
87 
 
(1)
Other financial
  institutions
115 
 
100 
(9)
 
25 
123 
 
37 
 
275 
 
 
Corporate
1,375 
181 
55 
 
134 
(4)
 
13 
140 
 
94 
 
1,609 
 
4,054 
3,944 
 
70 
(59)
Personal
26 
 
 
 
 
26 
 
 
                                         
 
1,665 
181 
55 
 
624 
(61)
 
496 
410 
710 
 
1,971 
 
4,346 
 
6,425 
6,381 
 
126 
(107)
31 December 2010
                                       
Central and local
  government
124 
 
324 
(25)
 
268 
283 
309 
 
697 
 
1,130 
 
1,975 
2,190 
 
(26)
34
Central banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other banks
142 
 
71 
(1)
 
52 
44 
79 
 
564 
 
785 
 
148 
142 
 
Other financial
  institutions
119 
 
 
(1)
 
29 
 
147 
 
 
Corporate
1,505 
238 
67 
 
133 
(1)
 
30 
15 
148 
 
79 
 
1,732 
 
3,254 
2,966 
 
(63)
51
Personal
24 
 
 
 
 
24 
 
 
 
1,915 
238 
67 
 
532 
(27)
 
350 
347 
535 
 
1,370 
 
3,820 
 
5,377 
5,298 
 
(88)
85

CDS bought protection: counterparty analysis by internal asset quality band

 
AQ1
 
AQ2-AQ3
 
AQ4-AQ9
 
AQ10
 
Total
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
 
Notional 
Fair value 
31 December 2011 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
Banks
2,877 
58 
 
50 
 
 
 
2,927 
59 
Other financial Institutions
3,464 
67 
 
 
30 
 
 
3,498 
67 
Total
6,341 
125 
 
54 
 
30 
 
 
6,425 
126 

Note:
(1)
Comprises Austria, Cyprus, Estonia, Finland, Malta, Slovakia and Slovenia.

 
207

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk: Eurozone non-periphery

Key points
Due to credit risk and capital considerations, the Group increased exposure to central banks (particularly in Germany and the Netherlands) by depositing with them higher levels of surplus liquidity on a short-term basis, given the limited alternative investment opportunities.
   
During 2011, in anticipation of widening credit spreads and for reasons of general risk management, the Group reduced its holdings in French and Dutch AFS sovereign bonds. The Group concurrently increased its holdings of German AFS sovereign debt in line with internal liquidity and risk management strategies.

Financial institutions
France - approximately half of the lending to banks is to the top three banks.
   
Luxembourg - lending to non-bank financial institutions increased by £1.0 billion during 2011, reflecting collateral relating to derivatives and repos.

Corporate
Netherlands - corporate lending fell £1.3 billion over 2011, driven by the manufacturing, natural resources and services sectors. The relatively large contingent liabilities and commitments declined £7.9 billion.

Non-Core (included above)
Refer to table on pages 187 and 188 for details.
Non-Core lending exposure has been generally reduced in line with the Group’s strategic plan. Lending exposure in France was £2.3 billion at 31 December 2011, having declined £0.5 billion during 2011. The lending portfolio mainly comprises property (45%) and sovereign and quasi-sovereign (20%) exposures.
   
Non-Core lending exposure in Germany was £5.4 billion at 31 December 2011, down £1.1 billion since December 2010. The lending portfolio is mostly in the property (44%) and transport (35%) sectors.
   
Non-Core lending exposure in the Netherlands was £2.5 billion at 31 December 2011, down £0.7 billion year on year. The portfolio mainly comprises exposures to the property (66%) and technology, media and telecommunications (19%) sectors.

 
208

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Risk management: Country risk
Notes to tables on page 187 to 207.

Lending comprises gross loans and advances to: central and local governments; central banks, including cash balances; other banks and financial institutions, incorporating overdraft and other short-term facilities; corporations, in large part loans and leases; and individuals, comprising mortgages, personal loans and credit card balances. Lending includes impaired loans and loans where an impairment event has taken place but no impairment provision is recognised.

Debt securities comprise securities classified as available-for-sale (AFS), loans and receivables (LAR), held-for-trading (HFT) and designated as at fair value through profit or loss (DFV). All debt securities other than LAR securities are carried at fair value. LAR debt securities are carried at amortised cost less impairment. HFT debt securities are presented as gross long positions (including DFV securities) and short positions per country. Impairment losses and exchange differences relating to AFS debt securities, together with interest are recognised in the income statement; other changes in the fair value of AFS securities are reported within AFS reserves, which are presented gross of tax.

Derivatives comprise the mark-to-market (mtm) value of such contracts after the effect of enforceable netting agreements, but gross of collateral. Reverse repurchase agreements (repos) comprise the mtm value of counterparty exposure arising from repo transactions net of collateral.

Balance sheet exposures comprise lending exposures, debt securities and derivatives and repo exposures.

Contingent liabilities and commitments comprise contingent liabilities, including guarantees, and committed undrawn facilities.

Asset Quality (AQ) - for the probability of default range relating to each internal asset quality band, refer to page 167.

Credit default swap (CDS) under CDS contract, the credit risk on the reference entity is transferred from the buyer to the seller. The fair value, or mtm, represents the balance sheet carrying value. The mtm value of CDSs is included within derivatives against the counterparty of the trade, as opposed to the reference entity. The notional is the par amount of the credit protection bought or sold and is included against the reference entity of the CDS contract.

The column CDS notional less fair value represents the notional less fair value amounts arising from sold positions netted against those arising from bought positions, and represents the net change in exposure for a given reference entity should the CDS contract be triggered by a credit event, assuming there is zero recovery rate. However, in most cases, the Group expects the recovery rate to be greater than zero and the change in exposure to be less than this amount.

 
209

 
 
Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk
Market risk arises from changes in interest rates, foreign currency, credit spreads, equity prices and risk related factors such as market volatilities. The Group manages market risk centrally within its trading and non-trading portfolios through a comprehensive market risk management framework. This control framework includes qualitative guidance in the form of comprehensive policy statements, dealing authorities, limits based on, but not limited to, value-at-risk (VaR), stress testing, positions and sensitivity analyses.

Following the implementation of CRD III, the Group is required to calculate: (i) an additional capital charge based on a stressed calibration of the VaR model - Stressed VaR; (ii) an Incremental Risk Charge to capture the default and migration risk for credit risk positions in the trading book; and (iii) an All Price Risk measure for correlation trading positions, subject to a capital floor that is based on standardised securitisation charges. The capital charges at 31 December 2011 associated with the new models are shown in the table below:

 
Total 
 
£m 
   
Stressed VaR
1,682 
Incremental Risk Charge
469 
All Price Risk
297 

For a description of the Group’s basis of measurement and methodology enhancements, refer to the 2011 Annual Report and Accounts: Market risk.

Daily distribution of GBM trading revenues
 
 
Note:
(1)
The effect of any month end adjustments, not attributable to a specific daily market move, is spread evenly over the days in the month in question.
 
 
 
210

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

Key points
·
GBM trading revenue was adversely affected by ongoing concerns around the European sovereign crisis and an overall uncertain macroeconomic environment. High volatility in the markets and increasingly risk-averse sentiment reduced levels of trading activity.
   
·
The average daily trading revenue earned by GBM’s trading activities in 2011 was £19 million, compared with £25 million in 2010. The standard deviation of the daily revenues in 2011 was £21 million, down from £22 million in 2010. The standard deviation measures the variation of daily revenues about the mean value of those revenues.
   
·
The number of days with negative revenue increased from 22 days in 2010 to 42 days in 2011, primarily due to the market and economic conditions referred to above.
   
·
The most frequent result is daily revenue of between £25 million and £30 million, of which there were 30 occurrences in 2011, compared with 37 in 2010.

The tables below detail VaR for the Group’s trading portfolios, segregated by type of market risk exposure, and between Core and Non-Core, Counterparty Exposure Management (CEM) and Core excluding CEM.

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
53.4 
68.1 
79.2 
27.5 
 
51.6 
57.0 
83.0 
32.5 
Credit spread
82.7 
74.3 
151.1 
47.4 
 
166.3 
133.4 
243.2 
110.2 
Currency
10.3 
16.2 
19.2 
5.2 
 
17.9 
14.8 
28.0 
8.4 
Equity
9.4 
8.0 
17.3 
4.6 
 
9.5 
10.9 
17.9 
2.7 
Commodity
1.4 
2.3 
7.0 
 
9.5 
0.5 
18.1 
0.5 
Diversification (1)
 
(52.3)
       
(75.6)
   
                   
Total
105.5 
116.6 
181.3 
59.7 
 
168.5 
141.0 
252.1 
103.0 
                   
Core (Total)
75.8 
89.1 
133.9 
41.7 
 
103.6 
101.2 
153.4 
58.3 
Core CEM
36.8 
52.4 
54.1 
21.9 
 
53.3 
54.6 
82.4 
30.3 
Core excluding CEM
59.2 
42.1 
106.2 
35.3 
 
82.8 
78.7 
108.7 
53.6 
                   
Non-Core
64.4 
34.6 
128.6 
30.0 
 
105.7 
101.4 
169.4 
63.2 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, industry counterparties, currencies and regions. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.
 
 
211

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
62.5 
68.1 
72.3 
50.8 
 
51.3 
73.0 
73.1 
33.1 
Credit spread
68.4 
74.3 
78.5 
57.4 
 
56.2 
69.8 
69.8 
47.4 
Currency
10.9 
16.2 
19.2 
5.7 
 
8.7 
6.5 
12.5 
6.1 
Equity
8.3 
8.0 
12.5 
5.0 
 
7.9 
7.7 
13.1 
4.6 
Commodity
4.3 
2.3 
7.0 
2.0 
 
0.9 
3.6 
3.6 
0.1 
Diversification (1)
 
(52.3)
       
(54.3)
   
                   
Total
109.7 
116.6 
132.2 
83.5 
 
78.3 
106.3 
114.2 
59.7 
                   
Core (Total)
77.3 
89.1 
95.6 
57.7 
 
58.3 
83.1 
91.0 
41.7 
Core CEM
46.1 
52.4 
54.1 
39.0 
 
34.4 
38.0 
45.2 
23.5 
Core excluding CEM
47.9 
42.1 
69.5 
38.7 
 
44.3 
62.2 
71.4 
35.3 
                   
Non-Core
35.2 
34.6 
40.7 
30.0 
 
40.4 
38.7 
53.0 
33.2 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, industry counterparties, currencies and regions. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key points
·
The Group’s market risk profile in 2010 was equally split across Non-Core and Core divisions, with a concentrated exposure to credit spread risk factors. The credit spread risk exposure significantly decreased in 2011, primarily due to the reduction in ABS trading inventory in Core and the restructuring of some monoline hedges for banking book exposures in Non-Core, in line with the overall business strategy to reduce risk exposures. The VaR also decreased due to the adoption of a more appropriate daily time series for sub-prime/subordinated RMBS and as the period of high volatility relating to the 2008/2009 financial crisis dropped out of the VaR calculation.
   
·
The average credit spread VaR for Q4 2011 was slightly higher than the average for Q3 2011 due to improvements to the credit default swap time series and as the volatility from European sovereign peripheral countries entered the two-year time series used in the VaR calculation.
   
·
The Group’s average interest rate VaR was slightly higher in Q4 2011 than in Q3 2011 due to the repositioning of interest rate exposures, reflecting market expectations that sterling would rally in the event of a eurozone break-up. Overall the average interest rate trading VaR was relatively unchanged between 2011 and 2010.
   
·
At period end 2010, the commodity VaR was materially lower than the average for that year as a result of the completion of the sale of the Group’s interest in the RBS Sempra Commodities joint venture. The commodity VaR increased slightly from mid-September 2011, due to improvements in capturing risk for commodity futures and indices.
 
 
212

 

Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

The tables below detail VaR for the Group’s non-trading portfolio, excluding the structured credit portfolio  (SCP) and loans and receivables (LAR), segregated by type of market risk exposure and between Core and Non-Core.

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
8.8 
9.9 
11.1 
5.7 
 
8.7 
10.4 
20.5 
4.4 
Credit spread
18.2 
13.6 
39.3 
12.1 
 
32.0 
16.1 
101.2 
15.4 
Currency
2.1 
4.0 
5.9 
0.1 
 
2.1 
3.0 
7.6 
0.3 
Equity
2.1 
1.9 
3.1 
1.6 
 
1.2 
3.1 
4.6 
0.2 
Diversification
 
(13.6)
       
(15.9)
   
                   
Total
19.7 
15.8 
41.6 
13.4 
 
30.9 
16.7 
98.0 
13.7 
                   
Core
19.3 
15.1 
38.9 
13.5 
 
30.5 
15.6 
98.1 
12.8 
Non-Core
3.4 
2.5 
4.3 
2.2 
 
1.3 
2.8 
4.1 
0.2 

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
 
Average 
Period end 
Maximum 
Minimum 
Non-trading VaR
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Interest rate
9.7 
9.9 
10.9 
8.8 
 
9.6 
10.3 
11.1 
8.2 
Credit spread
13.9 
13.6 
15.7 
12.1 
 
16.0 
14.8 
 18.0 
14.1 
Currency
3.5 
4.0 
5.1 
2.4 
 
3.0 
4.1 
5.9 
1.1 
Equity
1.9 
1.9 
2.0 
1.8 
 
1.9 
1.8 
2.0 
1.6 
Diversification
 
(13.6)
       
(13.5)
   
                   
Total
16.3 
15.8 
20.0 
14.2 
 
17.6 
17.5 
18.9 
15.7 
                   
Core
16.0 
15.1 
18.9 
14.1 
 
17.4 
18.6 
20.1 
15.2 
Non-Core
3.4 
2.5 
3.9 
2.5 
 
3.9 
3.7 
4.3 
3.2 

Note:
(1)
The Group benefits from diversification, which reflects the risk reduction achieved by allocating investments across various financial instrument types, industry counterparties, currencies and regions. The extent of diversification benefit depends on the correlation between the assets and risk factors in the portfolio at a particular time. Diversification has an inverse relationship with correlation. The diversification factor is the sum of the VaR on individual risk types less the total portfolio VaR.

Key points
·
The Group’s total non-trading VaR at 31 December 2011 was lower than at 31 December 2010, due to the exceptional volatility of the 2008/2009 financial crisis dropping out of the two year time series data used in the VaR calculation.
   
·
The maximum credit spread VaR was considerably lower in 2011 than in 2010. This was due to the implementation in early 2011 of the relative price-based mapping scheme for the Dutch RMBS portfolio. The availability of more granular data provided a better reflection of the risk in the portfolio.

 
213

 


Risk and balance sheet management (continued)


Market risk (continued)

Structured Credit Portfolio (SCP)

 
Drawn notional
 
Fair value
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
 
CDOs 
CLOs 
MBS (1)
Other 
 ABS 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
31 December 2011
                     
1-2 years
27 
27 
 
22 
22 
2-3 years
10 
196 
206 
 
182 
191 
4-5 years
37 
37 
95 
169 
 
34 
30 
88 
152 
5-10 years
32 
503 
270 
268 
1,073 
 
30 
455 
184 
229 
898 
>10 years
2,180 
442 
464 
593 
3,679 
 
766 
371 
291 
347 
1,775 
                       
 
2,212 
982 
781 
1,179 
5,154 
 
796 
860 
514 
868 
3,038 
                       
30 September 2011
                     
1-2 years
29 
36 
65 
 
28 
31 
59 
2-3 years
172 
177 
 
160 
164 
3-4 years
43 
55 
 
40 
50 
4-5 years
39 
95 
134 
 
36 
88 
124 
5-10 years
32 
517 
317 
277 
1,143 
 
30 
469 
230 
242 
971 
>10 years
1,296 
454 
470 
593 
2,813 
 
228 
394 
314 
349 
1,285 
                       
 
1,334 
1,010 
827 
1,216 
4,387 
 
263 
899 
581 
910 
2,653 
                       
31 December 2010
                     
1-2 years
47 
47 
 
42 
42 
2-3 years
85 
19 
44 
98 
246 
 
81 
18 
37 
91 
227 
3-4 years
41 
20 
205 
266 
 
-  
37 
19 
191 
247 
4-5 years
16 
16 
 
15 
15 
5-10 years
98 
466 
311 
437 
1,312 
 
87 
422 
220 
384 
1,113 
>10 years
412 
663 
584 
550 
2,209 
 
161 
515 
397 
367 
1,440 
                       
 
611 
1,189 
959 
1,337 
4,096 
 
344 
992 
673 
1,075 
3,084 

Notes:
(1)
MBS include sub-prime RMBS with a notional amount of £401 million (30 September 2011 - £406 million; 31 December 2010 - £471 million) and a fair value of £252 million (30 September 2011 - £274 million; 31 December 2010 - £329 million), all with residual maturities of greater than ten years.
(2)
This table relates to open market risk in SCP.

The Structured Credit Portfolio is within Non-Core. The risk in this portfolio is not measured or disclosed using VaR, as the Group believes this is not an appropriate tool for the banking book portfolio, which comprises illiquid debt securities. These assets are reported on a drawn notional and fair value basis, and managed on a third party asset and RWA basis.

Key points
·
The increase in total and CDO drawn notional year-on-year is due to the inclusion of banking book exposures that were previously hedged by monoline protection. As a result of the restructuring of some monoline protection, those previously protected assets are now reported on a drawn notional and fair value basis.
·
The overall reduction in CLO, MBS and other ABS drawn notional is due to the amortisations and pay downs over the year in line with expected amortisation profiles. In addition to this, fair value has declined due to falling market prices.

 
 
214

 

Risk factors


Set out below is a summary of certain risks which could adversely affect the Group; it should be read in conjunction with the Balance Sheet Management and Risk Management sections of the Business Review (pages 133 to 214). This summary should not be regarded as a complete and comprehensive statement of all potential risks and uncertainties. A fuller description of these and other risk factors is included in the Group’s 2011 Annual Report and Accounts.

·  
The Group’s businesses, earnings and financial condition have been and will continue to be affected by geopolitical conditions, the global economy, the instability in the global financial markets and increased competition. Together with a perceived increased risk of default on the sovereign debt of certain European countries and unprecedented stresses on the financial system within the eurozone, these factors have resulted in significant changes in market conditions including interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads, and other market factors and consequent changes in asset valuations.

·  
The Group’s ability to meet its obligations’ including its funding commitments, depends on the Group’s ability to access sources of liquidity and funding. The inability to access liquidity and funding due to market conditions or otherwise could adversely affect the Group’s financial condition. Furthermore, the Group’s borrowing costs and its access to the debt capital markets and other sources of liquidity depend significantly on its and the UK Government’s credit ratings.

·  
The Independent Commission on Banking has published its final report on competition and possible structural reforms in the UK banking industry. The Government has indicated that it supports and intends to implement the recommendations substantially as proposed which could have a material adverse effect on the Group.

·  
The Group’s ability to implement its strategic plan depends on the success of its efforts to refocus on its core strengths and its balance sheet reduction programme. As part of the Group’s strategic plan and implementation of the State Aid restructuring plan agreed with the European Commission and HM Treasury, the Group is undertaking an extensive restructuring which may adversely affect the Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition and give rise to increased operational risk and may impair the Group’s ability to raise new Tier 1 capital due to restrictions on its ability to make discretionary dividend or coupon payments on certain securities.

·  
The occurrence of a delay in the implementation of (or any failure to implement) the approved proposed transfers of a substantial part of the business activities of RBS N.V. to the Royal Bank of Scotland plc may have a material adverse effect on the Group.

·  
The Group or any of its UK bank subsidiaries may face the risk of full nationalisation or other resolution procedures and various actions could be taken by or on behalf of the UK Government, including actions in relation to any securities issued, new or existing contractual arrangements and transfers of part or all of the Group’s businesses.

 
215

 

Risk factors (continued)


·  
The actual or perceived failure or worsening credit of the Group’s counterparties or borrowers and depressed asset valuations resulting from poor market conditions have adversely affected and could continue to adversely affect the Group.

·  
The value of certain financial instruments recorded at fair value is determined using financial models incorporating assumptions, judgements and estimates that may change over time or may ultimately not turn out to be accurate.

·  
The Group’s insurance businesses are subject to inherent risks involving claims on insured events.

·  
The Group’s business performance, financial condition and capital and liquidity ratios could be adversely affected if its capital is not managed effectively or as a result of changes to capital adequacy and liquidity requirements, including those arising out of Basel III implementation (globally or by European or UK authorities), or if the Group is unable to issue Contingent B Shares to HM Treasury under certain circumstances.

·  
The Group could fail to attract or retain senior management, which may include members of the Group Board, or other key employees, and it may suffer if it does not maintain good employee relations.

·  
Any significant developments in regulatory or tax legislation could have an effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition, and the recoverability of certain deferred tax assets recognised by the Group is subject to uncertainty.

·  
The Group is subject to substantial regulation and oversight, and any significant regulatory or legal developments could have an adverse effect on how the Group conducts its business and on its results of operations and financial condition.  In addition, the Group is and may be subject to litigation and regulatory investigations that may impact its business, results of operations and financial condition.

·  
Operational and reputational risks are inherent in the Group’s operations.

·  
The Group may be required to make contributions to its pension schemes and government compensation schemes, either of which may have an adverse impact on the Group’s results of operations, cash flow and financial condition.

·  
As a result of the UK Government’s majority shareholding in the Group it can, and in the future may decide to, exercise a significant degree of influence over the Group including on dividend policy, modifying or cancelling contracts or limiting the Group’s operations. The offer or sale by the UK Government of all or a portion of its shareholding in the company could affect the market price of the equity shares and other securities and acquisitions of ordinary shares by the UK Government (including through conversions of other securities or further purchases of shares) may result in the delisting of the Group from the Official List.


 
216

 


Additional information


Selected financial data

Summary consolidated income statement

 
Quarter ended
 
31 December 
30 September 
31 December 
 
2011 
2011 
2010
 
£m 
£m 
£m
       
Net interest income
3,074 
3,077 
3,580 
Non-interest income
1,964 
5,526 
4,242 
       
Total income
5,038 
8,603 
7,822 
Operating expenses
(4,567)
(4,127)
(4,507)
       
Profit before insurance net claims and impairment losses
471 
4,476 
3,315 
Insurance net claims
(529)
(734)
(1,182)
Impairment losses
(1,918)
(1,738)
(2,141)
       
Operating (loss)/profit before tax
(1,976)
2,004 
(8)
Tax credit/(charge)
186 
(791)
       
(Loss)/profit from continuing operations
(1,790)
1,213 
(5)
Profit from discontinued operations, net of tax
10 
55 
       
(Loss)/profit for the period
(1,780)
1,219 
                     50 
       
(Loss)/profit attributable to:
     
Non-controlling interests
18
(7) 
38 
Ordinary and B shareholders
(1,798)
1,226 
12 

Summary consolidated balance sheet

 
31 December 
2011 
31 December 
2010  
 
£m 
£m 
     
Loans and advances
598,916 
655,778 
Debt securities and equity shares
224,263 
239,678 
Derivatives and settlement balances
537,389 
438,682 
Other assets
146,299 
119,438 
     
Total assets
1,506,867 
1,453,576 
     
Owners’ equity
74,819 
75,132 
Non-controlling interests
1,234 
1,719 
Subordinated liabilities
26,319 
27,053 
Deposits
483,256 
494,650 
Derivatives, settlement balances and short positions
572,499 
478,076 
Other liabilities
348,740 
376,946 
     
Total liabilities and equity
1,506,867 
1,453,576 
 

 
 
217

 

Additional information (continued)



 
2011 
2010 
     
Ordinary share price
£0.202 
£0.391 
     
Number of ordinary shares in issue
59,228m 
58,458m 

Capitalisation of the Group
The following table shows the Group’s issued and fully paid share capital, owners’ equity and indebtedness on an unaudited consolidated basis in accordance with IFRS as at 31 December 2011.
 
 
As at 
31 December 
 2011 
 
£m 
   
Share capital - allotted, called up and fully paid
 
Ordinary shares of 25p
14,807 
B shares of £0.01
510 
Dividend access share of £0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of US$0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of €0.01
Non-cumulative preference shares of £1.00
   
 
15,318 
Retained income and other reserves
59,501 
   
Owners’ equity
74,819 
   
Group indebtedness
 
Subordinated liabilities
26,319 
Debt securities in issue
162,621 
   
Total indebtedness
188,940 
   
Total capitalisation and indebtedness
263,759 
 
Under IFRS, certain preference shares are classified as debt and are included in subordinated liabilities in the table above.
 
Since 31 December 2011, issuances of debt securities totalled £2.8 billion, including a £1 billion public covered bond issuance and a US$1.2 billion securitisation.
 
Other than as disclosed above, the information contained in the tables above has not changed materially since 31 December, 2011.
 
 
218

 

Additional information (continued)


Ratio of earnings to fixed charges
 
  Year ended 31 December
 
2011 
2010 
2009(3)
2008(3)
2007 
Ratio of earnings to combined fixed charges
  and preference share dividends (1,2)
         
  - including interest on deposits
0.91 
0.94 
0.75 
­0.05 
1.45 
  - excluding interest on deposits
0.25 
0.38 
­
­
5.73 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges only (1,2)
         
  - including interest on deposits
0.91 
0.95 
0.80 
­0.05 
1.47 
  - excluding interest on deposits
0.25 
0.44 
­
­
6.53 

Notes:
(1)
For this purpose, earnings consist of income before tax and minority interests, plus fixed charges less the unremitted income of associated undertakings (share of profits less dividends received). Fixed charges consist of total interest expense, including or excluding interest on deposits and debt securities in issue, as appropriate, and the proportion of rental expense deemed representative of the interest factor (one third of total rental expenses).
(2)
The earnings for the years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were inadequate to cover total fixed charges and preference share dividends. The coverage deficiency for total fixed charges and preference share dividends for the years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were £766 million, £523 million, £3,582 million and £26,287 million, respectively. The coverage deficiency for fixed charges only for the years ended 31 December 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were £766 million, £399 million, £2,647 million and £25,691 million, respectively.
(3)
Negative ratios have been excluded.

 
 
219

 

SIGNATURE

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorised.




The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc
Registrant





 
 
/s/ Rajan Kapoor
 
Rajan Kapoor
Group Chief Accountant
March 1, 2012
 
 
 
 
 
220

 



 
Appendix 1
 
 
Businesses outlined for disposal


 
 

 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal

To comply with EC State Aid requirements the Group agreed to make a series of divestments by the end of 2013: the disposal of RBS Insurance, Global Merchant Services and its interest in RBS Sempra Commodities JV. The Group also agreed to dispose of its RBS England and Wales and NatWest Scotland branch-based businesses, along with certain SME and corporate activities across the UK (‘UK branch-based businesses’). The disposals of Global Merchant Services and RBS Sempra Commodities JV businesses have now effectively been completed.

The sale of the Group's UK branch-based businesses to Santander UK plc continues to make good progress and is expected to substantially complete in the fourth quarter of 2012, subject to regulatory approvals and other conditions.

The disposal of RBS Insurance, the base case plan for which is by way of a public flotation, is targeted to commence in the second half of 2012, subject to market conditions. External advisors have been appointed to assist the Group with the disposal and the process of separation is proceeding on plan. In the meantime, the business continues to be managed and reported as a separate core division.

The table below shows total income and operating profit of RBS Insurance and the UK branch-based businesses.

 
Total income
 
Operating profit/(loss)
before impairments
 
Operating profit/(loss)
 
2011 
2010 
 
2011 
2010 
 
2011 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
                 
RBS Insurance (1)
4,286 
5,302 
 
407 
(341)
 
407 
(341)
UK branch-based businesses (2)
959 
902 
 
518 
439 
 
319 
160 
                 
Total
5,245 
6,204 
 
925 
98 
 
726 
(181)

The table below shows the estimated risk-weighted assets, total assets and capital of the businesses identified for disposal.

 
RWAs
 
Total assets
 
Capital
 
2011 
2010 
 
2011 
2010 
 
2011 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
                 
RBS Insurance (1)
n/m 
n/m 
 
13.9 
14.0 
 
4.4 
4.0 
UK branch-based businesses (2)
11.1 
13.2 
 
19.3 
19.9 
 
1.0 
1.2 
                 
Total
11.1 
13.2 
 
33.2 
33.9 
 
5.4 
5.2 

Notes:
(1)
Total income includes investment income of £302 million (2010 - £309 million). Total assets and estimated capital include approximately £0.9 billion of goodwill, of which £0.7 billion is attributed to RBS Insurance by RBS Group.
(2)
Estimated notional equity based on 9% of RWAs.
 
 

 
1

 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

Further information on the UK branch-based businesses by division is shown in the tables below:

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
 
2011 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Income statement
         
Net interest income
329 
360 
 
689 
656 
Non-interest income
108 
162 
 
270 
246 
           
Total income
437 
522 
 
959 
902 
           
Direct expenses
         
  - staff
(74)
(84)
 
(158)
(176)
  - other
(106)
(60)
 
(166)
(144)
Indirect expenses
(67)
(50)
 
(117)
(143)
           
 
(247)
(194)
 
(441)
(463)
           
Operating profit before impairment losses
190 
328 
 
518 
439 
Impairment losses (1)
(92)
(107)
 
(199)
(279)
           
Operating profit
98 
221 
 
319 
160 
           
Analysis of income by product
         
Loans and advances
125 
311 
 
436 
445 
Deposits
101 
144 
 
245 
261 
Mortgages
134 
 
134 
120 
Other
77 
67 
 
144 
76 
           
Total income
437 
522 
 
959 
902 
           
Net interest margin
4.92% 
2.85% 
 
3.57% 
3.24% 
Employee numbers (full time equivalents rounded to the
  nearest hundred)
2,800 
1,600 
 
4,400 
4,400 

Note:
(1)
For the year ended 31 December 2011, impairment losses benefited from £75 million of latent and other provision releases.

 
Division
 
Total
 
UK 
Retail 
UK 
Corporate 
Global 
Banking 
& Markets 
 
 
2011 
 
2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
 
£bn 
£bn 
             
Capital and balance sheet
           
Total third party assets  (excluding mark-to-
  market derivatives)
7.2 
11.7 
 
18.9 
19.9 
Loans and advances to customers (gross)
7.3 
12.2 
 
19.5 
20.7 
Customer deposits
8.8 
13.0 
 
21.8 
24.0 
Derivative assets
0.4 
 
0.4 
n/a 
Derivative liabilities
0.1 
 
0.1 
n/a 
Risk elements in lending
0.5 
1.0 
 
1.5 
1.7 
Loan:deposit ratio
79% 
90% 
 
86% 
83% 
Risk-weighted assets
3.6 
7.5 
 
11.1 
13.2 


 
2

 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

The following information has been prepared to present RBS Insurance Group on a stand alone basis. The income statement includes the results of Direct Line Versicherung AG (DLVAG) (which is owned by National Westminster Bank plc), however the balance sheet excludes the balance sheet of DLVAG. The total assets and net assets of DLVAG are included in note 1 below.

RBS Insurance
Year ended
 
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
31 December 2009
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
Income Statement
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Earned premiums
4,221 
304 
4,525 
 
4,459 
733 
5,192 
 
4,519 
810 
5,329 
Reinsurers' share
(252)
(18)
(270)
 
(148)
(31)
(179)
 
(165)
(26)
(191)
                       
Net premium income
3,969 
286 
4,255 
 
4,311 
702 
5,013 
 
4,354 
784 
5,138 
Fees and commissions
(400)
(93)
(493)
 
(410)
89 
(321)
 
(367)
(119)
(486)
Instalment income
138 
145 
 
159 
35 
194 
 
171 
35 
206 
Other income
100 
(23)
77 
 
179 
(72)
107 
 
151 
(67)
84 
                       
Total income
3,807 
177 
3,984 
 
4,239 
754 
4,993 
 
4,309 
633 
4,942 
Net claims
(2,772)
(195)
(2,967)
 
(3,932)
(737)
(4,669)
 
(3,606)
(588)
(4,194)
                       
Underwriting profit/(loss)
1,035 
(18)
1,017 
 
307 
17 
324 
 
703 
45 
748 
                       
Staff expenses
(288)
(2)
(290)
 
(287)
(2)
(289)
 
(304)
(9)
(313)
Other expenses
(333)
(16)
(349)
 
(325)
(47)
(372)
 
(368)
(60)
(428)
                       
Total direct expenses
(621)
(18)
(639)
 
(612)
(49)
(661)
 
(672)
(69)
(741)
Indirect expenses
(225)
(46)
(271)
 
(267)
(46)
(313)
 
(270)
(58)
(328)
                       
Total expenses
(846)
(64)
(910)
 
(879)
(95)
(974)
 
(942)
(127)
(1,069)
                       
Technical result
189 
(82)
107 
 
(572)
(78)
(650)
 
(239)
(82)
(321)
Investment impairments
(2)
(2)
 
 
(8)
(8)
Investment income
265 
37 
302 
 
277 
32 
309 
 
305 
40 
345 
 
                     
Operating profit/(loss)
454 
(47)
407 
 
(295)
(46)
(341)
 
58 
(42)
16 


 
3

 
Appendix 1 Businesses outlined for disposal (continued)

RBS insurance (continued)
31 December 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
31 December 2009
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non-Core 
Total 
Balance Sheet (1)
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
Assets
                     
Property, plant and equipment
60 
60 
 
53 
53 
 
67 
67 
Investment properties
70 
70 
 
84 
84 
 
78 
78 
Intangible assets
362 
362 
 
280 
280 
 
282 
282 
Financial investments
6,912 
861 
7,773 
 
6,706 
939 
7,645 
 
6,263 
869 
7,132 
Loans and receivables including reinsurance
  receivables (2)
2,206 
159 
2,365 
 
1,792 
267 
2,059 
 
2,324 
388 
2,712 
Other assets, prepayments and accrued income
731 
20 
751 
 
808 
170 
978 
 
820 
60 
880 
Reinsurers share of insurance liabilities
298 
101 
399 
 
241 
117 
358 
 
258 
77 
335 
Cash and cash equivalents
1,304 
57 
1,361 
 
1,626 
196 
1,822 
 
1,123 
144 
1,267 
                       
Total assets
11,943 
1,198 
13,141 
 
11,590 
1,689 
13,279 
 
11,215 
1,538 
12,753 
                       
Liabilities
                     
Insurance liabilities (3)
7,101 
881 
7,982 
 
7,460 
1,362 
8,822 
 
6,956 
1,177 
8,133 
Borrowings
305 
11 
316 
 
309 
311 
 
290 
290 
Other liabilities, accruals and deferred income
916 
15 
931 
 
560 
67 
627 
 
592 
112 
704 
                       
Total liabilities
8,322 
907 
9,229 
 
8,329 
1,431 
9,760 
 
7,838 
1,289 
9,127 
                       
Equity (4)
3,621 
291 
3,912 
 
3,261 
258 
3,519 
 
3,377 
249 
3,626 
                       
Total liabilities and equity
11,943 
1,198 
13,141 
 
11,590 
1,689 
13,279 
 
11,215 
1,538 
12,753 

Notes:
(1)
Total assets of DLVAG at 31 December 2011 were £320 million (2010 - £322 million; 2009 - £337 million) and total equity was £103 million (2010 - £103 million; 2009 - £108 million).
(2)
Total reinsurance receivables at 31 December 2011 were £41 million (2010 - £41 million; 2009 - £42 million).
(3)
Insurance liabilities include unearned premium reserves.
(4)
Non-Core equity includes £259 million at 31 December 2011 which was a non-controlling interest (2010 - £259 million; 2009 - £259 million). Equity excludes goodwill of £0.7 billion which is attributed to RBS Insurance division by RBS Group.
 

 
 
4

 

 
Appendix 2
 
Additional risk management
disclosures



 
 

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures

Loans and advances to customers by sector and geography
The following tables analyse loans and advances to customers (excluding reverse repos and assets of disposal groups) by sector and geography (by location of office). Refer to Risk management: Credit risk for the Group summary. All assets, including loans, of businesses held for disposal are included as one line on the balance sheet, as required by IFRS.


 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
UK
                     
Central and local government
8,012 
25 
8,037 
 
7,680 
83 
7,763 
 
5,728 
173 
5,901 
Finance
30,874 
2,361 
33,235 
 
29,754 
3,795 
33,549 
 
27,995 
6,023 
34,018 
Residential mortgages
99,303 
1,423 
100,726 
 
104,040 
1,497 
105,537 
 
99,928 
1,665 
101,593 
Personal lending
20,080 
127 
20,207 
 
21,930 
295 
22,225 
 
23,035 
585 
23,620 
Property
31,141 
24,610 
55,751 
 
36,106 
25,953 
62,059 
 
34,970 
30,492 
65,462 
Construction
5,291 
1,882 
7,173 
 
6,203 
2,245 
8,448 
 
7,041 
2,310 
9,351 
Manufacturing
9,641 
835 
10,476 
 
11,123 
867 
11,990 
 
12,300 
1,510 
13,810 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
11,071 
1,441 
12,512 
 
12,325 
1,553 
13,878 
 
12,554 
1,853 
14,407 
  - transport and storage
8,589 
3,439 
12,028 
 
8,835 
3,664 
12,499 
 
8,105 
5,015 
13,120 
  - health, education and
    recreation
8,734 
757 
9,491 
 
11,894 
742 
12,636 
 
13,502 
1,039 
14,541 
  - hotels and restaurants
5,599 
569 
6,168 
 
6,264 
684 
6,948 
 
6,558 
808 
7,366 
  - utilities
2,462 
922 
3,384 
 
3,788 
715 
4,503 
 
3,101 
1,035 
4,136 
  - other
13,963 
1,644 
15,607 
 
13,952 
2,154 
16,106 
 
14,445 
1,991 
16,436 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
2,660 
76 
2,736 
 
2,963 
73 
3,036 
 
2,872 
67 
2,939 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
5,618 
5,598 
11,216 
 
5,524 
6,925 
12,449 
 
5,589 
7,785 
13,374 
Interest accruals
375 
375 
 
352 
353 
 
415 
98 
513 
                       
 
263,413 
45,709 
309,122 
 
282,733 
51,246 
333,979 
 
278,138 
62,449 
340,587 
                       
Europe
                     
Central and local government
116 
715 
831 
 
209 
805 
1,014 
 
365 
1,017 
1,382 
Finance
2,534 
474 
3,008 
 
2,654 
644 
3,298 
 
2,642 
1,019 
3,661 
Residential mortgages
18,393 
553 
18,946 
 
19,109 
590 
19,699 
 
19,473 
621 
20,094 
Personal lending
1,972 
492 
2,464 
 
2,126 
526 
2,652 
 
2,270 
600 
2,870 
Property
4,846 
11,538 
16,384 
 
5,359 
12,255 
17,614 
 
5,139 
12,636 
17,775 
Construction
1,019 
735 
1,754 
 
1,279 
754 
2,033 
 
1,014 
873 
1,887 
Manufacturing
4,383 
3,732 
8,115 
 
4,807 
3,872 
8,679 
 
5,853 
4,181 
10,034 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
3,992 
772 
4,764 
 
3,559 
721 
4,280 
 
4,126 
999 
5,125 
  - transport and storage
5,667 
862 
6,529 
 
5,281 
1,093 
6,374 
 
5,625 
1,369 
6,994 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,235 
349 
1,584 
 
1,334 
339 
1,673 
 
1,442 
496 
1,938 
  - hotels and restaurants
892 
535 
1,427 
 
1,029 
560 
1,589 
 
1,055 
535 
1,590 
  - utilities
1,569 
530 
2,099 
 
1,852 
598 
2,450 
 
1,412 
623 
2,035 
  - other
2,966 
1,555 
4,521 
 
3,554 
1,634 
5,188 
 
3,877 
2,050 
5,927 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
699 
53 
752 
 
760 
62 
822 
 
849 
68 
917 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
260 
435 
695 
 
259 
515 
774 
 
370 
744 
1,114 
Interest accruals
101 
71 
172 
 
105 
98 
203 
 
143 
101 
244 
                       
 
50,644 
23,401 
74,045 
 
53,276 
25,066 
78,342 
 
55,655 
27,932 
83,587 
 

 
 
1

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans and advances to customers by sector and geography (continued)

 
31 December 2011
 
30 September 2011
 
31 December 2010
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
Core 
Non- 
Core 
Total 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                       
US
                     
Central and local government
177 
14 
191 
 
164 
15 
179 
 
263 
53 
316 
Finance
8,993 
341 
9,334 
 
10,035 
368 
10,403 
 
9,522 
587 
10,109 
Residential mortgages
20,311 
2,926 
23,237 
 
20,285 
3,040 
23,325 
 
20,548 
3,653 
24,201 
Personal lending
7,505 
936 
8,441 
 
6,543 
1,986 
8,529 
 
6,816 
2,704 
9,520 
Property
2,413 
1,370 
3,783 
 
2,338 
1,549 
3,887 
 
1,611 
3,318 
4,929 
Construction
412 
45 
457 
 
443 
54 
497 
 
442 
78 
520 
Manufacturing
6,782 
42 
6,824 
 
6,545 
54 
6,599 
 
5,459 
143 
5,602 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
4,975 
98 
5,073 
 
4,851 
109 
4,960 
 
4,264 
237 
4,501 
  - transport and storage
1,832 
937 
2,769 
 
1,699 
985 
2,684 
 
1,786 
1,408 
3,194 
  - health, education and
    recreation
2,946 
88 
3,034 
 
2,572 
94 
2,666 
 
2,380 
313 
2,693 
  - hotels and restaurants
627 
57 
684 
 
532 
62 
594 
 
486 
136 
622 
  - utilities
1,033 
28 
1,061 
 
952 
27 
979 
 
1,117 
53 
1,170 
  - other
4,927 
394 
5,321 
 
4,447 
423 
4,870 
 
4,042 
577 
4,619 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
27 
27 
 
24 
24 
 
31 
31 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
2,471 
2,471 
 
2,531 
2,531 
 
2,315 
2,315 
Interest accruals
181 
45 
226 
 
172 
53 
225 
 
183 
73 
256 
                       
 
65,612 
7,321 
72,933 
 
64,133 
8,819 
72,952 
 
61,265 
13,333 
74,598 
                       
RoW
                     
Central and local government
54 
629 
683 
 
44 
604 
648 
 
425 
428 
853 
Finance
4,051 
53 
4,104 
 
5,651 
77 
5,728 
 
6,751 
22 
6,773 
Residential mortgages
502 
200 
702 
 
507 
192 
699 
 
410 
203 
613 
Personal lending
1,510 
1,511 
 
1,553 
1,556 
 
1,460 
1,462 
Property
304 
546 
850 
 
269 
871 
1,140 
 
735 
1,205 
1,940 
Construction
59 
10 
69 
 
67 
76 
 
183 
91 
274 
Manufacturing
2,395 
322 
2,717 
 
2,341 
440 
2,781 
 
2,185 
686 
2,871 
Service industries and
  business activities
                     
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
1,276 
28 
1,304 
 
1,472 
44 
1,516 
 
1,030 
102 
1,132 
  - transport and storage
366 
239 
605 
 
421 
267 
688 
 
430 
403 
833 
  - health, education and
    recreation
358 
225 
583 
 
424 
340 
764 
 
132 
17 
149 
  - hotels and restaurants
25 
25 
 
16 
52 
68 
 
90 
13 
103 
  - utilities
1,479 
369 
1,848 
 
1,620 
385 
2,005 
 
1,468 
399 
1,867 
  - other
2,372 
179 
2,551 
 
2,791 
268 
3,059 
 
2,100 
912 
3,012 
Agriculture, forestry and
  fishing
85 
85 
 
20 
20 
 
Finance leases and
  instalment credit
91 
26 
117 
 
90 
27 
117 
 
47 
47 
Interest accruals
18 
18 
 
32 
32 
 
90 
96 
                       
 
14,945 
2,827 
17,772 
 
17,318 
3,579 
20,897 
 
17,542 
4,489 
22,031 


 
2

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography
The following tables analyse loans and advances to banks and customers (excluding reverse repos and assets of disposal groups) and related REIL, provisions, impairments and write-offs by sector and geography (by location of office) for the Group, Core and Non-Core. Loans, REIL and provisions exclude amounts relating to businesses held for disposal, consistent with the balance sheet presentation required by IFRS.
31 December 2011
Gross
loans
£m
REIL
£m
Provisions
£m
REIL
as a %
of gross
loans
%
Provisions
as a %
of REIL
%
Provisions
as a %
of gross
loans
%
 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
FY
Amounts
written-off
£m
Group
               
Central and local government
9,742
-
-
-
-
-
-
Finance - banks
43,993
137
123
0.3
90
0.3
-
              - other
49,681
1,049
719
2.1
69
1.4
89 
87
Residential mortgages
143,611
5,084
1,362
3.5
27
0.9
1,076 
516
Personal lending
32,623
2,737
2,172
8.4
79
6.7
782 
1,286
Property
76,768
21,655
8,862
28.2
41
11.5
3,670 
1,171
Construction
9,453
1,762
703
18.6
40
7.4
139 
244
Manufacturing
28,132
881
504
3.1
57
1.8
227 
215
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
23,653
1,007
516
4.3
51
2.2
180 
172
  - transport and storage
21,931
589
146
2.7
25
0.7
78 
43
  - health, education and
    recreation
14,692
1,077
458
7.3
43
3.1
304 
98
  - hotels and restaurants
8,304
1,437
643
17.3
45
7.7
334 
131
  - utilities
8,392
88
23
1.0
26
0.3
3 
3
  - other
28,000
2,403
1,095
8.6
46
3.9
799 
373
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,600
145
63
4.0
43
1.8
(7)
18
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
14,499
794
508
5.5
64
3.5
112 
170
Interest accruals
791
Latent
1,986
(545)
                 
 
517,865
40,845
19,883
7.9
49
3.8
7,241 
4,527
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
100,726
2,076
397
2.1
19
0.4
180 
25
  - personal lending
20,207
2,384
1,925
11.8
81
9.5
645 
1,007
  - property
55,751
7,880
2,859
14.1
36
5.1
1,413 
490
  - other
162,220
4,934
3,040
3.0
62
1.9
699 
886
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
18,946
2,205
713
11.6
32
3.8
467 
10
  - personal lending
2,464
209
180
8.5
86
7.3
25 
126
  - property
16,384
13,073
5,751
79.8
44
35.1
2,296 
508
  - other
44,862
5,193
3,206
11.6
62
7.1
1,205 
289
US
               
  - residential mortgages
23,237
770
240
3.3
31
1.0
426 
481
  - personal lending
8,441
143
66
1.7
46
0.8
112 
153
  - property
3,783
329
92
8.7
28
2.4
(2)
138
  - other
38,158
656
913
1.7
139
2.4
(166)
197
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
702
33
12
4.7
36
1.7
3 
  - personal lending
1,511
1
1
0.1
100
0.1
  - property
850
373
160
43.9
43
18.8
(37)
35
  - other
19,623
586
328
3.0
56
1.7
(25)
182
                 
 
517,865
40,845
19,883
7.9
49
3.8
7,241 
4,527
 
 

 
 
3

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

30 September 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Central and local government
9,604 
76 
0.8 
Finance - banks
52,727 
149 
126 
0.3 
85 
0.2 
              - other
52,978 
979 
670 
1.8 
68 
1.3 
62 
Residential mortgages
149,260 
5,313 
1,420 
3.6 
27 
1.0 
949 
392 
Personal lending
34,962 
3,256 
2,622 
9.3 
81 
7.5 
535 
806 
Property
84,700 
22,354 
8,831 
26.4 
40 
10.4 
2,936 
731 
Construction
11,054 
1,753 
740 
15.9 
42 
6.7 
32 
168 
Manufacturing
30,049 
1,106 
489 
3.7 
44 
1.6 
105 
158 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
24,634 
1,094 
555 
4.4 
51 
2.3 
135 
93 
  - transport and storage
22,245 
544 
141 
2.4 
26 
0.6 
53 
35 
  - health, education and
    recreation
17,739 
1,197 
401 
6.7 
34 
2.3 
176 
72 
  - hotels and restaurants
9,199 
1,574 
701 
17.1 
45 
7.6 
266 
54 
  - utilities
9,937 
80 
22 
0.8 
28 
0.2 
  - other
29,223 
2,239 
1,162 
7.7 
52 
4.0 
690 
311 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,902 
151 
59 
3.9 
39 
1.5 
(21)
11 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
15,871 
861 
517 
5.4 
60 
3.3 
81 
125 
Interest accruals
813 
Latent
2,267 
(355)
                 
 
558,897 
42,726 
20,723 
7.6 
49 
3.7 
5,587 
3,020 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
105,537 
2,292 
424 
2.2 
18 
0.4 
152 
14 
  - personal lending
22,225 
2,913 
2,368 
13.1 
81 
10.7 
510 
666 
  - property
62,059 
8,373 
2,799 
13.5 
33 
4.5 
1,063 
421 
  - other
177,452 
5,343 
3,387 
3.0 
63 
1.9 
436 
650 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
19,699 
2,248 
722 
11.4 
32 
3.7 
445 
  - personal lending
2,652 
210 
178 
7.9 
85 
6.7 
(68)
20 
  - property
17,614 
13,165 
5,753 
74.7 
44 
32.7 
1,809 
189 
  - other
51,977 
5,188 
3,146 
10.0 
61 
6.1 
938 
195 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
23,325 
749 
265 
3.2 
35 
1.1 
352 
371 
  - personal lending
8,529 
131 
75 
1.5 
57 
0.9 
93 
116 
  - property
3,887 
377 
119 
9.7 
32 
3.1 
(10)
87 
  - other
38,275 
633 
946 
1.7 
149 
2.5 
(175)
111 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
699 
24 
3.4 
38 
1.3 
  - personal lending
1,556 
0.1 
50 
0.1 
  - property
1,140 
439 
160 
38.5 
36 
14.0 
74 
34 
  - other
22,271 
639 
371 
2.9 
58 
1.7 
(32)
135 
                 
 
558,897 
42,726 
20,723 
7.6 
49 
3.7 
5,587 
3,020 


 
4

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

31 December 2010
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
%
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Group
               
Central and local government
8,452 
Finance - banks
58,036 
145 
127 
0.2 
88 
0.2 
(13)
12 
              - other
54,561 
1,129 
595 
2.1 
53 
1.1 
198 
141 
Residential mortgages
146,501 
4,276 
877 
2.9 
21 
0.6 
1,014 
669 
Personal lending
37,472 
3,544 
2,894 
9.5 
82 
7.7 
1,370 
1,577 
Property
90,106 
19,584 
6,736 
21.7 
34 
7.5 
4,682 
1,009 
Construction
12,032 
2,464 
875 
20.5 
36 
7.3 
530 
146 
Manufacturing
32,317 
1,199 
503 
3.7 
42 
1.6 
(92)
1,547 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
25,165 
1,157 
572 
4.6 
49 
2.3 
334 
161 
  - transport and storage
24,141 
248 
118 
1.0 
48 
0.5 
87 
39 
  - health, education and
    recreation
19,321 
1,055 
319 
5.5 
30 
1.7 
159 
199 
  - hotels and restaurants
9,681 
1,269 
504 
13.1 
40 
5.2 
321 
106 
  - utilities
9,208 
91 
23 
1.0 
25 
0.2 
14 
  - other
29,994 
1,438 
749 
4.8 
52 
2.5 
378 
310 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,893 
152 
86 
3.9 
57 
2.2 
31 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
16,850 
847 
554 
5.0 
65 
3.3 
252 
113 
Interest accruals
1,109 
Latent
2,650 
(121)
                 
 
578,839 
38,598 
18,182 
6.7 
47 
3.1 
9,144 
6,042 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
101,593 
2,062 
314 
2.0 
15 
0.3 
169 
17 
  - personal lending
23,620 
3,083 
2,518 
13.1 
82 
10.7 
1,046 
1,153 
  - property
65,462 
7,986 
2,219 
12.2 
28 
3.4 
1,546 
397 
  - other
191,934 
5,652 
3,580 
2.9 
63 
1.9 
1,197 
704 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
20,094 
1,551 
301 
7.7 
19 
1.5 
221 
  - personal lending
2,870 
401 
316 
14.0 
79 
11.0 
66 
24 
  - property
17,775 
10,534 
4,199 
59.3 
40 
23.6 
2,828 
210 
  - other
53,380 
3,950 
2,454 
7.4 
62 
4.6 
763 
1,423 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
24,201 
640 
253 
2.6 
40 
1.0 
615 
645 
  - personal lending
9,520 
55 
55 
0.6 
100 
0.6 
160 
271 
  - property
4,929 
765 
202 
15.5 
26 
4.1 
321 
220 
  - other
36,780 
870 
1,133 
2.4 
130 
3.1 
(76)
524 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
613 
23 
3.8 
39 
1.5 
  - personal lending
1,462 
0.3 
100 
0.3 
98 
129 
  - property
1,940 
299 
116 
15.4 
39 
6.0 
(13)
182 
  - other
22,666 
722 
508 
3.2 
70 
2.2 
194 
136 
                 
 
578,839 
38,598 
18,182 
6.7 
47 
3.1 
9,144 
6,042 


 
5

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

31 December 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
 loans 
 
 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Central and local government
8,359 
Finance - banks
43,374 
136 
122 
0.3 
90 
0.3 
              - other
46,452 
732 
572 
1.6 
78 
1.2 
207 
44 
Residential mortgages
138,509 
4,704 
1,182 
3.4 
25 
0.9 
776 
198 
Personal lending
31,067 
2,627 
2,080 
8.5 
79 
6.7 
715 
935 
Property
38,704 
3,686 
1,001 
9.5 
27 
2.6 
470 
167 
Construction
6,781 
660 
228 
9.7 
35 
3.4 
178 
143 
Manufacturing
23,201 
458 
221 
2.0 
48 
1.0 
106 
125 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
21,314 
619 
312 
2.9 
50 
1.5 
208 
119 
  - transport and storage
16,454 
325 
52 
2.0 
16 
0.3 
47 
29 
  - health, education and
    recreation
13,273 
576 
213 
4.3 
37 
1.6 
170 
55 
  - hotels and restaurants
7,143 
952 
354 
13.3 
37 
5.0 
209 
60 
  - utilities
6,543 
22 
0.3 
  - other
24,228 
1,095 
591 
4.5 
54 
2.4 
553 
189 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,471 
98 
36 
2.8 
37 
1.0 
(15)
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,440 
172 
110 
2.0 
64 
1.3 
31 
68 
Interest accruals
675 
Latent
1,339 
(252)
                 
 
437,988 
16,862 
8,414 
3.8 
50 
1.9 
3,403 
2,137 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
99,303 
2,024 
386 
2.0 
19 
0.4 
174 
24 
  - personal lending
20,080 
2,347 
1,895 
11.7 
81 
9.4 
657 
828 
  - property
31,141 
2,475 
568 
7.9 
23 
1.8 
379 
113 
  - other
142,464 
2,636 
1,536 
1.9 
58 
1.1 
525 
537 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
18,393 
2,121 
664 
11.5 
31 
3.6 
437 
10 
  - personal lending
1,972 
143 
125 
7.3 
87 
6.3 
(8)
22 
  - property
4,846 
1,038 
367 
21.4 
35 
7.6 
162 
11 
  - other
33,794 
2,552 
1,891 
7.6 
74 
5.6 
928 
182 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,311 
526 
120 
2.6 
23 
0.6 
162 
164 
  - personal lending
7,505 
136 
59 
1.8 
43 
0.8 
66 
85 
  - property
2,413 
111 
24 
4.6 
22 
1.0 
16 
43 
  - other
36,054 
443 
584 
1.2 
132 
1.6 
26 
101 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
502 
33 
12 
6.6 
36 
2.4 
  - personal lending
1,510 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
  - property
304 
62 
42 
20.4 
68 
13.8 
(87)
  - other
17,396 
214 
140 
1.2 
65 
0.8 
(37)
17 
                 
 
437,988 
16,862 
8,414 
3.8 
50 
1.9 
3,403 
2,137 



 
6

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

30 September 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
of gross 
 loans 
 
 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Central and local government
8,097 
Finance - banks
52,018 
138 
125 
0.3 
91 
0.2 
              - other
48,094 
715 
518 
1.5 
72 
1.1 
130 
22 
Residential mortgages
143,941 
4,835 
1,139 
3.4 
24 
0.8 
641 
169 
Personal lending
32,152 
2,957 
2,359 
9.2 
80 
7.3 
514 
718 
Property
44,072 
4,314 
1,035 
9.8 
24 
2.3 
293 
122 
Construction
7,992 
741 
259 
9.3 
35 
3.2 
136 
122 
Manufacturing
24,816 
447 
238 
1.8 
53 
1.0 
48 
89 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
22,207 
685 
328 
3.1 
48 
1.5 
126 
68 
  - transport and storage
16,236 
277 
49 
1.7 
18 
0.3 
29 
23 
  - health, education and
    recreation
16,224 
633 
188 
3.9 
30 
1.2 
89 
39 
  - hotels and restaurants
7,841 
982 
359 
12.5 
37 
4.6 
150 
29 
  - utilities
8,212 
18 
0.2 
(1)
  - other
24,744 
1,126 
614 
4.6 
55 
2.5 
490 
154 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,767 
93 
31 
2.5 
33 
0.8 
(22)
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,404 
184 
114 
2.2 
62 
1.4 
21 
52 
Interest accruals
661 
Latent
1,516 
(165)
                 
 
469,478 
18,145 
8,873 
3.9 
49 
1.9 
2,479 
1,611 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
104,040 
2,236 
413 
2.1 
18 
0.4 
146 
13 
  - personal lending
21,930 
2,716 
2,185 
12.4 
80 
10.0 
498 
658 
  - property
36,106 
2,950 
636 
8.2 
22 
1.8 
167 
81 
  - other
153,683 
2,968 
1,811 
1.9 
61 
1.2 
379 
421 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
19,109 
2,074 
588 
10.9 
28 
3.1 
331 
  - personal lending
2,126 
143 
124 
6.7 
87 
5.8 
(15)
14 
  - property
5,359 
1,193 
320 
22.3 
27 
6.0 
89 
  - other
40,020 
2,566 
1,783 
6.4 
69 
4.5 
714 
126 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,285 
502 
129 
2.5 
26 
0.6 
164 
153 
  - personal lending
6,543 
96 
49 
1.5 
51 
0.7 
31 
42 
  - property
2,338 
108 
30 
4.6 
28 
1.3 
13 
30 
  - other
36,016 
329 
583 
0.9 
177 
1.6 
(20)
52 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
507 
23 
4.5 
39 
1.8 
  - personal lending
1,553 
0.1 
50 
0.1 
  - property
269 
63 
49 
23.4 
78 
18.2 
24 
10 
  - other
19,594 
176 
163 
0.9 
93 
0.8 
(42)
                 
 
469,478 
18,145 
8,873 
3.9 
49 
1.9 
2,479 
1,611 
 
 

 
7

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

31 December 2010
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Core
               
Central and local government
6,781 
Finance - banks
57,033 
144 
126 
0.3 
88 
0.2 
(5)
              - other
46,910 
567 
402 
1.2 
71 
0.9 
191 
53 
Residential mortgages
140,359 
3,999 
693 
2.8 
17 
0.5 
578 
243 
Personal lending
33,581 
3,131 
2,545 
9.3 
81 
7.6 
1,157 
1,271 
Property
42,455 
3,287 
818 
7.7 
25 
1.9 
739 
98 
Construction
8,680 
610 
222 
7.0 
36 
2.6 
189 
38 
Manufacturing
25,797 
555 
266 
2.2 
48 
1.0 
119 
124 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
21,974 
611 
259 
2.8 
42 
1.2 
199 
103 
  - transport and storage
15,946 
112 
40 
0.7 
36 
0.3 
40 
35 
  - health, education and
    recreation
17,456 
507 
134 
2.9 
26 
0.8 
145 
64 
  - hotels and restaurants
8,189 
741 
236 
9.0 
32 
2.9 
165 
49 
  - utilities
7,098 
22 
0.3 
14 
  - other
24,464 
583 
276 
2.4 
47 
1.1 
137 
98 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
3,758 
94 
57 
2.5 
61 
1.5 
24 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,321 
244 
140 
2.9 
57 
1.7 
63 
42 
Interest accruals
831 
Latent
1,649 
(5)
                 
 
469,633 
15,207 
7,866 
3.2 
52 
1.7 
3,737 
2,224 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
99,928 
2,010 
307 
2.0 
15 
0.3 
164 
16 
  - personal lending
23,035 
2,888 
2,341 
12.5 
81 
10.2 
1,033 
1,142 
  - property
34,970 
2,454 
500 
7.0 
20 
1.4 
394 
43 
  - other
161,746 
2,657 
1,743 
1.6 
66 
1.1 
689 
318 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
19,473 
1,506 
280 
7.7 
19 
1.4 
184 
  - personal lending
2,270 
203 
164 
8.9 
81 
7.2 
43 
19 
  - property
5,139 
631 
240 
12.3 
38 
4.7 
241 
  - other
38,992 
1,565 
1,343 
4.0 
86 
3.4 
468 
85 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
20,548 
460 
97 
2.2 
21 
0.5 
225 
221 
  - personal lending
6,816 
35 
35 
0.5 
100 
0.5 
81 
110 
  - property
1,611 
144 
43 
8.9 
30 
2.7 
84 
54 
  - other
33,110 
388 
649 
1.2 
167 
2.0 
35 
171 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
410 
23 
5.6 
39 
2.2 
  - personal lending
1,460 
0.3 
100 
0.3 
  - property
735 
58 
35 
7.9 
60 
4.8 
20 
  - other
19,390 
180 
75 
0.9 
42 
0.4 
71 
38 
                 
 
469,633 
15,207 
7,866 
3.2 
52 
1.7 
3,737 
2,224 
 
 

 
8

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

31 December 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Central and local government
1,383 
Finance - banks
619 
0.2 
100 
0.2 
              - other
3,229 
317 
147 
9.8 
46 
4.6 
(118)
43 
Residential mortgages
5,102 
380 
180 
7.4 
47 
3.5 
300 
318 
Personal lending
1,556 
110 
92 
7.1 
84 
5.9 
67 
351 
Property
38,064 
17,969 
7,861 
47.2 
44 
20.7 
3,200 
1,004 
Construction
2,672 
1,102 
475 
41.2 
43 
17.8 
(39)
101 
Manufacturing
4,931 
423 
283 
8.6 
67 
5.7 
121 
90 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
2,339 
388 
204 
16.6 
53 
8.7 
(28)
53 
  - transport and storage
5,477 
264 
94 
4.8 
36 
1.7 
31 
14 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,419 
501 
245 
35.3 
49 
17.3 
134 
43 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,161 
485 
289 
41.8 
60 
24.9 
125 
71 
  - utilities
1,849 
66 
22 
3.6 
33 
1.2 
  - other
3,772 
1,308 
504 
34.7 
39 
13.4 
246 
184 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
129 
47 
27 
36.4 
57 
20.9 
13 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
6,059 
622 
398 
10.3 
64 
6.6 
81 
102 
Interest accruals
116 
Latent
647 
(293)
                 
 
79,877 
23,983 
11,469 
30.0 
48 
14.4 
3,838 
2,390 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,423 
52 
11 
3.7 
21 
0.8 
  - personal lending
127 
37 
30 
29.1 
81 
23.6 
(12)
179 
  - property
24,610 
5,405 
2,291 
22.0 
42 
9.3 
1,034 
377 
  - other
19,756 
2,298 
1,504 
11.6 
65 
7.6 
174 
349 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
553 
84 
49 
15.2 
58 
8.9 
30 
  - personal lending
492 
66 
55 
13.4 
83 
11.2 
33 
104 
  - property
11,538 
12,035 
5,384 
104.3 
45 
46.7 
2,134 
497 
  - other
11,068 
2,641 
1,315 
23.9 
50 
11.9 
277 
107 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
2,926 
244 
120 
8.3 
49 
4.1 
264 
317 
  - personal lending
936 
0.7 
100 
0.7 
46 
68 
  - property
1,370 
218 
68 
15.9 
31 
5.0 
(18)
95 
  - other
2,104 
213 
329 
10.1 
154 
15.6 
(192)
96 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
200 
  - personal lending
  - property
546 
311 
118 
57.0 
38 
21.6 
50 
35 
  - other
2,227 
372 
188 
16.7 
51 
8.4 
12 
165 
                 
 
79,877 
23,983 
11,469 
30.0 
48 
14.4 
3,838 
2,390 


 
9

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

30 September 2011
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
YTD 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
YTD 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Central and local government
1,507 
76 
5.0 
Finance - banks
709 
11 
1.6 
0.1 
              - other
4,884 
264 
152 
5.4 
58 
3.1 
(126)
40 
Residential mortgages
5,319 
478 
281 
9.0 
59 
5.3 
308 
223 
Personal lending
2,810 
299 
263 
10.6 
88 
9.4 
21 
88 
Property
40,628 
18,040 
7,796 
44.4 
43 
19.2 
2,643 
609 
Construction
3,062 
1,012 
481 
33.1 
48 
15.7 
(104)
46 
Manufacturing
5,233 
659 
251 
12.6 
38 
4.8 
57 
69 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
2,427 
409 
227 
16.9 
56 
9.4 
25 
  - transport and storage
6,009 
267 
92 
4.4 
34 
1.5 
24 
12 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,515 
564 
213 
37.2 
38 
14.1 
87 
33 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,358 
592 
342 
43.6 
58 
25.2 
116 
25 
  - utilities
1,725 
62 
21 
3.6 
34 
1.2 
  - other
4,479 
1,113 
548 
24.8 
49 
12.2 
200 
157 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
135 
58 
28 
43.0 
48 
20.7 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
7,467 
677 
403 
9.1 
60 
5.4 
60 
73 
Interest accruals
152 
Latent
751 
(190)
                 
 
89,419 
24,581 
11,850 
27.5 
48 
13.3 
3,108 
1,409 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,497 
56 
11 
3.7 
20 
0.7 
  - personal lending
295 
197 
183 
66.8 
93 
62.0 
12 
  - property
25,953 
5,423 
2,163 
20.9 
40 
8.3 
896 
340 
  - other
23,769 
2,375 
1,576 
10.0 
66 
6.6 
57 
229 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
590 
174 
134 
29.5 
77 
22.7 
114 
  - personal lending
526 
67 
54 
12.7 
81 
10.3 
(53)
  - property
12,255 
11,972 
5,433 
97.7 
45 
44.3 
1,720 
188 
  - other
11,957 
2,622 
1,363 
21.9 
52 
11.4 
224 
69 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
3,040 
247 
136 
8.1 
55 
4.5 
188 
218 
  - personal lending
1,986 
35 
26 
1.8 
74 
1.3 
62 
74 
  - property
1,549 
269 
89 
17.4 
33 
5.7 
(23)
57 
  - other
2,259 
304 
363 
13.5 
119 
16.1 
(155)
59 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
192 
0.5 
  - personal lending
  - property
871 
376 
111 
43.2 
30 
12.7 
50 
24 
  - other
2,677 
463 
208 
17.3 
45 
7.8 
10 
132 
                 
 
89,419 
24,581 
11,850 
27.5 
48 
13.3 
3,108 
1,409 


 
10

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

Loans, REIL and impairments by sector and geography (continued)

31 December 2010
Gross 
loans 
£m 
REIL 
£m 
Provisions 
£m 
REIL 
 as a % 
 of gross 
loans 
Provisions 
  as a % 
of REIL 
Provisions 
as a % 
 of gross 
 loans 
 
FY 
Impairment 
charge 
£m 
 
FY 
Amounts 
written-off 
£m 
                 
Non-Core
               
Central and local government
1,671 
Finance - banks
1,003 
0.1 
100 
0.1 
(8)
11 
              - other
7,651 
562 
193 
7.3 
34 
2.5 
88 
Residential mortgages
6,142 
277 
184 
4.5 
66 
3.0 
436 
426 
Personal lending
3,891 
413 
349 
10.6 
85 
9.0 
213 
306 
Property
47,651 
16,297 
5,918 
34.2 
36 
12.4 
3,943 
911 
Construction
3,352 
1,854 
653 
55.3 
35 
19.5 
341 
108 
Manufacturing
6,520 
644 
237 
9.9 
37 
3.6 
(211)
1,423 
Service industries and
  business activities
               
  - retail, wholesale and repairs
3,191 
546 
313 
17.1 
57 
9.8 
135 
58 
  - transport and storage
8,195 
136 
78 
1.7 
57 
1.0 
47 
  - health, education and
    recreation
1,865 
548 
185 
29.4 
34 
9.9 
14 
135 
  - hotels and restaurants
1,492 
528 
268 
35.4 
51 
18.0 
156 
57 
  - utilities
2,110 
69 
20 
3.3 
29 
0.9 
13 
  - other
5,530 
855 
473 
15.5 
55 
8.6 
241 
212 
Agriculture, forestry and fishing
135 
58 
29 
43.0 
50 
21.5 
Finance leases and instalment
  credit
8,529 
603 
414 
7.1 
69 
4.9 
189 
71 
Interest accruals
278 
Latent
1,001 
(116)
                 
 
109,206 
23,391 
10,316 
21.4 
44 
9.4 
5,407 
3,818 
                 
of which:
               
UK
               
  - residential mortgages
1,665 
52 
3.1 
13 
0.4 
  - personal lending
585 
195 
177 
33.3 
91 
30.3 
13 
11 
  - property
30,492 
5,532 
1,719 
18.1 
31 
5.6 
1,152 
354 
  - other
30,188 
2,995 
1,837 
9.9 
61 
6.1 
508 
386 
Europe
               
  - residential mortgages
621 
45 
21 
7.2 
47 
3.4 
37 
  - personal lending
600 
198 
152 
33.0 
77 
25.3 
23 
  - property
12,636 
9,903 
3,959 
78.4 
40 
31.3 
2,587 
209 
  - other
14,388 
2,385 
1,111 
16.6 
47 
7.7 
295 
1,338 
US
               
  - residential mortgages
3,653 
180 
156 
4.9 
87 
4.3 
390 
424 
  - personal lending
2,704 
20 
20 
0.7 
100 
0.7 
79 
161 
  - property
3,318 
621 
159 
18.7 
26 
4.8 
237 
166 
  - other
3,670 
482 
484 
13.1 
100 
13.2 
(111)
353 
RoW
               
  - residential mortgages
203 
  - personal lending
98 
129 
  - property
1,205 
241 
81 
20.0 
34 
6.7 
(33)
182 
  - other
3,276 
542 
433 
16.5 
80 
13.2 
123 
98 
                 
 
109,206 
23,391 
10,316 
21.4 
44 
9.4 
5,407 
3,818 


 
11

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

ABS by geography and measurement classification

           
FVTPL (1)
   
 
US 
UK 
Other 
 Europe 
RoW 
Total 
HFT (2)
DFV (3)
AFS (4)
LAR (5)
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Gross exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
133 
203 
8,256 
8,592 
8,592 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
27,549 
5,884 
33,435 
15,031 
18,404 
RMBS: prime
1,201 
3,487 
1,541 
484 
6,713 
1,090 
567 
4,977 
79 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,220 
2,197 
74 
3,491 
717 
1,402 
1,372 
RMBS: sub-prime
1,847 
427 
94 
2,370 
2,183 
22 
165 
CMBS
1,623 
1,562 
883 
4,069 
2,001 
862 
1,206 
CDOs
7,889 
72 
469 
8,430 
4,455 
3,885 
90 
CLOs
5,019 
156 
1,055 
6,230 
1,294 
4,734 
202 
ABS covered bond
21 
71 
948 
1,044 
1,044 
Other ABS
2,085 
1,844 
1,746 
992 
6,667 
1,965 
17 
2,389 
2,296 
                   
 
48,587 
10,019 
20,950 
1,485 
81,041 
28,736 
584 
46,311 
5,410 
                   
Carrying value
                 
MBS: covered bond
136 
209 
7,175 
7,520 
7,520 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
28,022 
5,549 
33,573 
15,132 
18,441 
RMBS: prime
1,035 
3,038 
1,206 
466 
5,745 
872 
558 
4,243 
72 
RMBS: non-conforming
708 
1,897 
74 
2,679 
327 
980 
1,372 
RMBS: sub-prime
686 
144 
72 
904 
737 
158 
CMBS
1,502 
1,253 
635 
3,391 
1,513 
716 
1,162 
CDOs
1,632 
31 
294 
1,957 
315 
1,555 
87 
CLOs
4,524 
98 
719 
5,341 
882 
4,280 
179 
ABS covered bond
19 
70 
953 
1,046 
1,046 
Other ABS
1,715 
947 
1,525 
966 
5,153 
1,038 
1,945 
2,170 
                   
 
39,979 
7,687 
18,202 
1,441 
67,309 
20,816 
558 
40,735 
5,200 
                   
Net exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
136 
209 
7,175 
7,520 
7,520 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
28,022 
5,549 
33,573 
15,132 
18,441 
RMBS: prime
825 
3,456 
1,005 
458 
5,744 
447 
557 
4,668 
72 
RMBS: non-conforming
677 
2,225 
74 
2,976 
284 
1,320 
1,372 
RMBS: sub-prime
385 
138 
67 
592 
434 
158 
CMBS
860 
1,253 
543 
2,657 
777 
718 
1,162 
CDOs
1,030 
31 
294 
1,355 
304 
964 
87 
CLOs
1,367 
98 
712 
2,177 
827 
1,171 
179 
ABS covered bond
19 
70 
952 
1,045 
1,045 
Other ABS
1,456 
843 
1,527 
804 
4,630 
617 
1,941 
2,071 
                   
 
34,777 
8,323 
17,898 
1,271 
62,269 
18,822 
557 
37,788 
5,101 

For notes relating to this table refer to page 14.

 
12

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

ABS by geography and measurement classification (continued)

           
FVTPL (1)
   
 
US 
UK 
Other 
 Europe 
RoW 
Total 
HFT (2)
DFV (3)
AFS (4)
LAR (5)
30 September 2011
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
                   
Gross exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
136 
206 
8,468 
8,810 
8,810 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
29,011 
15 
6,141 
35,168 
17,622 
17,546 
RMBS: prime
1,464 
3,267 
1,848 
493 
7,072 
1,152 
74 
5,743 
103 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,197 
2,198 
75 
3,470 
678 
1,416 
1,376 
RMBS: sub-prime
2,015 
437 
106 
2,562 
2,355 
24 
183 
CMBS
1,937 
1,748 
881 
30 
4,596 
2,295 
949 
1,352 
CDOs
9,427 
49 
487 
9,963 
5,882 
3,989 
92 
CLOs
5,314 
119 
772 
6,205 
1,050 
4,893 
262 
ABS covered bond
1,466 
1,466 
1,466 
Other ABS
2,074 
1,688 
948 
1,150 
5,860 
1,907 
1,612 
2,341 
                   
 
52,575 
9,727 
21,192 
1,678 
85,172 
32,941 
74 
46,448 
5,709 
                   
Carrying value
                 
MBS: covered bond
139 
214 
7,504 
7,857 
7,857 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
29,759 
15 
5,790 
35,565 
17,948 
17,617 
RMBS: prime
1,207 
2,755 
1,493 
478 
5,933 
947 
4,891 
94 
RMBS: non-conforming
773 
1,914 
75 
2,762 
366 
1,020 
1,376 
RMBS: sub-prime
928 
159 
83 
1,174 
988 
11 
175 
CMBS
1,811 
1,373 
621 
30 
3,835 
1,759 
838 
1,238 
CDOs
1,913 
16 
298 
2,227 
476 
1,662 
89 
CLOs
4,787 
78 
500 
5,365 
647 
4,479 
239 
ABS covered bond
1,425 
1,425 
1,425 
Other ABS
1,743 
824 
838 
1,114 
4,519 
992 
1,291 
2,236 
                   
 
43,060 
7,348 
18,627 
1,627 
70,662 
24,123 
41,091 
5,447 
                   
Net exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
139 
214 
7,504 
7,857 
7,857 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
29,759 
15 
5,790 
35,565 
17,948 
17,617 
RMBS: prime
1,102 
2,740 
1,292 
454 
5,588 
610 
4,883 
94 
RMBS: non-conforming
739 
1,903 
75 
2,717 
322 
1,019 
1,376 
RMBS: sub-prime
506 
159 
78 
747 
569 
175 
CMBS
950 
1,373 
510 
30 
2,863 
802 
837 
1,224 
CDOs
369 
16 
298 
683 
225 
369 
89 
CLOs
1,159 
78 
493 
1,730 
580 
911 
239 
ABS covered bond
1,425 
1,425 
1,425 
Other ABS
1,449 
717 
840 
959 
3,965 
548 
1,292 
2,125 
                   
 
36,172 
7,215 
18,305 
1,448 
63,140 
21,604 
36,213 
5,322 

For notes relating to this table refer to page 14.

 
13

 
Appendix 2 Additional risk management disclosures (continued)

ABS by geography and measurement classification (continued)

           
FVTPL (1)
   
 
US 
UK 
Other 
 Europe 
RoW  
Total 
HFT (2)
DFV (3)
AFS (4)
LAR (5)
31 December 2010
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
£m 
Gross exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
138 
208 
8,525 
8,871 
8,871 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
24,207 
16 
6,422 
30,645 
13,840 
16,805 
RMBS: prime
1,784 
3,385 
1,118 
192 
6,479 
1,605 
4,749 
124 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,249 
2,107 
92 
3,448 
708 
1,313 
1,427 
RMBS: sub-prime
792 
365 
139 
221 
1,517 
819 
496 
202 
CMBS
3,086 
1,451 
912 
45 
5,494 
2,646 
120 
1,409 
1,319 
CDOs
12,156 
128 
453 
12,737 
7,951 
4,687 
99 
CLOs
6,038 
134 
879 
7,060 
1,062 
5,572 
426 
ABS covered bond
1,908 
1,908 
1,908 
Other ABS
3,104 
1,144 
963 
1,705 
6,916 
1,533 
2,615 
2,768 
                   
 
52,554 
8,938 
21,411 
2,172 
85,075 
30,164 
121 
48,425 
6,365 
                   
Carrying value
                 
MBS: covered bond
142 
208 
7,522 
7,872 
7,872 
RMBS: Government sponsored
   or similar
24,390 
16 
5,958 
30,364 
13,765 
16,599 
RMBS: prime
1,624 
3,000 
931 
192 
5,747 
1,384 
4,249 
113 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,084 
1,959 
92 
3,135 
605 
1,102 
1,428 
RMBS: sub-prime
638 
255 
120 
205 
1,218 
681 
344 
193 
CMBS
2,936 
1,338 
638 
38 
4,950 
2,262 
118 
1,281 
1,289 
CDOs
3,135 
69 
254 
3,458 
1,341 
2,021 
96 
CLOs
5,334 
102 
635 
6,074 
691 
4,958 
425 
ABS covered bond
1,861 
1,861 
1,861 
Other ABS
2,780 
945 
754 
1,667 
6,146 
1,259 
2,228 
2,659 
                   
 
42,063 
7,892 
18,765 
2,105 
70,825 
21,988 
119 
42,515 
6,203 
                   
Net exposure
                 
MBS: covered bond
142 
208 
7,522 
7,872 
7,872 
RMBS: Government sponsored
  or similar
24,390 
16 
5,958 
30,364 
13,765 
16,599 
RMBS: prime
1,523 
2,948 
596 
192 
5,259 
897 
4,248 
113 
RMBS: non-conforming
1,081 
1,959 
92 
3,132 
602 
1,102 
1,428 
RMBS: sub-prime
289 
253 
112 
176 
830 
305 
332 
193 
CMBS
1,823 
1,336 
458 
38 
3,655 
1,188 
10 
1,230 
1,227 
CDOs
1,085 
39 
245 
1,369 
743 
530 
96 
CLOs
1,387 
102 
629 
2,119 
673 
1,021 
425 
ABS covered bond
1,861 
1,861 
1,861 
Other ABS
2,293 
748 
748 
1,659 
5,448 
690 
2,220 
2,538 
                   
 
34,013 
7,609 
18,221 
2,066 
61,909 
18,863 
11 
37,015 
6,020 

Notes:
(1)
Fair value through profit or loss.
(2)
Held-for-trading.
(3)
Designated as at fair value through profit or loss.
(4)
Available-for-sale.
(5)
Loans and receivables.
 

 
 
14

 




Appendix 3
 
Asset Protection Scheme



 
 

 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme

Covered assets: roll forward to 31 December 2011
The Group has paid Asset Protection Scheme (APS) premiums totalling £2,225 million (£125 million in 2011, £700 million in 2010 and £1,400 million in 2009).  From 31 December 2011, premiums of £125 million are payable quarterly until the earlier of 2099 and the date the Group leaves the Scheme.

The table below shows the movement in covered assets.
 
Covered 
 amount
 
£bn 
   
Covered assets at 31 December 2010
194.7 
Disposals
(4.1)
Maturities, amortisation and early repayments
(33.2)
Effect of foreign currency movements and other adjustments
(1.6)
   
Covered assets at 30 September 2011
155.8 
Disposals
(1.2)
Maturities, amortisation and early repayments
(9.2)
Withdrawals
(12.4)
Effect of foreign currency movements and other adjustments
(1.2)
   
Covered assets at 31 December 2011
131.8 

Key points
·
The reduction in covered assets was due to run-off of the portfolio, disposals, early repayments and maturing loans.
   
·
The Group continues to take advantage of market conditions and execute sales from a number of its portfolios.
   
·
During the last quarter of 2011, the Group withdrew £12.4 billion of covered assets with a lower than average risk profile from the APS.

Credit impairments and write-downs
The table below analyses the credit impairment provision (adjusted for write-downs) and adjustments to par value (including available-for-sale reserves) relating to covered assets.

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
2010 
 
£m 
£m 
£m 
       
Loans and advances
20,586 
20,407 
18,033 
Debt securities
10,703 
11,079 
11,747 
Derivatives
3,056 
3,023 
2,043 
       
 
34,345 
34,509 
31,823 
       
Core
7,626 
8,061 
6,646 
Non-Core
26,719 
26,448 
25,177 
       
 
34,345 
34,509 
31,823 

Key points
·
The increase in Non-Core impairments of £1.5 billion accounted for the majority of the increase in credit impairments and write-downs in 2011.
·
The increase in Core is largely accounted for by impairments offset by asset withdrawals.


 
1

 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme (continued)

First loss utilisation
The table below shows the first loss utilisation under the original and modified rules.

 
Original Scheme rules
 
Modified
Scheme rules
 
 
Gross loss 
amount 
Cash 
recoveries 
to date 
 
Net triggered 
 loss 
Net triggered 
total 
31 December 2011
£m 
£m 
 
£m 
£m 
           
Core
8,451 
(2,240)
 
1,567 
7,778 
Non-Core
17,486 
(2,992)
 
8,158 
22,652 
           
 
25,937 
(5,232)
 
9,725 
30,430 
           
Loss credits
       
1,802 
           
         
32,232 

30 September 2011
         
           
Core
8,152 
(1,625)
 
2,004 
8,531 
Non-Core
14,974 
(2,477)
 
7,949 
20,446 
           
 
23,126 
(4,102)
 
9,953 
28,977 
           
Loss credits
       
1,792 
           
         
30,769 
           
31 December 2010
         
           
Core
6,865 
(1,042)
 
1,559 
7,382 
Non-Core
13,946 
(1,876)
 
6,923 
18,993 
           
 
20,811 
(2,918)
 
8,482 
26,375 
           
Loss credits
       
1,241 
           
         
27,616 

Key points
·
The cumulative first loss is £32.2 billion.  However, the Group does not expect to claim under the APS, which has a first loss of £60 billion.
   
·
The Group received loss credits of £0.6 billion in 2011 in relation to disposals. Cumulative loss credits at 31 December 2011 were £1.8 billion.
   
·
The Group continues to expect an average recovery rate of approximately 40% across all portfolios.


 
2

 
Appendix 3 Asset Protection Scheme (continued)

Risk-weighted assets
The table below analyses risk-weighted assets (RWAs) covered by the APS.

 
31 December 
2011 
30 September 
2011 
31 December 
 2010 
 
£bn 
£bn 
£bn 
       
Core
40.2 
43.9 
54.7 
Non-Core
28.9 
44.7 
50.9 
       
APS RWAs
69.1 
88.6 
105.6 

Key points

2011 compared with 2010
·
The decrease of £36.5 billion in RWAs covered by the APS, reflects pool movements, assets moving into default and changes in risk parameters.

Q4 2011 compared with Q3 2011
·
RWA decreases in the quarter were as a result of pool movements, asset withdrawals, assets moving into default and changes in risk parameters.
 

 
 
3

 




Appendix 4
 
Divisional reorganisation




 
 

 
Divisional reorganisation

Organisational change
In January 2012, the Group announced changes to its wholesale banking operations in light of a changed market and regulatory environment.  The changes will see the reorganisation of the Group’s wholesale businesses into ‘Markets’ and ‘International Banking’ and the exit and downsizing of selected activities.  The changes will ensure the wholesale businesses continue to deliver against the Group’s strategy.

The changes will include an exit from cash equities, corporate brokering, equity capital markets and mergers and acquisitions businesses.  Significant reductions in balance sheet, funding requirements and cost base in the remaining wholesale businesses will be implemented.
 
 
Existing GBM and GTS divisions will be reorganised as follows:
·
The ‘Markets’ business will maintain its focus on fixed income, with strong positions in debt capital raising, securitisation, risk management, foreign exchange and rates. It will serve the corporate and institutional clients of all Group businesses.
·
GBM's corporate banking business will combine with the international businesses of our GTS arm into a new ‘International Banking’ unit and provide clients with a 'one-stop shop' access to the Group’s debt financing, risk management and payments services. This international corporate business will be self-funded through its stable corporate deposit base.
·
The domestic small and mid-size corporates currently served within GTS will be managed within RBS's domestic corporate banking businesses in the UK, Ireland (Ulster Bank) and the US (US Retail and Commercial).

Our wholesale business will be retaining its international footprint to ensure that it can serve our customers' needs globally. We believe, that despite current challenges to the sector, wholesale banking services can play a central role in supporting cross border trade and capital flows, financing requirements and risk management and we remain committed to this business.

Going forward the Group will comprise the following segments:
·
Retail and Commercial
 
-
UK Retail
 
-
UK Corporate
 
-
Wealth
 
-
US Retail and Commercial
 
-
Ulster Bank
 
-
International Banking
·
Markets
·
RBS Insurance
·
Group Centre
·
Core
·
Non-Core

Revised allocation of Group Treasury costs
The Group is also refining the way that Group Treasury costs are allocated. It is in the process of revising prior period information to reflect these changes and further details will be published ahead of the Group’s Q1 2012 Interim Management Statement.
 
1